* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download Writing in Business and Economics
Dumping (pricing policy) wikipedia , lookup
Marketing mix modeling wikipedia , lookup
Youth marketing wikipedia , lookup
Marketing plan wikipedia , lookup
Market penetration wikipedia , lookup
Neuromarketing wikipedia , lookup
Integrated marketing communications wikipedia , lookup
Street marketing wikipedia , lookup
Target audience wikipedia , lookup
Sensory branding wikipedia , lookup
Multicultural marketing wikipedia , lookup
Product planning wikipedia , lookup
Perfect competition wikipedia , lookup
Advertising campaign wikipedia , lookup
Green marketing wikipedia , lookup
Marketing channel wikipedia , lookup
Target market wikipedia , lookup
Global marketing wikipedia , lookup
WRITING IN BUSINESS AND ECONOMICS (Language and Learning Online) Writing in Business and Economics These tutorials are intended to help you develop skills to improve your writing in Business and Economics subjects. Take a look at the resources in the Commercial Law <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/index.xml> , Economics <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/index.xml> , Management <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/index.xml> , or Marketing <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/index.xml> modules to learn more about meeting your lecturer's expectations and developing your own writing skills in these subjects. These tutorials all feature samples of student writing, as well as student comments on the writing process. Commercial Law assignment This tutorial contains information about assignment writing based on materials from the first-year subject Commercial Law. You will also find much of the information to be useful for your other Business Law subjects. Navigate through the tutorial using the Table of Contents on the left. The tutorial's three main sections are outlined below. Lecturer's advice <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/1.xml> Get information from the lecturer about what is required for Commercial Law assignments. Skills for writing in Commercial Law <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/2.xml> Learn to write better assignments through interactive tasks. Annotated assignments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.xml> View samples of student work with lecturer and student comments. Lecturer's advice In this section, one of your lecturers - Brendan Sweeney - answers Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) about researching and writing assignments in first-year Commercial Law. FAQs: Click on those topic areas that are of interest to you, or that you need to know more about. Objectives 1. What are you hoping to achieve in setting the main assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq1> 2. What do you hope students will gain from the experience of researching and writing it? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq2> 3. In the preparation of their assignments, what aspects of the course (content covered, skills, etc.) would you expect students to draw on? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq3> Assessment 4. What are your main considerations when assessing assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq4> Perception of performance 5. What in your experience are some of the main difficulties first-year students have with commercial law assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq5> 6. Which of these would you say are of a more generic nature (e.g. structuring paragraphs) and which specifically relate to writing in your discipline? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq6> Reading requirements 7. Students are often uncertain about the amount and type of reading they need to do for a university assignment. What are your expectations in this regard for a first-year commercial law assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq7> Transition issues 8. Do you have any sense of how the writing requirements of VCE compare with the type of writing required in your course? What transitions do you think students need to make? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq8> Advice 9. If you were to give students three simple pieces of advice as they prepare to do an assignment in your subject, what would these be? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq9> 1. What are you hoping to achieve in setting the main assignment? The aim of this assignment is: 1. To test the student's ability to apply the skills learnt in lectures and tutorials to a problem without the aid of extensive guidance 2. To provide students with the opportunity to cover one aspect of contract law in more detail Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 2. What do you hope students will gain from the experience of researching and writing it? 1. Knowledge from the research 2. Practice in applying conceptual principles to solve a practical problem 3. Confidence from being required to submit a solution without guidance Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 3. In the preparation of their assignments, what aspects of the course (content covered, skills, etc.) would you expect students to draw on? 1. Analytical skills 2. Preparation of coherent written opinion 3. Note: quality research skills are not really required for this assignment Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 4. What are your main considerations when assessing assignments? 1. 2. 3. 4. Application of the relevant rules to resolve the issues Ability to reach a reasoned conclusion Relevance of material Presentation (mainly the coherence of the argument, but also other factors such as clarity of expression) Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 5. What in your experience are some of the main difficulties first-year students have with Commercial Law assignments? 1. Failure to identify the issue properly. Failure to understand the notion of arguing by analogy. Students spend hours looking for a situation that is exactly the same as the one given. However, perhaps we shouldn't overstate this as a problem. If a student comes to the realization during the course of the assignment that what matters is the core issue not the superficial facts, then they have learnt a key lesson. 2. Fear of writing. This is particularly true of international students. 3. Fear of committing themselves to a solution. This may be particularly true of some international students who may be used to a system of assessment based on repeating precisely what they have been taught. They are uncomfortable expressing a conclusion that has not already been approved by the teacher. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 6. Which of these would you say are of a more generic nature (e.g. structuring paragraphs) and which specifically relate to writing in your discipline? Essentially they are all generic. However, they are often dressed up as problems with Law. Students have a notion that there is some secret to writing in Law and if only we would give them the secret all would be clear. This is just not true. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 7. Students are often uncertain about the amount and type of reading they need to do for a university assignment. What are your expectations in this regard for a first-year commercial law assignment? Our problem is based on testing their analytical skills rather than their research skills. Therefore, we do not expect much reading beyond the text. The test lies in their ability to reason. However, this puts us in a dilemma. We don't want to state outright that we do not want - or expect - students to do some reading beyond the text. We do however stress that the key to the assignment (and indeed to the subject) is how students go about solving the problem and not about the depth of research. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 8. Do you have any sense of how the writing requirements of VCE compare with the type of writing required in your course? What transitions do you think students need to make? I have to say that I am no expert on the VCE. However, I do understand that frequently the CATS were based on written work that was edited and re-edited many times following assessment by the teacher. This is clearly quite differently from what we expect. I note that a common complaint from students is that tutors are instructed not to help them with their assignment. This is absolutely true. On the other hand, the tutor is there to answer questions. The tutors will most certainly answer conceptual difficulties the students are having. However, many students really just want to be told what the answer is, or whether their answer is correct. Having said this it must be remembered that we get some very good answers that would certainly not be misplaced in a Law school. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 9. If you were to give students three simple pieces of advice as they prepare to do an assignment in your subject, what would these be? Begin early. Focus properly - look at the assignment as an analytical problem, not a research exercise. Read the assignment aloud to someone. If it doesn't seem to make sense, then it is probably not going to get many marks when we read it. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> Skills for writing in Commercial Law In this section, you have a chance to practice skills to help you with your report writing for Commercial Law. The materials cover four broad topics and include a range of practice tasks. Select those topics from the menu on the left that you'd like to work on. If you want to practice all of them, work from start to finish. Topics: Assignment tasks <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/2.1.xml> Style of writing <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/2.2.xml> Using paragraphs <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/2.3.xml> Legal arguments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/2.4.xml> Assignment tasks When you study Commercial Law, your assignment and exam questions will most likely be problem questions. These differ from essay and report tasks in that the latter are only a few sentences, or a short paragraph, in length. Problem questions in Commercial Law are often at least three quarters of a page in length. The information provided in the problem tasks has issues or problems embedded in them. You have to find these and then build your response on them. Structuring a written response Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. It is important that you address the directions given to you by your examiner. Study the [1]assignment task. Note how it concludes with a direction to you, the student. You are required to look at the situation from the perspective of one party involved in the situation presented: Patricia. [1] Patricia Wu had recently opened up her own office supplies business 'Wu's Wonders' which deals mainly with students at a local university. In addition to selling pens and paper, Patricia also provides copying services for students, particularly science and medical students. She specialises in the copying and binding of student theses. One day her photocopier broke down and she went to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd to purchase a new one. Several were displayed, including a second-hand one, manufactured by Kojack Ltd. It had a huge sign on it saying 'Great Bargain. Low mileage. Almost as good as new. Buy now and save!! Yours for $35,000.' Patricia asked Shirley, the salesperson, what 'low mileage' meant. Shirley explained that the machine had hardly been used and had only completed 1,000 copies. Patricia then asked how old it was. Shirley replied, ' Oh I'm not 100 % sure but I think it is last year's model'. Patricia told Shirley about her business of copying theses, which included photographs, and then asked if the copier could do a number of specialised tasks, such as colour copies, double-siding, collating, stapling and reducing. Most importantly, she asked whether it was capable of producing large quantities of copies quickly and without breaking down. Shirley reassured her and said: 'This copier will do all that and more. It has the best quality lens for really clear reproductions. You'll have no problem and anyway we provide a month's free service. We have had no complaints about this model.' Patricia then signed a contract of purchase, buying the copier for $35,000. When using the copier, Patricia soon realised that not all copies were clear, the colours appeared to be 'washed-out' and 'red' was always 'pink'. She rang Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who sent out a repairman to service the machine. The next day the copier broke down and the repairman explained that it needed a new lens valued at $10,000. Patricia, who had just recently obtained a contract, valued at $50,000, to provide copying services to the University's Faculty of Business, was placed in a stressful position. In order to honour this contract, Patricia had to lease another copier from 'Joe's Office Rentals' at $100 a day for a total of 14 days. When Patricia explained her story to Joe, he laughed and said that that particular model of copier was always breaking down and had been recalled by the manufacturer due to the overwhelming number of complaints. He also said that it was about 5 years old and explained that normally a lens only needed replacing after 200,000 copies had been made. Furthermore, he believed the copier was only worth approximately $15,000. When the new lens arrived, Patricia's troubles continued. The machine could not reduce and produce doublesided copies simultaneously. It could perform each task separately, but not simultaneously. Bob sent Patricia an account for the new lens, which Patricia refused to pay because she thought it was included in the first month's free service. Bob replied that the service deal didn't include spare parts, just the labour costs. Patricia re-read the contract. Although it contained a clause which stated that there was one month's free service, the meaning of 'service' was not stated. She did however, notice the following clause: 'Any conditions, statutory or otherwise, not contained herein are excluded.' a. What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd arising out of the above set of facts? Explain your answer. b. What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd if the price for the photocopier was $45,000? Explain your answer. As you will note in the task, you need to look at the facts from the perspective of Patricia and find the legal problems embedded in the task that relate to her dealings with a) Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd. generally; and b) Bob's Warehouse concerning the $45,000 price for the photocopier. You then need to devise legal solutions to both these areas and present them on Patricia's behalf. However, you also need to remember that you are dealing with an adversarial legal system. Question 1 Bearing in mind that it is an adversarial legal system, look at the task again. Think about how you might structure your written response when you provide a legal solution to the problem(s). Select from the following alternatives the one that you think is the best structure for a response. possible assignment response a. Summarise the facts presented in the problem question and explain clearly to your examiner what happened in the situation presented. best response feedback This is incorrect. You would not get many marks for a response such as this. Your examiner knows and understands very clearly the facts of the problem question because (s)he wrote it. You do use the facts from the problem question in your assignment, but only those relevant for the issue for which you are developing a legal argument. b. After you have identified cases and law that are relevant to the facts in the problem question, summarise and express these clearly for your reader. c. Both a) and b) above. Place a summary of the facts in one section of the assignment and a summary of the law in another section. d. When you have found the legal issues or disputes in the problem facts in relation to the party you are advising, develop and present legal arguments for both sides of the issue. In the legal arguments, name the issue, give the relevant law and analyse the relevant facts from the problem question. This is correct to some extent, but the law on its own is inadequate. If you express it clearly, this would show your examiner that you have a clear understanding of the law, but it would not show that you are able to apply the law to the particular facts in your problem question. You need to identify and present in writing the law relevant to the issue and your facts and then analyse the facts from your problem in relation to it. This is an inadequate response. You do need to use both the law and the facts from your problem question in your legal argument. However, they need to be linked to the relevant issues and they need to be interwoven as you analyse the problem facts in relation to the law. Correct. You must identify clearly for your examiner the issue(s) that are in the problem facts, in relation to the party you are advising. Then, you develop legal arguments for both sides of the issue, bringing in the relevant law and the relevant problem facts. Question 2: Directions to the student Study the assignment task again at the top of the page. You will note that, at the end of the series of facts, the examiner has provided clear instructions for the student on what they have to do in their written response. There is no choice or room for negotiation in this matter. If you do not follow your examiner's instructions, you will not receive many marks for your work. The direction for this assignment task is "What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against...?" What do you think this means? Select from the following alternatives the one that you think is the most appropriate. possible interpretations of the question a. Only look at the problem facts and develop a legal argument from the perspective of the person or party that you have been asked to advise. Completely ignore any counter-arguments for the other person or party also involved in the issue or dispute. best interpretation b. Look at the problem facts to isolate issue(s) and develop legal arguments from the perspectives of all people and parties involved in the problem facts, even if their involvement is only minimal. c. Find the legal issue(s) in the problem facts concerning the person or party you have been asked to advise. Then, develop and present in writing legal arguments in their favour as well as counter-arguments that could be presented by the other person or party to the issue or dispute. At the end of your response, summarise your advice to the specified person or party, indicating if you think they have, or do not have, a good chance of success if the case went to court. [2] Check your answer Interpretation C is the correct response. As you are looking at the facts from the perspective of one party, you should also present the counter-arguments. At the end, you summarise your overall advice after weighing up the strength of the various alternatives you have presented. [2] Style of writing When you study Law subjects and you read legal texts and cases, you will note that the writing style can be complex and difficult to understand. Especially in the words of judges cited in cases, the sentences may be very long and complicated, with many relative and subordinate clauses, and the vocabulary used may be very formal. Sometimes when students are writing their assignments, they think that they have to write in a sophisticated and complex style like this. The result can be that the meaning in the sentences is lost and the examiner may be completely confused as to the student's meaning. You do not have to write in a complex style in your Commercial Law assignments. Your writing style should be premised on expressing your meaning clearly for your reader (your examiner). Clear expression is based on clear and logical organisation of ideas in the written piece, as well as clear structure in the sentences. This means that you should plan your response clearly and logically before you start writing. In this section, we focus on clear sentence-level expression. Clear writing Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Study the two samples of student writing below. a. The first breach of the implied term of merchantable quality under section 71(1) of the Trade Practices Act, which states that when a good is fit for the purpose it is reasonable to expect that the good will be fit for the purpose, it is to be used for, seems to have occurred. As was the decision in the case H Beecham and Co Pty Ltd v Francis Howard and Co Pty Ltd [1921] VLR 428, as the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia bought it for having regard to the price and other circumstances and because Patricia was not aware of the defect prior to sale and any inspection made by Patricia would not have revealed the defect, the photocopier does not seem to have been of merchantable quality. b. The first implied term that has been breached is the term of merchantable quality under section 71(1) of the Trade Practices Act. Merchantable quality is when a good is fit for the purpose it is reasonable to expect the good will is used for. The photocopier that Patricia bought is not of merchantable quality as the goods are not fit for the purpose that it is reasonable to expect having regard to price and other circumstances (H Beecham and Co Pty Ltd v Francis Howard and Co Pty Ltd [1921] VLR 428). Also Patricia was not aware of the defect prior to sale and any inspection made by Patricia would not have revealed the defect. The term of merchantable quality has clearly been breached. Select the one where you think the writer's meaning is clear and easy to follow. a. b. [1] Check your answer [1] If you answered that Example B is clearer than Example A, you are correct. Because: Example A uses very long sentences, with too much information packed into them. There are only two sentences in this whole passage. Example B is clearer. It uses four sentences to express the same information. Sentence structure Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. A basic sentence consists of a subject, a verb, and an object. For example, in the sentence below, subject is in bold, verb is highlighted, and object is in italics. The bank officer signed the contract. This is a basic sentence, and it would not be good style to write all of your sentences as simply as this. You can add extra information in a sentence by including relative clauses and phrases, to provide further information about the main elements of the sentence. Note how we've added extra information by adding relative clauses and a phrase to our simple sentence below. (The relative clauses and phrase are in bold.) The bank officer, who had been dealing with both parties, signed, in a hasty manner, the contract which had been drawn up two years previously. Now it's time for you to try to include information in reasonably sized sentences. Study the notes below: Main points 2nd situation for consideration: photocopier purchased for $45,000 Trade Practices Act does not apply: goods over $40,000, not normally used for household or domestic use Non-consumer contract. So Patricia might use Goods Act But Section 61: exclusion clauses not allowed in non-consumer contract This is non-consumer contract: so, Patricia might use Goods Act But Section 61, Goods Act, exclusion clauses permitted in non-consumer contract: businesses normally on equal terms and do not need protection Only legal rights for Patricia: sue for misrepresentation But which type of misrepresentation? Two types are torts of deceit and negligence Using the above main points for your paragraph, see if you can express the information clearly. Write your response in the box below. Type your response into the text box below. [1] Check your answer [1] Look at the response below which is one way of expressing this information. Is your response similar to this? In what ways is it similar? In what ways is it different? Under the second situation, where the photocopier was purchased for $45,000 the Trade Practices Act will not apply as the good was over $40,000 and is not of a type that is normally used in household or domestic use. As this is a non-consumer contract Patricia may try to use the Goods Act however section 61 states that exclusion clauses are permitted in non-consumer contracts as businesses are normally on equal terms and do not need protection. The only legal rights available to Patricia under these circumstances are to attempt to sue for misrepresentation. The first step would be to see which type of misrepresentation she could sue for. The two areas are the torts of deceit and negligence. Using paragraphs When you are structuring your writing, you need to consider where you will begin and end paragraphs. Good organization of information in paragraphs helps your reader (who is your examiner) to follow your discussion. If the paragraphs are too long, your examiner may lose concentration and become lost in the information you are providing. If the paragraphs are too short (a paragraph of one sentence, for example, is too short), you are not indicating to your examiner that you are capable of investigating or arguing a point in detail. Paragraph structure Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Study the first part of the [1]sample assignment. (Print it out if you like - the paragraphs have been numbered in bold to help you with the exercises following the sample.) Question 1 What is your overall impression of the size of the paragraphs in this piece? Paragraphs are too short Paragraphs are too long Paragraphs are just right [2] Check your answer [2] The ideas are expressed clearly at the sentence level. However, perhaps the continuity of the discussion could be enhanced by joining up some of the smaller paragraphs to make longer, more complicated paragraphs. Question 2 Which paragraphs do you think could be combined to produce a more flowing piece of writing? Paragraphs 1 and 2 should be combined Paragraphs 3, 4, 5, and 6 should be combined Paragraphs 8 and 9 should be combined Paragraphs 10 and 11 should be combined Paragraphs 12 and 13 should be combined Paragraphs 14, 15, and 16 should be combined Paragraphs 17 and 18 should be combined Paragraphs 20, 21, and 22 should be combined [3] Check your answer [3] Answer: Paragraphs 3, 4, 5 and 6 could be combined into one paragraph. This is because all of these paragraphs contain information that relates to the end of Paragraph 2 (that is, the four steps for proving if the Trade Practices Act applies). Paragraphs 8 and 9 could be combined. This is because they both contain information on breaching of the implied term of merchantable quality. Paragraphs 10 and 11 could be combined. Both contain information and argument about fitness for purpose. Paragraphs 14, 15, and 16 could be combined as they all deal with rescinding the contract. Paragraphs 17 and 18 could be combined as both are concerned with damages. [1] Part 1 1. Clearly a contract exists here. The issue is what, if any, legal rights Patricia Wu might have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd after having purchased the photocopier for $35,000. 2. Patricia's best course of action would be under the Trade Practices Act (Cth) 1974 or the Goods Act (Vic). However as there is an exclusion clause in this contract the Goods Act will not apply as under section 61 of the act exclusion clauses are permitted. The Trade Practices Act however does not permit exclusion clauses under section 68. She would look toward section 4 to see if the Trade Practices Act does apply in these circumstances. There are four steps in testing whether the Trade Practices Act applies. 3. Step one is to check whether the seller is a corporation, Patricia purchased the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who are clearly a corporation as they have proprietorship limited attached after their name. 4. Step two is whether the contract is a consumer contract. A consumer contract is when the price of goods is less than $40,000 or the goods are normally used in a domestic or household situation. As the photocopier was $35,000 it is a consumer contract as it is less than the prescribed amount. 5. Step three is whether the sale was in the course of business. This means that the sale was done by a licensed seller and bought by a consumer, not just a sale between two people. Patricia bought the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd so it is clearly in the course of business. 6. The final step is that the sale was not at an auction. As the photocopier was bought from Bob's and not at an auction the Trade Practices Act obviously applies. 7. However Patricia must prove that the contract has been breached. The first way to see if it has is by seeing if any of the express terms have been breached, as the contract was a contract of purchase it would only contain terms relating to purchase, sale, warranties and the exclusion clause. As none of the express terms have been breached the next step would be to see if any of the implied terms have been breached. 8. The first implied term that has been breached is the term of merchantable quality under section 71(1) of the Trade Practices Act. Merchantable quality is when a good is fit for the purpose it is reasonable to expect the good will be used for. The photocopier that Patricia bought is not of merchantable quality as the goods are not fit for the purpose that it is reasonable to expect having regard to price and other circumstances (H Beecham and Co Pty Ltd v Francis Howard and Co Pty Ltd [1921] VLR 428). 9. Also Patricia was not aware of the defect prior to sale and any inspection made by Patricia would not have revealed the defect. The term of merchantable quality has clearly been breached. 10. The next implied term that has been breached is fitness for purpose under section 71(2) of the Trade Practices Act. Second-hand goods such as the photocopier are generally expected to not be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625). Also under this term the buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgement. 11. Patricia described to the salesperson that she needed the photocopier for her business of copying theses, and asked whether it could do a number of specialised tasks. The salesperson said that it could do all this and more, Patricia relied on the salesperson knowledge and therefore signed the contact (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110). However the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson and she had to replace the lens and hire the photocopier for 14 days. 12. The final implied term that has been breached is the term of correspondence with description under section 70 of the Trade Practices Act. This term is concerned with those matters that serve to identify the goods sold. The salesperson identified the photocopier as having only done 1000 copies and she thought it was last year's model, she also said that they had no complaints about that particular model. However the lens had to be replaced, and that usually only occurs after 200,000 copies, also Joe from Joe's Office Rentals told her that the photocopier was 5 years old and there had been numerous complaints about that model (Beale v Taylor [1967] 1 WLR 1193). As Patricia relied on what Shirley said and it convinced her to sign the contract to purchase the photocopier, the term of correspondence with description has been breached. 13. The Trade Practices Act does not allow terms to be excluded under section 68. If any term of the contract that purports to exclude, restrict or modify or has the effect of excluding restricting or modifying sections of the Trade Practices Act is void 14. Patricia will not be able to terminate the contract as the contact is already complete, she has the photocopier and Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd has the $35,000. Also if she terminated the contract she would still have the decrepit photocopier and Bob's would still have the money. 15. However she may try to rescind the contract for misrepresentation, as Shirley misrepresented the facts by stating that the photocopier had only done 1000 copies, she thought it was last year's model and that there had not been any complaints about that model. These misrepresented statements induced Patricia into buying the photocopier; therefore she may rescind the contract. 16. Rescinding a contract means that the parties involved are returned to the position they were in before the contract was formed. So Patricia would return the photocopier to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd and Bob would return Patricia's $35,000 as well as the $10,000 for the new lens and the $1400 for the hire of the other photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies. However, since section 52 of the Trade Practices Act was enacted, rescission has become less important and the courts may be reluctant to grant it as a remedy. 17. The other option that Patricia has is to sue for damages, which is the most common remedy granted. The losses must be caused by the breach of the contract and the plaintiff has a duty to mitigate losses. Also the losses must not be too remote, which means that the losses must either flow from the breach according to the usual course of things or be losses that D was aware of prior to the contract (Hadley v Baxendale [1854] 156 ER 145) 18. The damages that Patricia could sue for in this case is the $10,000 for the new lens as she bought the photocopier under the misconception that it had only done 1000 copies. She should not have had to buy a new lens and therefore Bob's Warehouse should cover those damages as they are caused by the breach of the contract and they flow from the breach in the usual course of things. 19. The hiring of the photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies for 14 days at $100 a day amounted to $1400 worth of damages. Patricia could sue for these damages as the hiring of the new photocopier was caused by the breach in the contract. Patricia told the salesperson of her business in copying theses and the requirements that she needed in a photocopier so Bob's Warehouse was aware of the losses that would be caused by the faulty photocopier. 20. Finally Patricia may with extreme difficulty be able to sue for damages for disappointment and distress (Jarvis v Swan Tours Ltd [1973] 1 QB 233). Courts have generally been reluctant to grant damages for disappointment and distress in commercial cases. 21. Patricia may attempt to prove that she was extremely distressed when she received a $50,000 contract from the university's business faculty and had to find other means to be able to honour that contract. Also she may have been distressed when she found out she had to pay $10,000 for the lens, also that the photocopier was actually only approximately worth $15,000. The most difficult thing in granting damages for distress is the amount of damages to be awarded. In this case I would believe that only $20,000 could be granted as that is the difference between the estimated price of the photocopier and the price Patricia paid. 22. The best step for Patricia would be to rescind the contract, however as I said earlier that is sometimes not granted. The next step would be damages however Patricia would be unlikely to receive damages for her distress so she would receive $11,400 for the lens and the hiring of the other photocopier. Structure of legal arguments Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. When you are developing your response to your problem question, you need to develop legal arguments. Study these paragraphs below taken from Part 2 of the sample assignment. These two paragraphs should be combined as they both contain the legal argument concerning the implied term of fitness for purpose. Question 1 What are the types of information or the 'moves' in the following legal argument? 10. The next implied term that has been breached is fitness for purpose under section 71(2) of the Trade Practices Act. Second-hand goods such as the photocopier are generally expected to not be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625). Also under this term the buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgement. 11. Patricia described to the salesperson that she needed the photocopier for her business of copying theses, and asked whether it could do a number of specialised tasks. The salesperson said that it could do all this and more, Patricia relied on the salesperson knowledge and therefore signed the contact (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110). However the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson and she had to replace the lens and hire photocopier for 14 days. [1] Check your answer [1] Information relevant to this legal argument The issue for examination (fitness for purpose) The law about fitness for purpose The facts that are relevant to this area of law from the problem Interpretation of the facts in relation to the law The outcome of the analysis of the relevant facts in relation to the law Question 2 Do you think that these aspects are components of a legal argument? Yes No [2] Check your answer [2] If you answered yes, you are correct. In a legal argument, you must always identify the area of law you are investigating, tell your reader what that law says, look at and interpret the relevant facts from your problem in relation to the law. Arrive at a conclusion of the situation when you have done this. Question 3 Match the points listed below to the types of information appropriate to a legal argument. However, photocopier not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson; she had to replace the lens and hire a photocopier for 14 days. Second hand goods such as photocopier: not expected to be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625) Patricia: told salesman that she needed photocopier for her business (copying theses), and inquired if photocopier could do several specialized tasks. Salesman said photocopier could do all this and more. Next implied term breached: fitness for purpose, section 71(2) Trade Practices Act. Under implied term fitness for purpose for second hand goods, buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgment. Patricia relied on salesperson's knowledge and signed the contract (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110) Question 4 Using this information above, see if you can re-organise it and form it into a legal argument. Type your response into the text box below. [3] Check your answer [3] See if your response is similar to the legal argument below, which is a suitable way of organising and expressing the information in a legal argument. The next implied term that has been breached is fitness for purpose under section 71(2) of the Trade Practices Act. Second-hand goods such as the photocopier are generally expected to not be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625). Also under this term the buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgement. Patricia described to the salesperson that she needed the photocopier for her business of copying theses, and asked whether it could do a number of specialised tasks. The salesperson said that it could do all this and more, Patricia relied on the salesperson's knowledge and therefore signed the contact (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110). However the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson and she had to replace the lens and hire photocopier for 14 days. Other Commercial Law resources Additional resources available to you on Commercial Law include: Crosling, G and Murphy, H. (2000) How to study Business Law (3rd edition.) Butterworths, Sydney. Q Manual, Faculty of Business and Economics http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/ <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/> Annotated assignments Topic: Commercial Law assignment Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this assignment Steve's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.2.xml> : See Steve's assignment before he received feedback on it Steve's assignment and what his lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.3.xml> : Read the lecturer's comments on this assignment Interview with Steve <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml> : Listen to Steve talk about the writing process The annotated assignments and the writing approaches described by students should not be seen as ideal models for you to copy. They are intended to be a general guide to writing in your subject and to help you to reflect on your own approach. Steve's assignment Steve is a first-year Commercial Law student. His assignment for the subject is a case involving the legal rights of a consumer against a business. Assignment topic: This assignment involves the legal rights and responsibilities of Patricia Wu and Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd. [1]View the whole assignment question here. 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Steve's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.2.xml> . o How well do you think the assignment responds to the topic? o Do you think the assignment could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.3.xml> about Steve's assignment. 4. Finally, listen to Steve <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml> talk about how he wrote his assignment and read feedback about how to overcome the difficulties he faced. [1] Assignment - Semester 2, 2000 Patricia Wu had recently opened up her own office supplies business 'Wu's Wonders' which deals mainly with students at a local University. In addition to selling pens and paper, Patricia also provides copying services for students, particularly science and medical students. She specialises in the copying and binding of student theses. One day her photocopier broke down and she went to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd to purchase a new one. Several were displayed, including a second-hand one, manufactured by Kojack Ltd. It had a huge sign on it saying 'Great Bargain. Low mileage. Almost as good as new. Buy now and save!! Yours for $35,000.' Patricia asked Shirley, the salesperson, what 'low mileage' meant. Shirley explained that the machine had hardly been used and had only completed 1,000 copies. Patricia then asked how old it was. Shirley replied, ' Oh I'm not 100 % sure but I think it is last year's model'. Patricia told Shirley about her business of copying theses, which included photographs, and then asked if the copier could do a number of specialised tasks, such as colour copies, double-siding, collating, stapling and reducing. Most importantly, she asked whether it was capable of producing large quantities of copies quickly and without breaking down. Shirley reassured her and said: 'This copier will do all that and more. It has the best quality lens for really clear reproductions. You'll have no problem and anyway we provide a month's free service. We have had no complaints about this model.' Patricia then signed a contract of purchase, buying the copier for $35,000. When using the copier, Patricia soon realised that not all copies were clear, the colours appeared to be 'washed-out' and 'red' was always 'pink'. She rang Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who sent out a repairman to service the machine. The next day the copier broke down and the repairman explained that it needed a new lens valued at $10,000. Patricia, who had just recently obtained a contract, valued at $50,000, to provide copying services to the University's Faculty of Business, was placed in a stressful position. In order to honour this contract, Patricia had to lease another copier from 'Joe's Office Rentals' at $100 a day for a total of 14 days. When Patricia explained her story to Joe, he laughed and said that that particular model of copier was always breaking down and had been recalled by the manufacturer due to the overwhelming number of complaints. He also said that it was about 5 years old and explained that normally a lens only needed replacing after 200,000 copies had been made. Furthermore, he believed the copier was only worth approximately $15,000. When the new lens arrived, Patricia's troubles continued. The machine could not reduce and produce doublesided copies simultaneously. It could perform each task separately, but not simultaneously. Bob sent Patricia an account for the new lens, which Patricia refused to pay because she thought it was included in the first month's free service. Bob replied that the service deal didn't include spare parts, just the labour costs. Patricia re-read the contract. Although it contained a clause which stated that there was one month's free service, the meaning of 'service' was not stated. She did however, notice the following clause: 'Any conditions, statutory or otherwise, not contained herein are excluded.' [a] What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd arising out of the above set of facts? Explain your answer. [15 marks] [b] What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd if the price for the photocopier was $45,000? Explain your answer. [15 marks] Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Brendan Sweeney - sets out what he expects from student assignments on this topic. How I would expect students to go about researching and writing an answer to this particular task Students must explain their answer in the sense that it is not sufficient just to say that Patricia might have an action for damages for breach of contract and then set out the basis for an action of this nature. Students must explain why Patricia (in respect of the facts given) would or would not succeed. This question could easily be answered without recourse to any other material than the text book. We expect students to recognize the key difference between Part A and Part B of the question. This could significantly alter the way in which they write their answer. Having said that, however, we are not out to punish those who may not have adopted the most rational and efficient approach. This is more a matter of the better students being rewarded for thinking through the best way to structure their answer. I think the question is difficult because of the thought that is required to plan the answer properly. Planning (or lack thereof) is a key issue in some of the papers I have corrected. I think the difference in planning stood out between the Fails and the Credits (and above). Steve's sample assignment Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic Part 1 Clearly a contract exists here. The issue is what, if any, legal rights Patricia Wu have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd after having purchased the photocopier for $35,000. Patricia best course of action would be under the Trade Practices Act (Cth) 1974 or the Goods Act (Vic) . However as there is an exclusion clause in this contract the Goods Act will not apply as under section 61 of the act exclusion clauses are permitted. The Trade Practices Act however does not permit exclusion clauses under section 68. She would look toward section 4 to see if the Trade Practices Act does apply in these circumstances. There are four steps in testing whether the Trade Practices Act applies. Step one is to check whether the seller is a corporation, Patricia purchased the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who are clearly a corporation as they have proprietorship limited attached after their name. Step two is whether the contract is a consumer contract. A consumer contract is when the price of goods is less than $40,000 or the goods are normally used in a domestic or household situation. As the photocopier was $35,000 it is a consumer contract as it is less than the prescribed amount. Step three is whether the sale was in the course of business. This means that the sale was done by a licensed seller and bought by a consumer, not just a sale between two people. Patricia bought the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd so it is clearly in the course of business. The final step is that the sale was not at an auction. As the photocopier was bought from Bob's and not at an auction the Trade Practices Act obviously applies. However Patricia must prove that the contract has been breached. The first way to see if it has is by seeing if any of the express terms have been breached, as the contract was a contract of purchase it would only contain terms relating to purchase, sale, warranties and the exclusion clause. As none of the express terms have been breached the next step would be to see if any of the implied terms have been breached. The first implied term that has been breached is the term of merchantable quality under section 71(1) of the Trade Practices Act. Merchantable quality is when a good is fit for the purpose it is reasonable to expect the good will is used for. The photocopier that Patricia bought is not of merchantable quality as the goods are not fit for the purpose that it is reasonable to expect having regard to price and other circumstances (H Beecham and Co Pty Ltd v Francis Howard and Co Pty Ltd [1921] VLR 428). Also Patricia was not aware of the defect prior to sale and any inspection made by Patricia would not have revealed the defect. The term of merchantable quality has clearly been breached. The next implied term that has been breached is fitness for purpose under section 71(2) of the Trade Practices Act. Second-hand goods such as the photocopier are generally expected to not be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625). Also under this term the buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgement. Patricia described to the salesperson that she needed the photocopier for her business of copying theses, and asked whether it could do a number of specialised tasks. The salesperson said that it could do all this and more, Patricia relied on the salesperson knowledge and therefore signed the contact (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110). However the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson and she had to replace the lens and hire photocopier for 14 days. The final implied term that has been breached is the term of correspondence with description under section 70 of the Trade Practices Act. This term is concerned with those matters that serve to identify the goods sold. The salesperson identified the photocopier as having only done 1000 copies and she thought it was last year's mode, she also said that they had no complaints about that particular model. However the lens had to be replaced, and that usually only occurs after 200,000 copies, also Joe from Joe's Office Rentals told her that the photocopier was 5 years old and there had been numerous complaints about that model (Beale v Taylor [1967] 1 WLR 1193). As Patricia relied on what Shirley said and it convinced her to sign the contract to purchase the photocopier, the term of correspondence with description has been breached. The Trade Practices Act does not allow terms to be excluded under section 68. If any term of the contract that purports to exclude, restrict or modify or has the effect of excluding restricting or modifying sections of the Trade Practices Act is void. Patricia will not be able to terminate the contract as the contact is already complete, she has the photocopier and Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd has the $35,000. Also if she terminated the contract she would still have the decrepit photocopier and Bob's would still have the money. However she may try to rescind the contract for misrepresentation, as Shirley misrepresented the facts by stating that the photocopier had only done 1000 copies, she thought it was last years model and that there had not been any complaints about that model. These misrepresented statements induced Patricia into buying the photocopier; therefore she may rescind the contract. Rescinding a contract means that the parties involved are returned to the position they were in before the contract was formed. So Patricia would return the photocopier to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd and Bob would return Patricia's $35,000 as well as the $10,000 for the new lens and the $1400 for the hire of the other photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies. However since section 52 of the Trade Practices Act was enacted rescission has become less important and the courts may be reluctant to grant it as a remedy. The other option that Patricia has is to sue for damages, which is the most common remedy granted. The losses must be caused by the breach of the contract and the plaintiff has a duty to mitigate losses. Also the losses must not be too remote, which means that the losses must either flow from the breach according to the usual course of things or be losses that D was aware of prior to the contract (Hadley v Baxendale [1854] 156 ER 145) The damages that Patricia could sue for in this case is the $10,000 for the new lens as the she bought the photocopier under the misconception that it had only done 1000 copies. She should not have had to buy a new lens and therefore Bob's Warehouse should cover those damages as they are caused by the breach of the contract and they flow from the breach in the usual course of things. The hiring of the photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies for 14 days at $100 a day amounted to $1400 worth of damages. Patricia could sue for these damages as the hiring of the new photocopier was caused by the breach in the contract. Patricia told the salesperson of her business in copying theses and the requirements that she needed in a photocopier so Bob's Warehouse was aware of the losses that would be caused by the faulty photocopier. Finally Patricia may with extreme difficulty be able sue for damages for disappointment and distress (Jarvis v Swan Tours Ltd [1973] 1 QB 233). Courts have generally been reluctant to grant damages for disappointment and distress in commercial cases. Patricia may attempt to prove that she was extremely distressed when she received a $50,000 contract from the university's business faculty and had to find other means to be able to honour that contract. Also she may have been distressed when she found out she had to pay $10,000 for the lens also that the photocopier was actually only approximately worth $15,000. The most difficult thing in granting damages for distress is the amount of damages to be awarded. In this case I would believe that only $20,000 could be granted as that is the difference between the estimated price of the photocopier and the price Patricia paid. The best step for Patricia would be to rescind the contract, however as I said earlier that is sometimes not granted. The next step would be damages however Patricia would be unlikely to receive damages for her distress so she would receive $11,400 for the lens and the hiring of the other photocopier. Part 2 Under the second situation, where the photocopier was purchased for $45,000 the Trade Practices Act will not apply as the good was over $40,000 and is not of a type that is normally used in household or domestic use. As this is a non-consumer contract Patricia may try to use the Goods Act however section 61 states that exclusion clauses are permitted in non-consumer contracts as businesses are normally on equal terms and do not need protection. The only legal rights available to Patricia under these circumstances are to attempt to sue for misrepresentation. The first step would be to see which type of misrepresentation she could sue for. The two areas are the torts of deceit and negligence. Fraudulent misrepresentation is extremely difficult to prove. There are three steps involved; step one is that a false representation of fact was made (Smith v Land and House Property Corp [1884] 28 Ch D 7). Under the circumstances in this situation a false representation was made as Shirley stated that the photocopier had only completed 1000 copies when it had more likely completed 200,000. Step two is whether the representation was intended to and did induce the representee to act (Holmes v Jones [1907] 4 CLR 1692 High Court). This is one of the harder steps to prove, as we do not know whether Shirley actually used the false fact of the photocopier having only done 1000 copies to induce Patricia into buying the good. However as Shirley is a salesperson in the store and more than likely knew how many copies the photocopier had done she probably did use those false facts to induce Patricia. The final step is whether the representor made the false representation knowing it to be untrue, or was reckless as to whether it was true or not (Derry v Peek [1889] 14 App Cas 337). Shirley may not have known whether the number of copies it had done was true but she recklessly did not know and she should have known. Therefore Shirley and Bob's Warehouse were fraudulent in the sale of the Photocopier. Under the tort of deceit it is not possible to exclude liability as a person is not entitled to take advantage of his or her own deceit. However due to the difficulty in proving fraud Patricia may attempt to prove negligent misrepresentation. There are also three steps in proving negligence, step one is whether the representor owed a duty of care. A duty of care was originally only owed for the chance of the goods harming somebody physically or mentally. However since Shaddock and associates Pty Ltd v Parramatta City Council (1981) 55 ALJR 713, a purely economic loss can also be considered in the duty of care. Under Patricia's circumstances a duty of care was owed as Bob's Warehouse was told that she was in the business of copying theses and needed a photocopier that could do specific jobs. However the photocopier was sold in a poor condition that caused Patricia to buy a new lens for the photocopier and also to have to hire a new photocopier at a cost of $1400 for 14 days. The second step is the standard of care owed. The standard of care is what a reasonable person in the community would expect be owed knowing the qualifications and means of the person or company. Under these circumstances Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd specialises in photocopiers. Therefore they should know how many copies the photocopier had and its capabilities, also exactly what model it was. The final step is the remoteness of the damage. Under the circumstances in this situation Patricia could get damages for the lens and the hiring of the photocopier, so a total of $11,400. However there is also a possibility that the exclusion clause at the end of the contact could remove Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd duty of care in this case. Patricia's best course of action would be to attempt to sue for fraudulent misrepresentation, as the exclusion clause will not be included. Also if the facts of the case point toward deceit there is a much higher chance of winning the case and receiving damages. The problem with negligent misrepresentation in this case is the exclusion clause. The facts of the case point toward a fraudulent misrepresentation due to the false representation of the number of copies that the photocopier had completed, this induced Patricia into the contract so deceit was involved. If I was advising Patricia on the legal rights that she had and what course of action to take I would use fraudulent misrepresentation. The remedies that she would receive under this situation would be damages for the lens and the hiring of the other photocopier, so a total of $11,400. [1] Assignment - Semester 2, 2000 Patricia Wu had recently opened up her own office supplies business 'Wu's Wonders' which deals mainly with students at a local university. In addition to selling pens and paper, Patricia also provides copying services for students, particularly science and medical students. She specialises in the copying and binding of student theses. One day her photocopier broke down and she went to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd to purchase a new one. Several were displayed, including a second-hand one, manufactured by Kojack Ltd. It had a huge sign on it saying 'Great Bargain. Low mileage. Almost as good as new. Buy now and save!! Yours for $35,000.' Patricia asked Shirley, the salesperson, what 'low mileage' meant. Shirley explained that the machine had hardly been used and had only completed 1,000 copies. Patricia then asked how old it was. Shirley replied, ' Oh I'm not 100 % sure but I think it is last year's model'. Patricia told Shirley about her business of copying theses, which included photographs, and then asked if the copier could do a number of specialised tasks, such as colour copies, double-siding, collating, stapling and reducing. Most importantly, she asked whether it was capable of producing large quantities of copies quickly and without breaking down. Shirley reassured her and said: 'This copier will do all that and more. It has the best quality lens for really clear reproductions. You'll have no problem and anyway we provide a month's free service. We have had no complaints about this model.' Patricia then signed a contract of purchase, buying the copier for $35,000. When using the copier, Patricia soon realised that not all copies were clear, the colours appeared to be 'washed-out' and 'red' was always 'pink'. She rang Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who sent out a repairman to service the machine. The next day the copier broke down and the repairman explained that it needed a new lens valued at $10,000. Patricia, who had just recently obtained a contract, valued at $50,000, to provide copying services to the university's Faculty of Business, was placed in a stressful position. In order to honour this contract, Patricia had to lease another copier from 'Joe's Office Rentals' at $100 a day for a total of 14 days. When Patricia explained her story to Joe, he laughed and said that that particular model of copier was always breaking down and had been recalled by the manufacturer due to the overwhelming number of complaints. He also said that it was about 5 years old and explained that normally a lens only needed replacing after 200,000 copies had been made. Furthermore, he believed the copier was only worth approximately $15,000. When the new lens arrived, Patricia's troubles continued. The machine could not reduce and produce doublesided copies simultaneously. It could perform each task separately, but not simultaneously. Bob sent Patricia an account for the new lens, which Patricia refused to pay because she thought it was included in the first month's free service. Bob replied that the service deal didn't include spare parts, just the labour costs. Patricia re-read the contract. Although it contained a clause which stated that there was one month's free service, the meaning of 'service' was not stated. She did however, notice the following clause: 'Any conditions, statutory or otherwise, not contained herein are excluded.' [a] What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd arising out of the above set of facts? Explain your answer. [15 marks] [b] What legal rights (including remedies) would Patricia have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd if the price for the photocopier was $45,000? Explain your answer. [15 marks] Steve's assignment and what his lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Part 1 [IMG-1] [1]Clearly a contract exists here. The issue is what, if any, legal rights Patricia Wu might have against Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd after having purchased the photocopier for $35,000. Patricia's best course of action would be under the Trade Practices Act (Cth) 1974 or the Goods Act (Vic) . However as there is an exclusion clause in this contract the Goods Act will not apply as under section 61 of the act exclusion clauses are permitted. The Trade Practices Act however does not permit exclusion clauses under section 68. She would look toward section 4 to see if the Trade Practices Act does apply in these circumstances. There are four steps in testing whether the Trade Practices Act applies. Step one is to check whether the seller is a corporation, Patricia purchased the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd who are clearly a corporation as they have proprietorship limited attached after their name. [IMG-2] [2]Step two is whether the contract is a consumer contract. A consumer contract is when the price of goods is less than $40,000 or the goods are normally used in a domestic or household situation. As the photocopier was $35,000 it is a consumer contract as it is less than the prescribed amount. Step three is whether the sale was in the course of business. This means that the sale was done by a licensed seller and bought by a consumer, not just a sale between two people. Patricia bought the photocopier from Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd so it is clearly in the course of business. The final step is that the sale was not at an auction. As the photocopier was bought from Bob's and not at an auction the Trade Practices Act obviously applies. [IMG-3] However Patricia must prove that the contract has been breached. The first way to see if it has is by seeing if any of the express terms have been breached, as the contract was a contract of purchase it would only contain terms relating to purchase, sale, warranties and the exclusion clause. [3]As none of the express terms have been breached the next step would be to see if any of the implied terms have been breached. [IMG-4] [4]The first implied term that has been breached is the term of merchantable quality under section 71(1) of the Trade Practices Act. Merchantable quality is when a good is fit for the purpose it is reasonable to expect the good will be used for. The photocopier that Patricia bought is not of merchantable quality as the goods are not fit for the purpose that it is reasonable to expect having regard to price and other circumstances (H Beecham and Co Pty Ltd v Francis Howard and Co Pty Ltd [1921] VLR 428). Also Patricia was not aware of the defect prior to sale and any inspection made by Patricia would not have revealed the defect. The term of merchantable quality has clearly been breached. The next implied term that has been breached is fitness for purpose under section 71(2) of the Trade Practices Act. Second-hand goods such as the photocopier are generally expected to not be as fit as new goods (Atkinson v Hastings Deering (Qld) Pty Ltd [1985] ATPR 40-625). Also under this term the buyer must rely on seller's skill and judgement. Patricia described to the salesperson that she needed the photocopier for her business of copying theses, and asked whether it could do a number of specialised tasks. The salesperson said that it could do all this and more, Patricia relied on the salesperson knowledge and therefore signed the contact (David Jones Ltd v Willis [1934] 52 CLR 110). However the photocopier was not fit for the purpose that Patricia described to the salesperson and she had to replace the lens and hire photocopier for 14 days. The final implied term that has been breached is the term of correspondence with description under section 70 of the Trade Practices Act. This term is concerned with those matters that serve to identify the goods sold. The salesperson identified the photocopier as having only done 1000 copies and she thought it was last year's model, she also said that they had no complaints about that particular model. However the lens had to be replaced, and that usually only occurs after 200,000 copies, also Joe from Joe's Office Rentals told her that the photocopier was 5 years old and there had been numerous complaints about that model (Beale v Taylor [1967] 1 WLR 1593). As Patricia relied on what Shirley said and it convinced her to sign the contract to purchase the photocopier, the term of correspondence with description has been breached. [IMG-5] [5]The Trade Practices Act does not allow terms to be excluded under section 68. If any term of the contract that purports to exclude, restrict or modify or has the effect of excluding restricting or modifying sections of the Trade Practices Act is void. Patricia will not be able to terminate the contract as the contact is already complete, she has the photocopier and Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd has the $35,000. Also if she terminated the contract she would still have the decrepit photocopier and Bob's would still have the money. [IMG-6] [6]However she may try to rescind the contract for misrepresentation, as Shirley misrepresented the facts by stating that the photocopier had only done 1000 copies, she thought it was last years model and that there had not been any complaints about that model. These misrepresented statements induced Patricia into buying the photocopier; therefore she may rescind the contract. Rescinding a contract means that the parties involved are returned to the position they were in before the contract was formed. So Patricia would return the photocopier to Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd and Bob would return Patricia's $35,000 as well as the $10,000 for the new lens and the $1400 for the hire of the other photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies. [IMG-7] [7]However since section 52 of the Trade Practices Act was enacted rescission has become less important and the courts may be reluctant to grant it as a remedy. The other option that Patricia has is to sue for damages, which is the most common remedy granted. The losses must be caused by the breach of the contract and the plaintiff has a duty to mitigate losses. Also the losses must not be too remote, which means that the losses must either flow from the breach according to the usual course of things or be losses that D was aware of prior to the contract (Hadley v Baxendale [1854] 156 ER 145) The damages that Patricia could sue for in this case is the $10,000 for the new lens as she bought the photocopier under the misconception that it had only done 1000 copies. She should not have had to buy a new lens and therefore Bob's Warehouse should cover those damages as they are caused by the breach of the contract and they flow from the breach in the usual course of things. The hiring of the photocopier from Joe's Office Supplies for 14 days at $100 a day amounted to $1400 worth of damages. Patricia could sue for these damages as the hiring of the new photocopier was caused by the breach in the contract. Patricia told the salesperson of her business in copying theses and the requirements that she needed in a photocopier so Bob's Warehouse was aware of the losses that would be caused by the faulty photocopier. [IMG-8] [8]Finally Patricia may with extreme difficulty be able sue for damages for disappointment and distress (Jarvis v Swan Tours Ltd [1973] 1 QB 233). Courts have generally been reluctant to grant damages for disappointment and distress in commercial cases. Patricia may attempt to prove that she was extremely distressed when she received a $50,000 contract from the university's business faculty and had to find other means to be able to honour that contract. Also she may have been distressed when she found out she had to pay $10,000 for the lens also that the photocopier was actually only approximately worth $15,000. The most difficult thing in granting damages for distress is the amount of damages to be awarded. In this case I would believe that only $20,000 could be granted as that is the difference between the estimated price of the photocopier and the price Patricia paid. The best step for Patricia would be to rescind the contract, however as I said earlier that is sometimes not granted. The next step would be damages however Patricia would be unlikely to receive damages for her distress so she would receive $11,400 for the lens and the hiring of the other photocopier. Part 2 Under the second situation, where the photocopier was purchased for $45,000 the Trade Practices Act will not apply as the good was over $40,000 and is not of a type that is normally used in household or domestic use. As this is a non-consumer contract Patricia may try to use the Goods Act however section 61 states that exclusion clauses are permitted in non-consumer contracts as businesses are normally on equal terms and do not need protection. [IMG-9] [9]The only legal rights available to Patricia under these circumstances are to attempt to sue for misrepresentation. The first step would be to see which type of misrepresentation she could sue for. The two areas are the torts of deceit and negligence. [IMG-10] [10]Fraudulent misrepresentation is extremely difficult to prove. There are three steps involved; step one is that a false representation of fact was made (Smith v Land and House Property Corp [1884] 28 Ch D 7). Under the circumstances in this situation a false representation was made as Shirley stated that the photocopier had only completed 1000 copies when it had more likely completed 200,000. Step two is whether the representation was intended to and did induce the representee to act (Holmes v Jones [1907] 4 CLR 1692 High Court). This is one of the harder steps to prove, as we do not know whether Shirley actually used the false fact of the photocopier having only done 1000 copies to induce Patricia into buying the good. However as Shirley is a salesperson in the store and more than likely knew how many copies the photocopier had done she probably did use those false facts to induce Patricia. The final step is whether the representor made the false representation knowing it to be untrue, or was reckless as to whether it was true or not (Derry v Peek [1889] 14 App Cas 337). Shirley may not have known whether the number of copies it had done was true but she recklessly did not know and she should have known. Therefore Shirley and Bob's Warehouse were fraudulent in the sale of the Photocopier. Under the tort of deceit it is not possible to exclude liability as a person is not entitled to take advantage of his or her own deceit. However due to the difficulty in proving fraud Patricia may attempt to prove negligent misrepresentation. There are also three steps in proving negligence, step one is whether the representor owed a duty of care. A duty of care was originally only owed for the chance of the goods harming somebody physically or mentally. However since Shaddock and associates Pty Ltd v Parramatta City Council (1981) 55 ALJR 713, a purely economic loss can also be considered in the duty of care. Under Patricia's circumstances a duty of care was owed as Bob's Warehouse was told that she was in the business of copying theses and needed a photocopier that could do specific jobs. However the photocopier was sold in a poor condition that caused Patricia to buy a new lens for the photocopier and also to have to hire a new photocopier at a cost of $1400 for 14 days. The second step is the standard of care owed. The standard of care is what a reasonable person in the community would expect be owed knowing the qualifications and means of the person or company. Under these circumstances Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd specialises in photocopiers. Therefore they should know how many copies the photocopier had and its capabilities, also exactly what model it was. The final step is the remoteness of the damage. Under the circumstances in this situation Patricia could get damages for the lens and the hiring of the photocopier, so a total of $11,400. However there is also a possibility that the exclusion clause at the end of the contact could remove Bob's Warehouse Pty Ltd duty of care in this case. Patricia's best course of action would be to attempt to sue for fraudulent misrepresentation, as the exclusion clause will not be included. Also if the facts of the case point toward deceit there is a much higher chance of winning the case and receiving damages. The problem with negligent misrepresentation in this case is the exclusion clause. The facts of the case point toward a fraudulent misrepresentation due to the false representation of the number of copies that the photocopier had completed, this induced Patricia into the contract so deceit was involved. If I was advising Patricia on the legal rights that she had and what course of action to take I would use fraudulent misrepresentation. The remedies that she would receive under this situation would be damages for the lens and the hiring of the other photocopier, so a total of $11,400. [IMG-11] [11] [Lecturer's Overall comment] [1] Concise This is good. In a problem-based assignment there is no need for a lengthy introduction. The parameters of the ensuing discussion have already been set by the facts of the case. [2] TPA s 4 B There should be some reference in the paragraph to the fact that the goods were not bought for resale. [3] Is this correct? The facts do not support such an unconditional statement. On the contrary, they indicate that there has probably been a breach of an express warranty. This whole paragraph should be deleted from the paper. [4] Good The discussion on the implied terms is good. In particular the student has discussed the facts of the problem. The student has correctly referred to the relevant sections of the Trade Practices Act. The student referred correctly to cases that support his argument. [5] "the implied" Section 68 of the Trade Practices Act does not apply to all terms within a contract. It is only relevant to the terms 'implied' by virtue of the Trade Practices Act (i.e. merchantable quality, fitness for purpose, correspondence with description). [6] TPA s 75A The TPA s75A gives the buyer the right to return the goods. Patricia did not need to rely on rescission for misrepresentation. [7] Relevance The final sentence of this paragraph is irrelevant. Generally the student has avoided the trap of quoting passages from text books. This is one case, however, where he has paraphrased a sentence from the text book without considering whether it adds anything to the argument he is developing. [8] An unlikely remedy Damages for distress in this context are so unlikely that the student must consider whether it is worthwhile even mentioning it. However, it should be said that the student's comments are not incorrect. [9] Why not breach the warranty? The conclusion is not correct. The exemption clause does not exclude liability for all breaches, only breaches of conditions (statutory or otherwise). Therefore, Patricia could seek damages for breach of a warranty. The student failed to examine the exemption clause closely. [10] Good, but why not s 52 TPA? The discussion on fraud and negligence is good. However, if fraud and negligence may apply, why wouldn't s 52 TPA? [11] Lecturer's overall comment The approach to answering the assignment is very good. It is well planned. It concentrates on the facts of the problem. The critical difference between Part 1 and Part 2 of the question (i.e. the application of the Trade Practices Act) is clearly articulated. But, there are three mistakes that prevented the student from obtaining a higher mark: Part 1 - no discussion on the remedy provided under the TPA s75A; Part 2 - no consideration given to the possibility of seeking damages for breach of an express warranty; Part 2 - no discussion on the possibility of a breach of s 52 of the TPA. Steve's comments How did you feel when you were doing your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I was doing my Commercial Law assignment, I felt at ease as I felt that I knew what I was doing and I thought that I was going to get a good mark How did you feel about the assignment after you had handed it in? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The final paper that I handed in, I was very pleased with, as I was happy with everything I had done, I thought I had done a very good job. How did you feel when you had handed in your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I finally handed my assignment in, I felt relieved as it was another assignment out of the way and I could focus on the other assignments that I had to do. How did you feel when you got your assignment mark? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I got my result I was very happy as to me it was a good result for what I had done and it showed that I'd did my job very well. How effective do you think your approach to the assignment was? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I felt that with my assignment, my approach was fairly effective as it gave me a good structure and I used many cases and I ended up with a fairly good result. The way which I believe I could of improved it was by doing more as it would of helped me with more cases and more acts and laws which were more relevant than the ones which I had used. What have you learnt from completing the Commercial Law assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I completed my assignment it gave me a knowledge on how to write law assignments much better than I had before and also how to write university assignments in a more grammatical manner. It gave me a knowledge of Commercial Law in the Acts and the cases which I had to do for the assignment as does it taught me exactly what occurs when those cases are used and what has to happen for that law to be relevant to a certain case. What have you come to understand about university study from Semester 1 to Semester 2 of your first year? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Once you learn second semester, you know how university works, you know what you have to do when you go to lectures, you know what you have to do when you go to tutorials. You know more how to write the assignments and what to do in exams and it helps you a lot as it gives you knowledge and it helps you to write the assignments better and you are not so stressed as most people are in first semester. You learn how to deal with how the university works in second semester by the experience you had in first semester, and also the university does help by, with the university union and the information they give you on how to write the assignments and things and what to do in exams and any help they can give you and things like that. Students that are stressed in first semester, they cope with it by just getting their work done and getting it over and done with and then they can relax after that. Others just can't really handle the stress and they just get their work done but they don't always get the best results but most students just get their work done and they just try and ignore the stress and then just get everything over and done with in first semester. How did you go about completing your Commercial Law assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The lecturers and tutors gave a lot of assistance to the students in the classes as, if you ever wanted any help you just have to go up and ask them a question and they told you and they are your structure for the assignment, they told you what cases could be relevant and it helped a lot when you had to write the assignment. What assistance did you get in completing your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I first worked the assignment I started by doing a lot of research with the text book that we got given in the class as well as going to the library and hiring some of the textbooks and one's which were based entirely on the act and then I continued them up by taking notes down and doing a rough draft, rough plan and draft of my assignment and then after I had done a final draft I did my final presentation..... How did your friends help in completing your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> My friends, when I was doing an assignment were very helpful as you ask each other questions and you gave each other ideas for what cases might be, needed to be used or what parts of the laws were relevant to the assignment. We also gave each other support when you were doing the assignment and it helped a lot. Regarding when I was, when we were working with friends by, giving each other ideas but not giving our entire idea so that we didn't, our assignments didn't look that entirely similar, they just had some ideas which were vaguely similar and that's all. How did you go about interpreting the task? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I was interpreting the topics and actually finding out how to do the assignment, the best way that I went about it was by listening to the tutor and the lecturer, in the lectures and tutorials and asking many questions of the lecturer and tutor and also reading the text book helped a lot as it gave a very good basis for the knowledge that you had to know for the assignment. How did you research for your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/commercial-law/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The research I did for an assignment was mainly in the library where I hired multiple books on the acts that we were using as well as other legal studies and Commercial Law books, as well as the text book that we were given for the class and I just read through those relevant areas and took notes on all the areas I needed to and use that in my assignment. How did you cope with the reading for your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Legal textbooks are not very difficult to understand as they are written in a more layman's manner than the acts are. The acts are very difficult to understand as they are written in a legal manner and that is very hard to understand and follow. I helped myself in understanding the acts by going to the tutor in the lectures and asking bits of the acts, which I did not understand and they helped a lot in that area. How did you find out what your lecturer expected in your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> You worked out exactly what the lecturer and tutor wanted by going to the lecturing tutor and asking questions and looking at past assignments and doing your down research. It gave you a basis on what you had to do. How did you know how to structure your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> In the writing of an assignment the structure was given to us by the lecturer and the tutor and they showed us exactly how they wanted us to write the assignment, in what order we needed to do it and also they offered us cases which could be relevant to the assignment. How did you know how to develop legal arguments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> They give you clues on developing a legal argument by telling you the way to start off the argument and the central point to the argument and then how to conclude it and that helped us a lot in putting our augments down on paper. Despite having to look at the assignments in one party's perspective you also have to look at the other party's perspective to get ideas on how they would defend against her case and also the methods that they would use to stop her from suing their company. They also helped you give ideas for what she could do to win her case. How did you know how to incorporate cases in your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Our lecturers and tutors told us that cases were very important in the assignment as it could make our grades go from a credit to a distinction in that it showed that you had used a textbook and you had knowledge of other cases. We knew how to use it because the lecturer and tutor taught us when, when you give an example of a situation you should always use the case that you got the example from and that told us when we should use cases as examples. What does it mean to be analytical and have your own point of view? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> At university they always ask you to be analytical in your assignments. In Commercial Law this means that you have to analyse the case that they have given you and put it in your own perspective of what cases are relevant and what examples are relevant and how you should actually write the assignment. In Commercial Law, your own point of view in the assignments is writing the assignment and using cases that you have decided that need to be used and using a structure that, even though it is based on what the lecturers and tutors said, that you think will make the assignment sound and look the best. How did you apply the law to the problem in your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The situation that we had to deal with in the assignment was bought together with the laws by you do a lot of reading and then you've read your case and anything that just clicks, is it should go together, that's when you know that the law and the case go together, and that's when you have to write as an example and put the cases that are relevant and also examples of acts and things like that. Do you have to develop a legal argument for only one side of the case in Commercial Law assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> In Commercial Law you never have to have one point of view as in Law there's a number of points of view and you have to choose one that you think is the best that you can also say this could occur as well as another case could occur or this can as well but you should choose which one you think is best. The way to get a balance of which point of view is the best is by reading a text book and going over the notes that you have done and choosing which one you think would be the best chance of an.... How did Year 12 Legal Studies help you with your Commercial Law assignment in your university studies? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Legal Studies in Year 12 was very helpful to Commercial Law as it gave me a basis for Commercial Law and it just gave me a general knowledge to help me in Commercial Law in the first year of Uni. In Legal Studies in Year 12, they do Criminal Law and Commercial Law throughout the entire year and the Commercial Law knowledge which is a lot more basic than the one in Commercial law, it helped me a lot to learn the Commercial Law subject a lot easier when I started it. In what ways is Year 12 Legal Studies different from Commercial Law at university? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Year 12 Legal Studies assignments and Commercial Law assignments varied very much as legal studies assignments were all Criminal assignments, while the Commercial Law assignments were just on Commercial Law aspects of the legal area. Are Year 12 Legal Studies and Commercial Law assignments similar or different? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The assignments that I did at Uni were similar to university in that you had to answer them from your own point of view and be analytical and express yourself in a clear way with good English. The Year 12 assignments varied from the Uni assignments as in year 12 you get a criteria based system where you had to answer criteria 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 while in University you are just given a case study and you have to go and do your own research and everything yourself with some help from your lecturer and your tutor. You did not get the criteria in University as you just got given the case study, so you didn't actually know where..what.... In what ways are university assignments similar to or different from Year 12 assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The assignments were similar in that they were both problem based and that you got a case study and you have to deal with that and answer it in a specific way. What was easy and what was difficult about Year 12 and university assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/commerciallaw/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> In the first semester the assignments were fairly difficult, as a change from year 12, as they were a lot more involved and the marking structure was a lot more harder than in year 12. They are easier in that you didn't have the pressure of a teacher over your shoulder saying this is due at this date, you must do this, you must do this now, but that is also difficult as well because then you don't pressure yourself. Download the full interview with Steve (mp3, 7.14 MB). <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/assets/utilities/download.php?file=assets/audio/steve/steve-all.mp3> Economics assignment This tutorial contains information about writing based on materials from the first-year subject Introductory Microeconomics. You will also find much of the information to be useful for your other Economics subjects. Navigate through the tutorial using the Table of Contents on the left. The tutorial's three main sections are outlined below. Lecturer's advice <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/1.xml> Get information from the lecturer about what is required for Economics assignments. Skills for writing in Economics <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/2.xml> Learn to write better assignments through interactive tasks. Annotated assignments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.xml> View samples of student work with lecturer and student comments. Lecturer's advice In this section, one of your lecturers - Shirley Richardson - answers Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) about researching and writing reports in first-year Economics. FAQs: Click on those topic areas that are of interest to you, or that you need to know more about. Objectives 1. What are you hoping to achieve in setting the main assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq1> 2. What do you hope students will gain from the experience of researching and writing it? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq2> 3. In the preparation of their assignments, which aspects of the course (content covered, skills, etc.) would you expect students to draw on? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq3> Assessment 4. What are your main considerations when assessing assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq4> Perception of performance 5. What, in your experience, are some of the main difficulties first-year students have with Economics assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq5> 6. Which of these would you say are of a more generic nature (e.g. structuring paragraphs) and which specifically relate to writing in your discipline? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq6> 7. Is there any feature of first-year assignments that you find particularly problematic? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq7> Reading requirements 8. Students are often uncertain about the amount and type of reading they need to do for a university assignment. What are your expectations in this regard for a first-year Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq8> Transition issues 9. Do you have any sense of how the writing requirements of VCE compare with the type of writing required in your course? What transitions do you think students need to make? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq9> 10. What would you say is distinctive about writing in Eeconomics? Is there anything you would point to that distinguishes Economics writing from the writing in other business/commerce disciplines? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq10> Advice 11. If you were to give students three simple pieces of advice as they prepare to do an assignment in your subject, what would these be? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq9> 1. What are you hoping to achieve in setting the main assignment? Summary: First assignment tests basic skills The first assignment is as much about finding out how we are going as teaching staff as it is about where the students are at. The first assignment establishes the basic foundations for all the future learning in Economics. It is therefore essential that students have to carry out tasks that test the "basic skills". Students know these basic skills are the same skills to be examined. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 2. What do you hope students will gain from the experience of researching and writing it? Summary: Economics is visually oriented It is made clear in the assignment that NO RESEARCH is necessary, only reading the prescribed text. This reading cannot be classified as research. The students gain experience in handling diagrams and building their written answer around them. Economics is both (or either) diagram or maths oriented. We concentrate upon the visual, using geometry instead of maths. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 3. In the preparation of their assignments, which aspects of the course (content covered, skills, etc.) would you expect students to draw on? Summary: Students use skills from the teaching program It is expected that students will use all the skills and content which are demonstrated in the weekly lecture presentation, practised in the student activity segment of the lecture, and reinforced in the weekly tutorial. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 4. What are your main considerations when assessing assignments? Summary: Assessment criteria Do students understand? Can they apply it? Can they express it well in writing? Is referencing correct? We have a feedback sheet attached to the returned assignment indicating the relative importance of the content needed in the answers to all questions. We are looking to see that the student understands what has been written and can apply the tools of Economics to solving problems which occur in the real world. Quoting slabs from the text book gives no indication of understanding, and only illustrates that the student knows where to look in the text. (This information is already given on the assignment sheet, so it tells us nothing.) The student is expected to be competent in the written expression of their work and professional in their presentation, including detailed referencing. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 5. What, in your experience, are some of the main difficulties first-year students have with Economics assignments? Summary: Students' problems with the assignment Not enough effort Not answering the question Not writing information "in own words" Many students do not want to put the necessary work into understanding the reading. They still expect to understand everything by just reading the prescribed text once, rather than reading some of the chapters more than once. Less skilled students do not answer the question asked, but instead tell us everything they know about a topic. Students need to recognise that they will not be able to put their answers to the assignment questions "into their own words" unless they actually understand the content being demonstrated. Often quoting the author's words does not demonstrate student understanding. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 6. Which of these would you say are of a more generic nature (e.g. structuring paragraphs) and which specifically relate to writing in your discipline? None of these is generic in nature. If students understand the concepts and can demonstrate them , the writing required in economics at introductory level is minimal. Students who have accomplished VCE English will have little difficulty in writing for economics if they have done the prescribed reading and practised using the concepts. The economic vocabulary used at the first-year level is straightforward and students are immersed in it through lectures, student activities, and tutorials, as well as in the prescribed text. With the assistance given during the normal semester of lectures and tutorials, students should have little difficulty in gaining a good grade. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 7. Is there any feature of first-year assignments that you find particularly problematic? Summary: Students' problems with the assignment Not following instructions Not doing assignments progressively Not reading/studying the text Problems arise for a few reasons: Students do not follow the instructions given on the assignment. Students do not do the questions progressively but complete the whole assignment in one hit. Students try to do the assignment from lecture notes and tutorials only, without reading the prescribed text. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 8. Students are often uncertain about the amount and type of reading they need to do for a university assignment. What are your expectations in this regard for a first-year Economics assignment? There is no such problem in economics. The week of the lecture is identified as well as the particular chapter students need to understand. I expect students to follow the instructions and guidelines given on the assignment sheet. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 9. Do you have any sense of how the writing requirements of VCE compare with the type of writing required in your course? What transitions do you think students need to make? In Economics, students need to understand what they read – the theory – and then apply it to a similar situation. They cannot just regurgitate the text content to answer the problems set. They have to use the basic concepts to solve simple and familiar problems. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 10. What would you say is distinctive about writing in Economics? Is there anything you would point to that distinguishes Economics writing from the writing in other business/commerce disciplines? Economics is about the real world and people. It is also about key relationships. Students need to be taught how to think about the key relationships (e.g. demand and supply), and the language that describes those relationships. Economics is a subject built on understanding certain key concepts and the terminology that describes the key concepts. These basic key concepts occur throughout all levels of Economics studies. If the students don't understand the basics thoroughly, they will always struggle in the subject area. If they learn the basic concepts well, they can always work their way to a correct or justifiable answer. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 11. Do you have any sense of how the writing requirements of VCE compare with the type of writing required in your course? What transitions do you think students need to make? Summary: Advice to students Read instructions and guidelines Attend lectures and tutorials, do the reading thoroughly Complete assignment progressively Read the assignment including the instructions and guidelines. Ensure that you have attended the lectures and tutorials, and have covered the required reading at least twice. Do each question on the assignment progressively. For example when told in the lecture that "after this week's tutorial you should prepare your draft answer to Q5", the student should do so. This means that as each layer of knowledge is learned, the student is then carrying out the application of that layer of knowledge. By the time the due date for the assignment comes around, a complete draft of the assignment is ready for the final copy. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> Skills for writing in Economics In this section, you have a chance to practice skills to help you with your report writing for Economics. The materials cover four broad topics and include a range of practice tasks. Select those topics you"d like to work on from the menu on the left. Topics: Reading <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/2.1.xml> Reading and understanding texts Applying theory <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/2.2.xml> - Applying theory and principles to real life Analysing <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/2.3.xml> Analysing your assignment tasks Style <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/2.4.xml> - Writing in an Economics style Reading This exercise focuses on reading economic theory in texts, understanding it, and writing in your own words. In Economics assignments, as in most assignments you do, you need to read theory in texts and articles. These explain the economics principles that you will apply to the different contexts or situations represented in your assignment tasks. To be able to apply theory to new situations in your assignments, you need to be able to read and understand the economic principles. Read, understand, and identify key terms Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Read the following excerpt from McTaggart, D., Findlay, C and Parkin, M. Macroeconomics. Addison-Wesley Publishing Company, Sydney. 1992. Page 66. Demand The quantity demanded of a good or service is the amount that consumers plan to buy in a given period of time. Demands are different from wants. Wants are the unlimited desires or wishes that people have from goods or services. How many times have you thought that you would like something 'if only you could afford it' or 'if it weren't so expensive'? Scarcity guarantees that many - perhaps most - of our wants will never be satisfied. Demand reflects a decision about which wants to satisfy. If you demand something, then you've made a plan to buy it. The quantity demanded is measured as an amount per unit of time. For example, suppose a person consumes one cup of coffee a day. The quantity of coffee demanded by that person can be expressed as one cup per day or seven cups per week or 365 cups per year. Without a time, dimension, we cannot tell whether a particular quantity demanded is large or small. If you were trying to understand "demand" and take notes on it, your next step would be to identify the key terms about demand in the above excerpt. Identifying the key terms assists your understanding. You can't separate the important from the less important information if it is only a mass of words for you. 1. Can you identify the key terms about demand? Your key terms [1] Check your answer [1] Another way to understand a concept or economics principle is to try to group key information in note form. Did you identify these key terms?: Key terms Quantity demanded: Amount consumers plan to buy, over given time period. Demands: Different from wants, which are unlimited desires for goods/services. Not necessarily quantity actually bought. Quantity wanted: Quantity bought and sold called quantity traded. If quantity demanded more than amount of goods available, then quantity traded is less than quantity demanded. Diagramming the concept Diagramming is another way to consolidate your understanding of the concept. It helps you to see how the key ideas in the concept are related. 2. Using the key words from Task 1(above), see if you can fill in the detail on the diagram below. Demand Goods/services consumers Different from to buy unlimited desires Because of , most wants not satisfied. Therefore, demand involves decisions of what to satisfy. [2] Check your answer [2] Demand Goods/services consumers plan to buy. Different from wants, unlimited desires Because of scarcity, most wants not satisfied. Therefore, demand involves decisions of what to satisfy. Write in your own words When using an economics concept in your written work, it is important to be able to write it in your own words (or paraphrase it). This demonstrates to your examiner that you understand the concept. You can use the keywords and their relationship from your notes or diagram as the basis for your paraphrase. 3. Using the framework above, type in below an explanation of 'demand' in your own words. [3] Check your answer [3] Does your paraphrase look something like this? Demand is concerned with the goods and services that consumers plan to buy in a given period. It is different from wants, which are unlimited desires. Because of scarcity of goods or services, most wants are not satisfied. Thus, demand involves decisions of what to satisfy. An important note! Remember: You must always reference through the footnote or the Harvard in text method whenever you use material from texts and other sources. If you take the words directly, you need to indicate this by using quotation marks. When you write the idea from a text in your own words, you still need to reference it. The Bibliography at the end of your assignment is where you record full details about the sources that you have used in your assignment. Applying theory Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. This exercise focuses on applying economic theory to your Economics problems and in your written work. As in most university subjects, this is an important aspect in writing in Economics . Your lecturers want to see that you not only understand the theory or principles underpinning your subject, but also that you are able to apply them to other settings. Identifying economic principles Look at the example below of the application of the economic principle of "supply" to the assignment task on electricity. [1] In analysing the market for electricity, the supply curve would be affected [2] because there would be an increase in supply as there is a new product on the [3] market and everybody would want it. The law of supply states that an increase [4] in quantity demanded would increase the price of the product and therefore less [5] will be demanded at the new process. This factor is exogenous as it did not [6] appear in either of the axes and affects both demand and supply curves. On which lines in the above example from the assignment is the economic principle presented? Line 1 Line 4 Check your answer Line 2 Line 3 Line 5 Line 6 [1] Applying economic principles On which lines is the application of the economics principle presented? Line 1 Line 4 Check your answer Line 2 Line 3 Line 5 Line 6 [2] Linking economic principles to assignment topics On which lines are the economic principles linked to the assignment topic? Line 1 Line 2 Line 3 Line 4 Line 5 Line 6 [3] Check your answer [1] Identifying economic principles: answer If you answered Lines 3, 4, 5 and 6, you are correct. [2] Applying economic principles: answer If you answered Lines 2 and 3 and Lines 5 and 6, you are correct. [3] Linking economic principles to assignment topics: answer In Lines 2 to 5, the phrase "the supply curve would be affected because... and everybody would want it" explains the economic principle in practical terms. A link is evident between this and the next sentence because the next sentence provides the theoretical explanation for this phenomenon. Analysing In completing university assignments in Economics, it is vital that you carefully read and completely understand the task with which you have been presented. Your lecturers are looking to see that you can come to terms with their requirements and, importantly, that you can respond to the directions in a relevant way. If you write an answer to what you think the task is about, or what you would like it to be about, you will not get many marks if it is not what the task is actually asking you to do. It may be a well-written response, but it must address and be relevant to the requirements. Hence, it is important that you take the time to pull apart, or analyse, your task so that you are crystal clear on what you are being asked to do. You then have a clear direction for further work on the assignment, and you will be using your time as efficiently as possible. Analysing the topic Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Contextualising the topic Look at the topic task for Question 2 of the assignment below, and then answer the questions as we analyse the topic. [1] Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. [2] Explain why this might be the case. [3] Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price inelasticity of demand. [4] Use the diagram to explain how the inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. [5] Word limit: 750 You can see that this topic question comprises two sections: a contextualising sentence a set of directions to the student. Which part of the task is the contextualising topic or sentence? Sentence 1 [1] Check your answer Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 Sentence 5 Number of tasks How many subtasks must the students complete in this assignment? 1 subtask [2] Check your answer 2 subtasks 3 subtasks 4 subtasks Direction words In the directions section of the topic question, what are students instructed to do? That is, what are the directive words in each of these subtasks? The first one has been done for you. Subtask 1's instruction words: Subtask 2's instruction words: Subtask 3's instruction words: [3] Check your answer Choice of tasks Are you given the choice of which of these subtasks you will complete? Yes No [4] Check your answer [1] Contextualising the topic: Answer The contextualising sentence is Sentence 1, which establishes that this assignment is about illicit and legal drugs. The other sentences are directions. [2] Number of tasks: Answer This assignment has three subtasks: Sentences 2, 3, and 4. [3] Direction words: Answer If you included these directions, you are correct: Explain why Draw a diagram and explain Use the diagram to explain how [4] Choice of tasks: answer The correct answer is No. You must respond to all of these tasks. If you only respond to two out of the three tasks, the most you can obtain for the assignment is 25% of the total marks. Instruction words Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Below are some meanings of directive words. See if you can match the correct word with its meaning. 1. Describe, say what they are, name. 2. Pull apart, dissect, explain the parts and how they work together to produce the result. 3. Spell out, tell in a step by step, cause and effect way the process involved. Term Analyse Explain Identify [1] Check your answers [1] Your Answer Correct Answers: Analyse: Meaning 2 Explain: Meaning 3 Identify: Meaning 1 Check your answers above and look at the wording of the assignment task below where the directive words and phrases have been bolded. Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. Explain why this might be the case. Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price inelasticity of demand. Use the diagram to explain how the inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Word limit: 750 Economics style This section focuses on the style suitable for writing in Economics. Complete tasks related to the following: Types of thinking Diagrams Headings Types of thinking Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. Explain why this might be the case. Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price inelasticity of demand. Use the diagram to explain how the inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Word limit: 750 Look at the task above. From your analysis of the task, how would you explain the type of thinking that is required in studying economics and completing economics assignments such as this? Choose the examples that you think are involved in economics from the list below: a. Learning economics principles and retelling them to the examiner/lecturer b. Pulling apart an economics principle so that you can explain how it works. That is, the components of it and how the components interact/affect each other to produce the result. c. Learning the text book off by heart and rewriting this. d. After explaining the components of an economics principle and how it works, explaining to your examiner/lecturer how it relates to a topic that you have been presented with. e. All of Style D above, as well as being aware of and explaining to your reader implications, or effects in the future, of the process that you have just explained and applied. Option A Option D Check your answer Option B Option C Option E [1] [1] Options A and C are not adequate in the study of economics. It is important that you go much further with the content of your study, as we have explained in Options B, D, and E. Diagrams Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Integrating graphs and diagrams in written work In completing Economics assignments, you will need to draw graphs to explain in visual form the effect on economic principles under certain conditions that have been presented to you in your task. It is important that you integrate these visual representations with the text of your assignment. Not only will this indicate to your lecturer/examiner that your thinking is organised, it will make it easier for them to follow your written text. You can integrate them by labelling them correctly, and then making a clear link in words for your reader between the graph and the written information. Look at the section from the sample assignment below, and then answer the following questions about it. This factor was exogenous, outside the Australian model. The lower price in the United States did not appear on either of the axes. This means a shift of the demand curve to the left, towards the origin, as the quantity demanded has decreased. The new demand curve (D2) now shows that at the old equilibrium price at point Z, the quantity demanded is actually Q3. At this same price the quantity demanded before the shift was at Qb. As the diagram shows there is now too much supplied, excess supply as at this price. To adjust to the new equilibrium, there must be an adjustment along both the demand and supply curves. Both curves will have movements along them. The supply curve will have a downward movement along the supply curve meaning less is being supplied at the lower price. As the price falls the quantity demanded will increase until the market reaches a new equilibrium between demand and supply at Q1 and P2 where there is no further tendency to change. Graph: Market for Australian Tertiary Education 1. Is the graph labelled? Yes. No. [1] Check your answer 2. Could the labelling be improved? Yes. No. [2] Check your answer 3. Does the student refer to the graph in her written text? Yes. No. [3] Check your answer 4. Is it clear that she is referring to that particular graph? Yes. No. [4] Check your answer 5. How could this be improved in the written text about the graph? Choose the best responses from the examples below by clicking the box: a) Place the written information about the graph under the graph. b) Write "See graph" in brackets next to the information about the graph. c) Write something like: "Graph 1 above explains the..." OR "As can be seen in Graph 1 below..." [5] Check your answer [1] Question 1: answer Yes, it does have a title: "Market for Australian Tertiary Education". [2] Question 2: answer Yes. It could be given a number. For example: Graph 1. Market for Australian Tertiary Education. This should be placed above or below the graph. [3] Question 2: answer Yes. She states "As the diagram shows..."; "The lower price in the United States did not appear on either of the axes..."; "The new demand curve (D2) now shows that...". [4] Question 4: answer No. The reader would need to infer this. [5] Question 5: answer Options A and C together are the best responses. Option B is an improvement from the use in the sample assignment, but it is not as clear for the reader as A and C. Headings Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Using headings in assignments In all university assignments, including Economics, you should aim to make it as easy as possible for your lecturer/examiner to follow and understand your written response. It is important to remember that your lecturer will be reading and assessing a large number of students' assignments and they want to be able to understand your response without too much difficulty. Using headings also indicates in a subtle way to your lecturer that you have worked in a systematic way and that you are organised in your approach. As you can see in the Economics assignment covered in this tutorial, there are several sections of the task to be addressed. You need to guide your lecturer through your assignment. Using headings as "signposts" of the sections that are being addressed at particular points is a good way of doing this. Look at the final draft of the sample response on illicit and legal drugs. We have reproduced it for you below. As you can see, this response does not include any headings, even though there are three components to the task question. You can also see that it is not easy for the lecturer to know where the different sections of the task start and end. It would make it much easier to read in relation to the tasks if headings were included. Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. a) Explain why this might be the case. b) Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price elasticity of demand. c) Use the diagram to explain how inelastic demand has implication for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. [1] Elasticity is a measure of the responsiveness of quantity supplied to one of its determinants (Gans, King and Mankiw, 1999, page 88). [2] Illicit and legal drugs can be classed as both elastic and inelastic products because for some there can be close substitutes found. Therefore they are not needed as much and people are not dependent on just the one particular product. With inelastic products, when the price changes dramatically there is not a large decrease in the quantity demanded. This shows that people who are dependent on this product have no choice, and therefore will pay a higher price for it. These products will always be demanded. [3] People become addicted to drugs or need them for medical reasons and therefore they will always demand them. This means that distributors and sellers can raise their prices and people will still buy them, there will not be a dramatic decrease in consumers if there is a sudden price increase. [4] This shows the product is inelastic because it is may be addictive or always demanded for health reasons. It is something that people have to have so they can live, and therefore prices can increase, as quantity levels of consumers will not decrease dramatically. Graph 4: Inelastic Demand Curve [5] The inelastic demand curve is very similar to a straight line, because of the curve's almost vertical appearance. It shows that quantity levels will only decrease by a little when price increases quite dramatically. The two points I have drawn on the curve show this. Even when I made one dot quite a lot higher than the other the quantity demanded didn't decrease dramatically. Graph 5: Inelastic Demand Curve Graph 6: Elastic Demand Curve [6] By colouring in the difference between the two dots and the vertical and horizontal axis, you can see the revenue gain is larger than the revenue loss (as drawn on the diagram). [7] Whereas the other diagram is the elastic demand curve, and it shows the same two points with similar dramatic price increases. The price increases however, show a large drop in the quantity levels. Again, when you shade in the required areas you can see that with the same price increase the revenue loss wedge is larger than the revenue gain. This then explains that with a dramatic price increase inelastic companies still make a profit. [8] By showing the two diagrams I have attempted to show that the elastic demand curve does not have the same responses as the inelastic when it comes to price increases, and that the products which are inelastic can absorb slight price increases and will not lose a lot of their consumers. [9] Inelastic demand products are different from other products on the market. Usually when a products price increases consumers may change brands or find a substitute product, and this is a way that product prices are kept reasonable, as long as all the products don't go up all at once. This is because these products rely on their demand to maintain their profit. [10] Inelastic products however are not the same, they do not keep customers because their prices are low, or because it is a well-known brand name. Pharmaceutical companies know that their market is dependent on their products and therefore they can raise their prices. These are a product without which the consumer would not be able to survive, that is why when there is a dramatic price increase there is not the same decrease in quantity demand. For example the price of cigarettes has recently risen but this has not encouraged many smokers to quit, this is because they are addicted and can't stop therefore they are willing to pay the higher price for their nicotine fix. 1. Which paragraphs do you think respond to Subtask A of the assignment? Paragraph 1 Paragraph 2 Paragraph 3 Paragraph 4 Paragraph 5 Paragraph 6 [1] Check your answer Paragraph 7 Paragraph 8 Paragraph 9 Paragraph 10 2. Can you think of a heading that encapsulates the requirements of Subtask A? Look at the examples below and select the one that you consider to be the best heading for Subtask A. Illicit and Legal Drugs Price Inelastic Goods Price Inelasticity and Illicit and Legal Drugs [2] Check your answer 3. Before which paragraph would you put a heading for the response to Subtask B? Paragraph 1 Paragraph 6 [3] Check your answer Paragraph 2 Paragraph 3 Paragraph 4 Paragraph 5 Paragraph 7 Paragraph 8 Paragraph 9 Paragraph 10 4. At what point in the text would you begin Subtask C and place a heading? Paragraph 1 Paragraph 6 [4] Check your answer Paragraph 2 Paragraph 3 Paragraph 4 Paragraph 5 Paragraph 7 Paragraph 8 Paragraph 9 Paragraph 10 5. The key areas of Subtask C are inelastic demand, pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue, and the implications of inelastic demand for price setting and revenue of pharmaceutical companies. See if you can combine these concepts into an appropriate heading. [5] Check your answer [1] Question 1: answer Beginning with "Elasticity is a measure..." and ending with "...as quantity levels of consumers will not decrease dramatically", Paragraphs 1-4 respond to Subtask A. In using headings in assignments, it is most important that the headings you devise encapsulate the task and are relevant to the information to which they refer. Otherwise, they will only confuse your lecturer and will not give them the impression that you are in control of your response. [2] Question 2: answer If you selected the third option - Price Inelasticity and Illicit and Legal Drugs - you are correct. This heading encapsulates all the concepts involved in Subtask A. [3] Question 3: answer If you think it would be best placed after the graph "Inelastic Demand Curve" and before Paragraph 5, you are correct. [4] Question 4: answer Probably above Paragraph 10, beginning with "Inelastic products however are not the same..." However, there is not a clear demarcation in the way the text has been composed here to introduce the response to Subtask C. It should be rephrased to indicate a new beginning that addresses the task. [5] Question 5: answer If you used a heading such as "Pharmaceutical Company Price Setting, Revenue and Inelastic Demand", you have encapsulated the key areas. Other Economics resources Additonal resources available to you on Economics include: McConnell, J., Nailon, K., Bell, G., Johnston, C. (1995) Economics Activity Book 2, McMillan Education Australia, South Melbourne. Q Manual, Faculty of Business and Economics http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/qmanual/qmanual/ <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/qmanual/qmanual.pdf> (PDF 4.3MB) Annotated assignments Topic: Economics Assignment Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this assignment. Rebecca's sample assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.2.xml> : See Rebecca's assignment before she received feedback on it. Rebecca's assignment and what her lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.3.xml> : See the assignment along with the lecturer's comments. Interview with Rebecca <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.4.xml> : Listen to Rebecca talk about the writing process. The annotated assignments and the writing approaches described by students should not be seen as ideal models for you to copy. They are intended to be a general guide to assignment writing in your subject and to help you to reflect on your own approach. Rebecca's assignment Rebecca is a first-year Economics student. For her main assignment in the subject, Rebecca had to complete the three questions based on supply and demand. Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Rebecca's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.2.xml> . o How well do you think the assignment responds to the topic? o Do you think the assignment could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.3.xml> about Rebecca's assignment. 4. Finally, listen to Rebecca <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/economics/3.1.4.xml> talk about how she wrote her assignment and read feedback about how to overcome the difficulties she faced. [1] Assignment Questions Assignment Question 1 This question relates to content and skills covered in Week 2 of the Subject Guide, Chapter 4, Gans, King, Mankiw. Use the four steps from Week 2 of the Subject Guide to answer the following questions. Draw a separate diagram for each event and refer to points on the diagram in your explanation. (a) Analyse the impact on the market for Australian tertiary education of a decrease in the price of tertiary education in the United States. [10 marks] b) Analyse the impact on the market for electricity of new regulations requiring the installation of pollution reduction equipment by all electricity producers. [10 marks] (c) Analyse the impact on the market for tea of new medical research linking tea drinkers to lower rates of cancer. [10 marks] Word Limit 750 Assignment Question 2 This question relates to content and skills covered in Week 3 of the Subject Guide, Chapter 5, Gans, King, Mankiw. Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. a) Explain why this might be the case. b) Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price elasticity of demand. c) Use the diagram to explain how inelastic demand has implication for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Word Limit 750 Assignment Question 3 This question relates to content and skills covered in Weeks 4 and 5 of the Subject Guide, Chapters 6,7,8, Gans, King, Mankiw. Chapter 12, Gans, King, Mankiw is not part of the prescribed reading but does provide Australian context, which may be useful to answer part (d) of this question. Australia's taxation system will change on July 1, 2000 to include a broad based Goods and Services Tax (GST), which will be added to the price of most goods and services purchased by consumers. A hair cut is currently untaxed in Australia. a) Use a demand and supply diagram to show the impact of the GST on prices and output in the Australian hair cutting industry. (Actual prices and quantities are not required). b) Identify and explain the areas of consumer surplus, producer surplus and government tax revenue. In doing so, comment on whether the burden of tax falls only on consumers. c) Use your diagram and the concept of deadweight loss to predict the oveall effect on welfare as a result of the GST on hair cuts. d) Part of the new tax package is a reduction in income tax rates. Knowing that taxes change economic incentives, explain why the broader based GST tax system may be preferable to the current system of progressive income taxes. Word Limit 1000 Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Shirley Richardson - sets out what she expects from student assignments on this topic. How I would expect students to go about researching and writing an answer to this particular task No research is necessary except the reading of the prescribed text as indicated on the assignment sheet. How should students interpret the topic? It is expected that the students will interpret the topic by making use of all the skills and content which are demonstrated in the weekly lecture presentation, practised in the student activity segment of the lecture, and reinforced in the weekly tutorial. What reading would you expect them to do? The reading is indicated on the assignment sheet; usually a single chapter, occasionally several, depending on the question asked. The reading for Economics is very reasonable when measured against some other subject areas - Management for instance. With the usual topics that are in the newspapers or on the current affairs students are encouraged to listen to what others say about things - GST being one of them. How long would you expect students to spend on the question overall? As long as it takes to draw the particular diagrams, go through the steps which are indicated in the subject book and demonstrated in class. Economists are in the business of prediction, so students need to commence as early as possible. What would a good response on this topic need to contain? The student needs to address all parts of the question. The student will have to make use of the relevant and labelled diagram with a discussion that indicates the student understood the basic concepts underlying the construction of the diagram. The student needs to have used the theory underlying the diagram to make some conclusions or observations that may or may not be similar to others speaking on the topic elsewhere. How in general terms would a High Distinction response differ from one at a Pass/Credit level? High Distinction - would have included all as indicated above; whereas the Pass and Credit would have omitted more than one of the above. A Pass or Credit is usually one where the student may have drawn the diagram perfectly but does not understand what they have drawn and therefore cannot discuss the diagram fully or use the diagram to make a prediction. Rebecca's sample assignment Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic Assignment topic Question 1 In analysing the three examples I will use the four-step approach outlined in the study book for Introductory Microeconomics. Step one, identify which curve (demand or supply) will be affected? Step two, how will the curve be affected? It will be either a shift of the curve or a movement along. Step three, in which direction? Step four, analyse the adjustment process for both supply and demand. (a) Analyse the impact on the market for Australian tertiary education of a decrease in the price of tertiary education in the United States. In analysing the market for Australian tertiary education, the demand curve would be affected because the fees in the United States of America were going down and the law of demand states a decrease in price will lead to an increase in quantity demanded. Relative to the United States, Australia's tertiary education is now more expensive; therefore there will be less demand for tertiary places in Australia. Students will choose to go to the United States instead. This factor was exogenous, outside the Australian model. The lower price in the United States does did not appear on either of the axes. This means a shift of the demand curve to the left, towards the origin, as the quantity demanded has decreased. The new demand curve (D2) now shows that at the old equilibrium price at point Z, the quantity demanded is actually Q3. At this same price the quantity demanded before the shift was at Qb. As the diagram shows there is now too much supplied, excess supply as at this price. To adjust to the new equilibrium, there must be an adjustment along both the demand and supply curves. Both curves will have movements along them. The supply curve will have a downward movement along the supply curve meaning less is being supplied at the lower price. As the price falls the quantity demanded will increase until the market reaches a new equilibrium between demand and supply at Q1 and P2 where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 1: Market for Australian Tertiary Education (b) Analyse the impact on the market for electricity of new regulations requiring the installation of pollution reduction equipment by all electricity producers. In analysing the market for electricity I found that the supply curve would be affected because there would be an increase in supply as there is a new product on the market and everybody would want it. The law of supply states that an increase in quantity demanded would increase the price of the product and therefore less will be demanded at the new price. This factor is exogenous as it did not appear in either of the axes and affects both demand and supply curves. It would then shift the supply curve right, or away from the origin, as the supply has increased. The new supply curve now intersects at the old equilibrium price at point W; at this point the quantity supplied is Q3. This shows the excess demand, as at this price there is more supplied than there is demanded. To adjust the curves so that they are at equilibrium, both curves will have movements along them. The supply curve will have an upward movement along the curve because more is being supplied at the higher price. As the price is increasing the quantity demanded will decrease until the market reaches a new equilibrium between Qh and Pz where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 2: Market for Electricity (c) Analyse the impact on the market for tea of new medical research linking tea drinkers to lower rates of cancer. In analysing the market for tea the new medicinal characteristics would cause an increase in the amount of people drinking and buying tea, so therefore the demand curve would be affected. The increase in demand would shift the demand curve to the right, a shift away from the origin. The new demand curve (D2) at the old equilibrium price at point F, has the quantity demanded as Q3. At this same price the quantity demanded before the shift was Qc. This shows that at the old price too much is demanded, while not enough is being supplied. There is excess demand. For the market to adjust so that both demand and supply are at equilibrium, there must be a movement along both demand and supply curves. The supply curve will have an upward movement along the curve because more will be supplied at the higher price. As the price increases the quantity demanded decreases until the market reaches a new equilibrium between Qx and Pr where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 3: Market for Tea Assignment topic Question 2 Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. (a) Explain why this might be the case. (b) Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price elasticity of demand. (c) Use the diagram to explain how inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Elasticity is a measure of the responsiveness of quantity supplied to one of its determinants (Gans, King and Mankiw, 1999, page 88). Illicit and legal drugs can be classed as both elastic and inelastic products because for some there can be close substitutes found. Therefore they are not needed as much and people are not dependent on just the one particular product. With inelastic products, when the price changes dramatically there is not a large decrease in the quantity demanded. This shows that people who are dependent on this product have no choice, and therefore will pay a higher price for it. These products will always be demanded. People become addicted to drugs or need them for medical reasons and therefore they will always demand them. This means that distributors and sellers can raise their prices and people will still buy them, there will not be a dramatic decrease in consumers if there is a sudden price increase. This shows the product is inelastic because it is may be addictive or always demanded for health reasons. It is something that people have to have so they can live, and therefore prices can increase, as quantity levels of consumers will not decrease dramatically. Graph 4: Inelastic Demand Curve The inelastic demand curve is very similar to a straight line, because of the curve's almost vertical appearance. It shows that quantity levels will only decrease by a little when price increases quite dramatically. The two points I have drawn on the curve show this. Even when I made one dot quite a lot higher than the other the quantity demanded didn't decrease dramatically. Graph 5: Inelastic Demand Curve Graph 6: Elastic Demand Curve By colouring in the difference between the two dots and the vertical and horizontal axis, you can see the revenue gain is larger than the revenue loss (as drawn on the diagram). Whereas the other diagram is the elastic demand curve, and it shows the same two points with similar dramatic price increases. The price increases however, show a large drop in the quantity levels. Again, when you shade in the required areas you can see that with the same price increase the revenue loss wedge is larger than the revenue gain. This then explains that with a dramatic price increase inelastic companies still make a profit. By showing the two diagrams I have attempted to show that the elastic demand curve does not have the same responses as the inelastic when it comes to price increases, and that the products which are inelastic can absorb slight price increases and will not lose a lot of their consumers. Inelastic demand products are different from other products on the market. Usually when a products price increases consumers may change brands or find a substitute product, and this is a way that product prices are kept reasonable, as long as all the products don't go up all at once. This is because these products rely on their demand to maintain their profit. Inelastic products however are not the same, they do not keep customers because their prices are low, or because it is a well-known brand name. Pharmaceutical companies known that their market is dependent on their products and therefore they can raise their prices. These are a product without which the consumer would not be able to survive, that is why when there is a dramatic price increase there is not the same decrease in quantity demand. For example the price of cigarettes has recently risen but this has not encouraged many smokers to quit, this is because they are addicted and can't stop therefore they are willing to pay the higher price for their nicotine fix. Assignment topic Question 3: Australia's taxation system will change on July 1 next year to include a broad based Goods and Services Tax (GST), which will be added to the price of most goods and services purchased by consumers. A hair cut is currently untaxed in Australia. (a) Use a demand and supply diagram to show the impact of the GST on prices and output in the Australian hair cutting industry. (Actual prices and quantities are not required). (b) Identify and explain the areas of consumer surplus, producer surplus and government tax revenue. In doing so, comment on whether the burden of tax falls only on consumers. (c) Use your diagram and the concept of deadweight loss to predict the overall effect on welfare as a result of the GST on haircuts. (d) Part of the new tax package is a reduction in income tax rates. Knowing that taxes change economic incentives explain why the broader based GST tax system may be preferable to the current system of progressive income taxes. Graph 7: Australian Haircut Industry - Introduction of GST With the new taxation laws introduced in July there is now going to be taxes on products that never had taxes before, hairdressing is one of these. With this there will be an increase in the price to have your haircut (shown by the arrows, and the dot for new price). Although the price has increased, the amount that the hairdresser receives has decreased (amount received shown on diagram). The area between this is the tax wedge, or the government tax revenue. The government tax revenue is the amount that the hairdresser will have to pay the government for every hair cut, and then they will redistribute to the public. Tax burden falls on both the producer and the consumer; this is shown because the wedge has taken an even share from both sides of the equilibrium line. Consumer and producer surplus are both labelled on the diagram. Consumer surplus is found above the equilibrium line, and is the area or surplus of what consumers have to pay and what they are willing to pay. That is why it is above the equilibrium because that is the level they have to pay and the space above this line and the demand curve is the surplus. Producer surplus is the area from the equilibrium point and down until it hits the horizontal axis. This is the surplus of what the producers were willing to sell the product for and what they are selling it for. Dead weight loss is another area labelled on the diagram. This is the area where the consumers were willing to pay this price, but the producer could not supply it at that price now that tax has been introduced. This now means people have to pay more for a haircut and that a hairdresser does not receive as much revenue from each cut because they have to pay tax. The reduction in consumer and producer surplus is bad for welfare, but the tax revenue is good because then the money can be redistributed to the public, so the dead weight loss can have both a bad and good outcome. The new tax package is broad and with the introduction of the higher income taxes it is going to give consumers more of an incentive to buy items as they have more money in their pockets. But this may not be the case, as the new tax regulations mean that items that never use to be taxed are, and previously taxed items will increase in price. When the new tax regulations are introduced this may, at the beginning, reduce the demand for some products, but these producers may not be able to lower prices as they now have to pay a tax, therefore the dead weight loss may grow in size. Producers may have to reduce the levels they supply because they may not be able to pay the tax, or buy the raw materials now that they have gone up in price. Although there may seem to be a large amount of problems with the new tax laws, they will end up making all producers even and will not disadvantage some trades as the previous law may have. Biblography [2]Gans.J., King.S. and Mankiw.N. (1999) Principles Of Microeconomics. NSW: Harcourt Brace and Company. [1] Assignment topic Question 1: This question relates to content and skills covered in Week 2 of the Subject Guide, Chapter 4 Gans, King, Mankiw. Use the four steps from Week 2 of the Subject Guide to answer the following questions. Draw a separate diagram for each event and refer to points on the diagram in your explanation. a. Analyse the impact on the market for Australian tertiary education of a decrease in the price of tertiary education in the United States. [10 marks] b. Analyse the impact on the market for electricity of new regulations requiring the installation of pollution reduction equipment by all electricity producers. [10 marks] c. Analyse the impact on the market for tea of new medical research linking tea drinkers to lower rates of cancer. [10 marks] Word Limit 750 Assignment topic Question 2: Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. a. Explain why this might be the case. b. Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price elasticity of demand. c. Use the diagram to explain how inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Assignment topic Question 3: This question relates to content and skills covered in Weeks 4 and 5 of the Subject Guide, Chapters 6,7,8 Gans, King, Mankiw. Chapter 12, Gans, King, Mankiw is not part of the prescribed reading but does provide Australian context, which may be useful to answer part (d) of this question. Australia's taxation system will change on July 1 next year to include a broad based Goods and Services Tax (GST), which will be added to the price of most goods and services purchased by consumers. A hair cut is currently untaxed in Australia. a. Use a demand and supply diagram to show the impact of the GST on prices and output in the Australian hair cutting industry. (Actual prices and quantities are not required). b. Identify and explain the areas of consumer surplus, producer surplus and government tax revenue. In doing so, comment on whether the burden of tax falls only on consumers. c. Use your diagram and the concept of deadweight loss to predict the oveall effect on welfare as a result of the GST on hair cuts. d. Part of the new tax package is a reduction in income tax rates. Knowing that taxes change economic incentives, explain why the broader based GST tax system may be preferable to the current system of progressive income taxes. Word Limit 1000 [2] In APA Style this is called References. Rebecca's assignment and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Assignment topic Question 1 In analysing the three examples I will use the four-step approach outlined in the study book for Introductory Microeconomics. Step one, identify which curve (demand or supply) will be affected? Step two, how will the curve be affected? It will be either a shift of the curve or a movement along. Step three, in which direction? Step four, analyse the adjustment process for both supply and demand. [IMG-1] [1] (a) Analyse the impact on the market for Australian tertiary education of a decrease in the price of tertiary education in the United States. In analysing the market for Australian tertiary education, the demand curve would be affected because the fees in the United States of America were going down and the law of demand states a decrease in price will lead to an increase in quantity demanded. Relative to the United States, Australia's tertiary education is now more expensive; therefore there will be less demand for tertiary places in Australia. Students will choose to go to the United States instead. This factor was exogenous, outside the Australian model. The lower price in the United States does did not appear on either of the axes. This means a shift of the demand curve to the left, towards the origin, as the quantity demanded has decreased. The new demand curve (D2) now shows that at the old equilibrium price at point Z, the quantity demanded is actually Q3. At this same price the quantity demanded before the shift was at Qb. As the diagram shows there is now too much supplied, excess supply as at this price. To adjust to the new equilibrium, there must be an adjustment along both the demand and supply curves. Both curves will have movements along them. The supply curve will have a downward movement along the supply curve meaning less is being supplied at the lower price. As the price falls the quantity demanded will increase until the market reaches a new equilibrium between demand and supply at Q1 and P2 where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 1: Market for Australian Tertiary Education [IMG-2] [2] (b) Analyse the impact on the market for electricity of new regulations requiring the installation of pollution reduction equipment by all electricity producers. In analysing the market for electricity I found that the supply curve would be affected because there would be an increase in supply as there is a new product on the market and everybody would want it. The law of supply states that an increase in quantity demanded would increase the price of the product and therefore less will be demanded at the new price. This factor is exogenous as it did not appear in either of the axes and affects both demand and supply curves. It would then shift the supply curve right, or away from the origin, as the supply has increased. The new supply curve now intersects at the old equilibrium price at point W; at this point the quantity supplied is Q3. This shows the excess demand, as at this price there is more supplied than there is demanded. To adjust the curves so that they are at equilibrium, both curves will have movements along them. The supply curve will have an upward movement along the curve because more is being supplied at the higher price. As the price is increasing the quantity demanded will decrease until the market reaches a new equilibrium between Qh and Pz where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 2: Market for Electricity [IMG-3] [3] (c) Analyse the impact on the market for tea of new medical research linking tea drinkers to lower rates of cancer. In analysing the market for tea the new medicinal characteristics would cause an increase in the amount of people drinking and buying tea, so therefore the demand curve would be affected. The increase in demand would shift the demand curve to the right, a shift away from the origin. The new demand curve (D2) at the old equilibrium price at point F, has the quantity demanded as Q3. At this same price the quantity demanded before the shift was Qc. This shows that at the old price too much is demanded, while not enough is being supplied. There is excess demand. For the market to adjust so that both demand and supply are at equilibrium, there must be a movement along both demand and supply curves. The supply curve will have an upward movement along the curve because more will be supplied at the higher price. As the price increases the quantity demanded decreases until the market reaches a new equilibrium between Qx and Pr where there is no further tendency to change. Graph 3: Market for Tea [IMG-4] [4] Assignment topic Question 2 Both illicit and legal drugs are often cited as the classic example of goods which are very price inelastic. (a) Explain why this might be the case. (b) Draw a demand curve illustrating price inelastic demand and explain how the curve relates to the definition of price elasticity of demand. (c) Use the diagram to explain how inelastic demand has implications for pharmaceutical company price setting and revenue. Elasticity is a measure of the responsiveness of quantity supplied to one of its determinants (Gans, King and Mankiw, 1999, page 88). Illicit and legal drugs can be classed as both elastic and inelastic products because for some there can be close substitutes found. Therefore they are not needed as much and people are not dependent on just the one particular product. With inelastic products, when the price changes dramatically there is not a large decrease in the quantity demanded. This shows that people who are dependent on this product have no choice, and therefore will pay a higher price for it. These products will always be demanded. People become addicted to drugs or need them for medical reasons and therefore they will always demand them. This means that distributors and sellers can raise their prices and people will still buy them, there will not be a dramatic decrease in consumers if there is a sudden price increase. This shows the product is inelastic because it is may be addictive or always demanded for health reasons. It is something that people have to have so they can live, and therefore prices can increase, as quantity levels of consumers will not decrease dramatically. Graph 4: Inelastic Demand Curve The inelastic demand curve is very similar to a straight line, because of the curve's almost vertical appearance. It shows that quantity levels will only decrease by a little when price increases quite dramatically. The two points I have drawn on the curve show this. Even when I made one dot quite a lot higher than the other the quantity demanded didn't decrease dramatically. Graph 5: Inelastic Demand Curve Graph 6: Elastic Demand Curve By colouring in the difference between the two dots and the vertical and horizontal axis, you can see the revenue gain is larger than the revenue loss (as drawn on the diagram). Whereas the other diagram is the elastic demand curve, and it shows the same two points with similar dramatic price increases. The price increases however, show a large drop in the quantity levels. Again, when you shade in the required areas you can see that with the same price increase the revenue loss wedge is larger than the revenue gain. This then explains that with a dramatic price increase inelastic companies still make a profit. By showing the two diagrams I have attempted to show that the elastic demand curve does not have the same responses as the inelastic when it comes to price increases, and that the products which are inelastic can absorb slight price increases and will not lose a lot of their consumers. Inelastic demand products are different from other products on the market. Usually when a products price increases consumers may change brands or find a substitute product, and this is a way that product prices are kept reasonable, as long as all the products don't go up all at once. This is because these products rely on their demand to maintain their profit. Inelastic products however are not the same, they do not keep customers because their prices are low, or because it is a well-known brand name. Pharmaceutical companies known that their market is dependent on their products and therefore they can raise their prices. These are a product without which the consumer would not be able to survive, that is why when there is a dramatic price increase there is not the same decrease in quantity demand. For example the price of cigarettes has recently risen but this has not encouraged many smokers to quit, this is because they are addicted and can't stop therefore they are willing to pay the higher price for their nicotine fix. [IMG-5] [5] Assignment topic Question 3 Australia's taxation system will change on July 1 next year to include a broad based Goods and Services Tax (GST), which will be added to the price of most goods and services purchased by consumers. A hair cut is currently untaxed in Australia. (a) Use a demand and supply diagram to show the impact of the GST on prices and output in the Australian hair cutting industry. (Actual prices and quantities are not required). (b) Identify and explain the areas of consumer surplus, producer surplus and government tax revenue. In doing so, comment on whether the burden of tax falls only on consumers. (c) Use your diagram and the concept of deadweight loss to predict the overall effect on welfare as a result of the GST on haircuts. (d) Part of the new tax package is a reduction in income tax rates. Knowing that taxes change economic incentives explain why the broader based GST tax system may be preferable to the current system of progressive income taxes. Graph 7: Australian Haircut Industry - Introduction of GST With the new taxation laws introduced in July there is now going to be taxes on products that never had taxes before, hairdressing is one of these. With this there will be an increase in the price to have your haircut (shown by the arrows, and the dot for new price). Although the price has increased, the amount that the hairdresser receives has decreased (amount received shown on diagram). The area between this is the tax wedge, or the government tax revenue. The government tax revenue is the amount that the hairdresser will have to pay the government for every hair cut, and then they will redistribute to the public. Tax burden falls on both the producer and the consumer; this is shown because the wedge has taken an even share from both sides of the equilibrium line. Consumer and producer surplus are both labelled on the diagram. Consumer surplus is found above the equilibrium line, and is the area or surplus of what consumers have to pay and what they are willing to pay. That is why it is above the equilibrium because that is the level they have to pay and the space above this line and the demand curve is the surplus. Producer surplus is the area from the equilibrium point and down until it hits the horizontal axis. This is the surplus of what the producers were willing to sell the product for and what they are selling it for. Dead weight loss is another area labelled on the diagram. This is the area where the consumers were willing to pay this price, but the producer could not supply it at that price now that tax has been introduced. This now means people have to pay more for a haircut and that a hairdresser does not receive as much revenue from each cut because they have to pay tax. The reduction in consumer and producer surplus is bad for welfare, but the tax revenue is good because then the money can be redistributed to the public, so the dead weight loss can have both a bad and good outcome. The new tax package is broad and with the introduction of the higher income taxes it is going to give consumers more of an incentive to buy items as they have more money in their pockets. But this may not be the case, as the new tax regulations mean that items that never use to be taxed are, and previously taxed items will increase in price. When the new tax regulations are introduced this may, at the beginning, reduce the demand for some products, but these producers may not be able to lower prices as they now have to pay a tax, therefore the dead weight loss may grow in size. Producers may have to reduce the levels they supply because they may not be able to pay the tax, or buy the raw materials now that they have gone up in price. Although there may seem to be a large amount of problems with the new tax laws, they will end up making all producers even and will not disadvantage some trades as the previous law may have. [IMG-6] [6] Biblography Gans, J., King, S. and Mankiw, N. (1999). Principles Of Microeconomics. NSW: Harcourt Brace and Company. [1] Reasonable diagram and discussion The diagram and the discussion are reasonable and indicate that the four-step process has been applied to assist the analysis of the market arriving at the new equilibrium. It would have been improved with a more systematic explanation of the market model and then a concise discussion of the adjustment. [2] Poor understanding of supply curve Clearly the student has not absorbed an understanding that the supply curve in the electricity market is related to the costs experienced by the market producers. The answer should have reflected that the new pollution reduction equipment would increase the costs of electricity production, and ceteris paribus decrease the amount of electricity to be supplied. A shift to the left of the supply curve resulting in a reduction in supply and an increase in market equilibrium price. On the other side of the market, following the law of demand, the increased price will necessarily lead to a decrease in the quantity demanded. [3] Could be more precise Similarly to (a), the answer identified and discussed the adjustment processes using the four-step method. The answer could have been more precise, particularly in the use of the related Economics terminology. The phrase "upward movement along the curve" is a little confusing. Overall a satisfactory answer. [4] Could have improved answer This answer could have been improved considerably with only a few minor adjustments. Also the separate parts of the question being addressed needed to be identified. (a) Examples of the types of drugs for instance, those with and without substitutes, those for patients possibly suffering terminal illness, as against those for simple remedies, headaches, etc. (b) This part is solid, with the identification of the inelastic curve and the demonstration of the small decrease in quantity demanded clearly illustrated graphically an understanding of the concept. The revenue gains and losses were adequately demonstrated. However, details of the elasticity coefficient and the features of the different values and their relationship to the impact on total revenue of a price increase would have provided a more complete answer. [5] Answer did not clearly identify... This part of the question was to allow students to bring in their own views and general knowledge. As well, it allowed the student the opportunity to use the tools of economics learned to date to compare the predictions from the economic diagrams to the perceived outcomes indicated by the media and government. The correctness or otherwise of the answer was not the issue, but the experience of manipulating the diagrams. Further lecturer's comment The answer did not again identify clearly the parts of the question being addressed. Even though the appropriate sections could be identified by the words commencing each part the use of (a-d) may have assisted your thinking. One diagram could have been used to illustrate the normal market place with demand (consumer surplus) and supply (producer surplus), and then another with the added GST application and the identification of the government revenue. This would have given clear reference points for the discussion for parts (a) and (b). Another diagram demonstrating how the application of the GST might fall differently upon producers and consumers would have also improved the answer (e.g. a more inelastic demand curve and an elastic supply curve). Part (c) the discussion of the dead weight loss needed an explanation as to why this area is a loss to society as a whole. Some indication that government taxes (GST) can distort market signals and cause distortions in the allocation of resources with the result that there will be welfare implications for all. Part (d) might have addressed some of the comments from the media regarding the impact of the GST and these could have been illustrated where possible. Some issues raised may have been - the increased compliance costs upon producers over and above the 10% collected on behalf of the government; that these additional costs may force some small operators out of the market place completely; the likelihood that with increased prices, consumers may tend to decrease consumption and increase their savings; the claim that people who evade tax presently cannot evade it on most purchases especially with having to have ABN numbers; the black economy should shrink and increase the economy's tax take overall. [6] In APA Style this is called References. Rebecca's comments What is different about a VCE and a university assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I found with VCE that they give you the criteria of... if you want to do well, this is what you've got to put in and how much detail has to be given. Whereas I'm also...and I find that TAFE is a lot more practical and the questions don't so much... you have to go into detail, but you have to find all the knowledge behind it. It's not so much about the detail and how much you can write, it's about your research and what you've found and what you find useful. What is it like to do an assignment at university? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> My Economics assignment, I found I could relate some parts of it to my normal life; which probably helps with writing the assignment. Learning like; oh, well if there's a shortage of this then the supply will decrease and stuff like that. So I could relate it to my personal life, but I also found it hard - there was topics about tax and stuff like that and I am not really educated in the world of Economics or Accounting or something like that. When I was in VCE, I did a lot of Science subjects, I didn't do any business subjects. So I didn't sort of know what I was talking about when it came to taxes or stuff like that; which probably might be general knowledge to some people, but to me it was just a new experience where I didn't know what I was doing. I'm sure reading up on stuff like that did help a little. What are some differences between TAFE and university subjects? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I do find TAFE a lot more practical because a lot of the stuff I learnt there I can put into everyday use and I can see it all happening once. I'd agree I could go out somewhere and I could go, "Oh, that's what I learnt at TAFE, and that's it happening there." Whereas with Uni subjects, the ones I've done so far have seemed to be very theoretical and not something that you can probably go out and do, "Oh, well that's what I learnt at Uni today." It's a lot more theory based, and hopefully later down the track or even when I get a job that a lot of the theory will come back into use. I suppose Economics is a bit different because with the changing in prices and stuff like that you can sort of see where the Economics I learnt in one semester comes into use. So it is a bit more practical than some of the other Uni subjects that I've... How do you cope with the terminology at university? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I suppose you take the terminology for our Uni subjects from just what you read and what they tell you in the lectures and what you read in your textbooks and stuff like that. It's just stuff that you have to pick up, it's not so much given to you. They don't so much say, "You have to use our terminology", but you are marked down heavily if you don't use their terminology and if you don't grasp their theories and stuff that you learn during the lectures... What is a difference between teachers' assistance at school and at university? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I think with the Uni assignments, the language has to be precise and the genre of the subject. It's hard to know, if you've never done the subjects before, if you're on the right track, or if you're writing what they want to know - if you're information is what they want. It's very different, what detail they want you to go into... What is a difference between university and TAFE assignment questions? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The TAFE questions are very different from Uni questions. I find that they have a lot more, they're sort of loaded questions - they've got a lot more in the questions. So that helps you with what you have to do. I don't find them as hard to know where to start, whereas the Uni questions are very broad and I find TAFE questions very specific and you sort of know where you're going with TAFE questions. I find the TAFE teachers are around a lot more and they're a lot easier to find and ask questions... What is a difference between writing in Economics at university and at TAFE? (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Well, I know I have trouble expressing myself and knowing what to say and what parts of the theory to bring in and if you should be technical or if you should be explaining what you know - showing your knowledge to the lecturer, tutor or whoever is marking your assignment. That I didn't know what to write, and I found I was under the word limit. I think my problem with that was because I was too broad; I knew what I was doing and I didn't know how to elaborate on what I had written and what I knew... What is a difference between writing in Economics at university and at TAFE? (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I found it very hard to crossover from the Uni and TAFE expectations. I find when I am writing a Uni subject, I have to really sit down and think, "Oh this is a Uni subject, I'll have to go into a lot more detail and I have to use proper English." Whereas with TAFE you can write things in dot points and your assignments they don't so much put a word limit on you very much, they just say, "Well, you write what you want to write." Whereas with Uni they give you the word limit and you feel that you have to meet that word limit. It's very different. What is a difference between writing in Economics at university and at TAFE? (part 3) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Well, the Uni questions are very ambiguous and very broad, you don't know where to start and what they really want you to write about. I find that if you don't listen to your lecturer very carefully when they're going over what they want in the assignment - it's not written down anywhere for you, so you've really got to listen to them; and they speak so fast you can't write it down anyway. But they tell you what they want and they sort of give you a starting point but it's only if whether you pick up on their clues where they're going, or else you're out there by yourself and you've just gotta guess I suppose. What else is different about a VCE and a university assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I think it's also, when you're doing VCE, you get the criteria and you can hand in your assignment a different criteria at a time. Where with Uni assignments, you have to do the whole assignment at once and you have to hand it all in at the one date. I find you don't have as long as when you were doing VCE to do like a ...or an assignment that you had there. You could draft it and re-draft it and give it to the teacher and they could give you feedback. Whereas with Uni, you do the whole assignment, and you probably only got about three weeks to do it and you can't see your tutors or lecturers... What was your first reaction to your Economics assignment task? (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I first got the assignment, I think it was in the first lecture and they gave us a whole heap of sheets and a whole...there was probably about twenty of them and a booklet, which was the student manual. Which I sort of put aside and started focusing on my lectures because I was really stressed about catching up... it was a new subject that I'd never done before. Then, I think it was brought up by a lecturer in the lecture, "Oh, and your assignment's due..." And I think I was shocked, I was like, "Oh my God, I better get the sheets out and start looking." So I had a quick look and I went to tutorials that week. And the tutor gave us an example of Question 1 and showed us the types of things they were looking for; not so much the exact question, but she gave similar ones which sort of made me think I should get my assignment out and have a look. What was your first reaction to your Economics assignment task? (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I got the questions and I started looking over and trying to interpret them, I was shocked and it got me, I really didn't know what I was doing and I suppose if I hadn't gone to my tutorials and probably used my textbook and done a lot a reading I would have been lost, but interpreting the questions I started from the base point and went "well, what are they really looking for?" and hopefully from there I went on the right track. What do you think about the way you approached your Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> My approach to the Economic assignment was in effect if I wrote dot points down when I was doing my graphs or whenever I thought of something, I think it was effective but maybe not for that assignment. I lost my momentum because I only wrote those dot points down and when I went to write down the questions, I didn't do one question all at once, I only elaborated on one dot point, so therefore I think I sort of lost my momentum of what I was writing about. In the end it sort of didn't come off that well. How would you describe Economics assignment questions? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I suppose I was able to call the questions broad, because they only give you the starting point and they sort of say "this is what we want you to do" but it doesn't really say where they want to you start and which bits they would like to hear more about and which bits in details and what part of the questions you only have to into a little bit of detail about. What did you draw on to complete your Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> When I got my Economics assignment it wasn't so much a research assignment, there was a lot of which you could have used resources to read it over. But it went off your general knowledge of what you've learnt in the lecturers and what you have read in your text book, it wasn't so much a research based assignment it was more an interpretation of what you knew and showing your knowledge of the task. What was your first challenge in completing your Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I find there is a concern when you start the assignment, because if you stuff up at the start or you do something wrong in the first part of the question the rest of the question is sort of gone and that can ruin the whole thing, because if you start on the wrong track you are always going to head down that same wrong track. What was of assistance in completing your Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> It was very much a big learning curve. I find that once you've handed the first assignment in for a new subject that you have never done before you can sort of see where you're going from. Where you probably need to go from there if you've got three or four assignments for one new subject, you find with the first one you do what you think you should be doing and then from there you can either talk to your lecturer or read over the notes written on your assignment. That can point you in the next direction for the next assignment and say "well this is the bit where they want us to do better or they want us to write like this." How can you learn to use language appropriate for Economics? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Uni students are supposed to very independent. I suppose that's because tutors and lecturers aren't there all the time like in VCE and even as much TAFE people are always there and are always around for you to ask questions too. With Uni lecturers you can't find them a lot of the time and when you can find them they can only talk to you on a broad level, they can't really talk to you specifically about the assignment and stuff like that. I think it's good because I am friends with quite a few people at Uni that we could all talk about what we'd done with the questions and where we're having troubles and I think that's good, but it also can cast out into mind over what you've done and what they've done and who's right and who's wrong. You can't really tell, you just go by the majority of what the class has done and even the majority have all done the wrong thing... How are you expected to use language in Economics? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I am lucky because I'm at TAFE. The group that I'm at TAFE with go across to Uni with me so all my friends that I have from TAFE are at Uni, too, so when I started I didn't feel overwhelmed by the number of people there, the lecturers and all the scary things that go on at Uni. I think it's because I'm at TAFE with these people that I've got a big group of friends there and it made easier to make friends at Uni because my TAFE friends knew a few people and I knew a few people and we've all integrated What would you do better with this type of assignment next time? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I'd probably, if I had to do the assignment over again, I probably would of started a lot earlier, instead of ... I probably would of made a time to sit down and do, because it was broken into three, ... I'd probably sit down and do one question and then probably leave it for a couple of days, go over, reread the question again and see where I may of gone wrong or made it better. Yeh, I probably would of gone to a lot more resources and read a lot more text books about what to write and stuff like that, I'd probably, yeh, maybe ask my tutor a lot more questions...... How did you feel when you received the mark for the Economics assignment? (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I found with economics I know what I am doing and when I'm sitting in the lecture or when I was doing my assignment, Oh yeh, I know what I am doing here, this is breezy this is breezy and maybe because I was too broad or maybe I didn't elaborate on the bits that they wanted more detail over. I didn't go as well as I thought I would and it was a bit upsetting when I got my assignment back but I think in the end, like it's all a learning experience and it helped me sit back and go oh well ..., next assignment or for the exam I know that I have to go into more detail over this or I have to learn this bit of it, or you know, oh well that bits good, yes but you didn't elab..... How did you feel when you received the mark for the Economics assignment? (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Yeh, I think it very much is, um, hard because the marks are so broad, there's like, you know, pass the hardest things and there's not many marks in-between and um, you know, you can be a really high pass but you still just get a pass, and it, or you could be a really low high distinction but you still get that high distinction back. You know, its really hard to stay positive when you get an assignment back and you don't go as well as you probably hoped you would or what you expected to get. I think, yeh, you've just got to lean to stay really really positive. How do you balance your time when completing university assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Time with Uni assignments I find very difficult, er, they sort of creep up on you, when its due and having time to find how to do an assignment along with tutorial questions you might have and the readings for the lectures and interpreting what you have learnt in the lectures, its very time consuming.... How can friends help you with your assignments at university? (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I have a very busy Uni and TAFE schedule so I have time slotted away each week hopefully to do questions and readings for my Uni subjects but I find that the assignments are always left up to the last..... How can friends help you with your assignments at university? (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I think friends are very good at Uni because, yeh, they do help you stay positive and they are always there but it's also hard when you are sitting there and you know you studied very hard for that test or you did a lot of work on that assignment and your friends got better than you and you know they only did it the night before but I suppose you have just got to learn that they just interpret it a different way, or, you know, you wrote about something that they probably didn't write about and they probably went into detail about something you probably should have, so that's why they got the higher mark than you. How can friends help you with your assignments at university? (part 3) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Yeh, I think having a big group of friends and good friends at Uni can help if, you know, if you seem to be struggling, because you can't, you know, they, well hopefully will let you look at their assignments and you can see where they went better than you and you could probably sit back and say oh well that's the bit I should of elaborated on and so can help you for your next assignment saying oh well this is the bit where my friend elaborated last time maybe I should elaborate this time there. What help did you get from your lecturer and tutor for your assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> After we got the assignment, our lecturer sort of, the lectures from there on, like the next three lectures were sort of based around what we had to do on the assignment so then when we went to tut... our tutors seemed to go through questions which were very similar to the ones in the assignment, but not exactly the same. So there are pointers saying oh well do this and then you do this and its sort of, examples of what to do and what to write but not exactly what had to be done in the assignment. Where can you get help with your assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> In getting assistance with your Uni subjects and assignments is very difficult, I don't know if this is just at my campus or if its like campuses all over the place but there's not so much anyone that can help you. You can go to your lecturer or your tutor with very broad questions but you can't go with direct questions about your exact assignment. Or if you are having trouble with your assignment you can't really go up and say, well I've done this, is this right. They will say, well we can't tell you that, this is the question and they sometimes emphasise things or say, oh well, this chapter would really help you in the text book but they can't really, yeh, they're not as direct as they ... How do you feel when you are completing an assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> It's a very stressful time when you've got a Uni assignment but I think it's very, you are very glad once you've handed it in. You may not think you've gone well with it, you're excited and relieved that you have got rid of it. Um, I found it very hard, it's very stressful. How did you feel when you had handed in your Economics assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/economics/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Um, ... out of my way but I was very uncertain in how I went and I was very, I wouldn't of been able to say, oh yes I went very well in that assignment, I think I was very unsure of how I went in what parts I had done right and what parts I had gone badly in. If you'd asked me I would probably say the whole assignment.... Download the full interview with Rebecca (mp3, 11.7 MB). <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/assets/utilities/download.php?file=assets/audio/rebecca/rebeccaall.mp3> Management assignment This tutorial contains information about writing based on materials from the first-year subject Managing People and Organisations. You will also find much of the information to be useful for your other Management subjects. Navigate through the tutorial using the Table of Contents on the left. The tutorial's three main sections are outlined below. Lecturer's advice <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/1.xml> Get information from the lecturer about what is required for Management assignments. Skills for writing in Management <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/2.xml> Learn to write better assignments through interactive tasks. Annotated assignments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.xml> View samples of student work with lecturer and student comments. Lecturer's advice In this section, one of your lecturers - Loretta Inglis - answers Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) about researching and writing of reports in first-year Management. FAQs: Click on those topic areas that are of interest to you, or that you need to know more about. 1. 2. 3. 4. What do you look for when marking an assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq1> What makes a good first-year Management report? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq2> What are the main difficulties students have? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq3> How much reading and research should I do for my assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq4> 5. What are some of the differences between writing for Management at university and for Business Management at VCE? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq5> 6. What final advice do you have for students? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq6> 1. What do you look for when marking an assignment? Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Summary: use of the case study method throughout use of supporting theory and evidence properly completed solutions, recommendations, and implementation First of all, the assignment should show that you have used the [1]case study method throughout. The main section is the Problem Identification section where we look for the ability to succinctly identify problems, a relevant theory which explains the problem, and case evidence which illustrates the problems. We also look for a range of possible solutions for each problem, which should be thoroughly evaluated, with at least two to three advantages and disadvantages being given for each one. Finally, we want a clear recommendation (or two or three) which is justified using the theory, and an Implementation section presented in concise, practical steps. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 2. What makes a good 1st Year Management report? Summary: consistently good quality in all sections In terms of the qualities of a good assignment, a High Distinction assignment would be consistently very good in every section. Many students do a good job of the Problem Identification section, then fail to allow enough time to put the work into the latter parts of the assignment. In the case where students fail, this is because they do not seem to have read the information, and have tried to do the assignment in a hurry. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 3. What are the main difficulties students have? Summary: leaving preparation to the last minute using theory appropriately inadequate recommendations and implementation Case studies just require time in the preparation. Most students don't actually have all that much trouble producing a satisfactory case in the end. They eventually get the idea in identifying problems and usually they do a reasonable job of generating suggestions. Writing up the problems, case evidence, and relevant theory is the demanding part because students will have rarely experienced an assignment like this before. In particular, I think all first-year students find it hard to recognise when theory is appropriate and how to use it. Where students go wrong is that too many appear to leave their preparation to the last minute or just run out of time and ideas. So the Recommendations section and, particularly, the Implementation section, is often poorly done. In some cases, students will do the early sections extremely well and just throw marks away in the later sections. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 4. How much reading and research should I do for my assignment? Summary: Check course guidelines, lecture material Use a targeted reading strategy Go beyond the textbook to other sources In general, I would expect students to start by first reading the relevant case, reading the information about how to do it, and looking at what has been covered in the subject . They should then relate the case to the information they have collected. I would then read the appropriate text chapters and find one or two more texts, or articles on individual topics. Students don't need to do heaps of reading for this case study. Their reading should be targeted in any case because of the problems they identify (i.e. it is fairly easy to find the information). I think it advisable that students learn to use a few more references than the text, such as other management or organisational behaviour texts, or journal articles. In terms of time, they should anticipate between 12-20 hours for research and reading. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 5. What are some of the differences between writing for Management at university and for Business Management at VCE? Summary: the need to think independently the more varied reference material available Most business writing is to the point (i.e. it doesn't waste words). Some students may have trouble focusing on the issue at hand, but I don't see that as a major problem. It's probably because they are used to teachers telling them whether it is right or wrong all the way. This doesn't happen at university and may make some people feel very unsure. What we're interested in is how students think for themselves. Thinking for yourself can involve seeking out additional references. Another important difference is the variety of reference material available in the Management area. We expect students to make good use of this in their written work. This means working out when to cite, and how - and summarising others' views to support your line of argument. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 6. What final advice do you have for students? Summary: read all the information the minute you get it, even if you don't start on the case study immediately go to lectures and tutorials and listen ask questions start early! Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> [1] MONASH UNIVERSITY FACULTY OF BUSINESS AND ECONOMICS DEPARTMENT OF MANAGEMENT MGX1010 MANAGING PEOPLE AND ORGANISATIONS Notes on the Case Study Method The use of case studies is a widely accepted means of bringing theoretical concepts and practical situations together. It is not possible to take a class into an organisation and observe the subject matter of management or organisational behaviour in real life - hence a written case study outlining a real, or realistic, situation is the best available alternative. When reading and studying a case study it is possible to take two different approaches. The first of these is the 'analytical' approach where a case structure is examined to try to understand what has happened and why. In this approach you do not identify problems or attempt to develop solutions. The second approach is the problem-oriented method. In this approach a case is analysed to identify the major problems that exist, the causes of and possible solutions to the problems and finally a recommendation as to the best solution to implement. In this course we mainly utilise a 'PROBLEM SOLVING' case study method. As with most things in the management area there is not 'one best way' to analyse or write up a case report. Everyone develops their own methods of sorting and sifting through the information and presenting their findings. However, in this subject we have a set format which we would like you to utilise when presenting your case reports. This format is outlined briefly below. Some General Issues: In a case study it is crucial that you integrate relevant theory from the course and evidence from the case. Failure to attempt to integrate theory will lead to severe mark reduction or failure. Referencing of all non-original material is essential. You will lose marks for poor referencing. The Faculty of Business and Economic's Q Manual should be used as a guide. This is available in the library, for sale in the bookshop and on the web (see Subject Outline for address). The Q Manual should also be used as a guide for correct presentation of written material. Check your completed work for internal consistency, for example make sure that you attempt to solve the key issues you have identified., Don't say 'X' is the major problem and then recommend a solution to 'Y'. Try not to be overly descriptive. Remember you are trying to identify, analyse and solve the problems of the case using the relevant theories from the course - not just repeating what the text book, or case information, has said. PRESENTATION OF WRITTEN MATERIAL The following notes are to be used as a guide to students the case studies for assessment in MGX1010. GUIDELINES A high standard of presentation is required. Typing, or word processing, of all is expected. Work that is submitted in an illegible or untidy fashion may, at your tutor's discretion, be returned unmarked or with marks deducted for poor presentation. In no circumstances should an assignment be written/typed on both sides of the paper. Work should be double or 1 spaced. A margin of 30mm should be left on both sides of the page. This provides adequate room for examiner's comments as well as creating an uncluttered presentation. All quotations should be enclosed within inverted commas. The exception is quotations of two or more sentences which run to four or more lines. These should be single-spaced and indented from the main body of the text. In these cases inverted commas are unnecessary (see Qmanual). Assignments should be bound firmly into a cover, such as a manilla folder, plastic folder, ring binder, etc. Please do not use envelope folders or submit loose sheets. It should be possible to read every page without undoing any fastenings. Every assignment must be clearly identified. The following details must be on the front of all assignments: o Name: o Student Number: o Assignment Name: o Subject Code/Name: o Lecturer/Tutor: o Due Date: o Date Submitted: It is recommended that students KEEP A COPY OF ALL WORK SUBMITTED. While it is extremely rare for student work to be misplaced, it does sometimes occur. The onus is on you to prove that a piece of work was submitted. Grammar, spelling and punctuation are matters which should not be neglected. Failure to take care of these matters causes confusion and ambiguity. Ask someone to read and comment critically on your work prior to submitting it; can they understand what you are trying to say? If not, re-write it! PROBLEM SOLVING CASE FORMAT FOR PRESENTATION 1. Title Page 2. Table of Contents 3. Executive Summary This section should comprise a brief overview of the case, giving a brief background and noting any important assumptions made. (You will not have all the information you would like - so you may need to make some assumptions). As well as this, you should give a synopsis of your case report, noting very briefly the major problems identified and the recommended solutions. One page is enough. 4. Problem Identification and Analysis In this section you should identify all the major problems in the case in behavioural terms, ie. in Management/OB related terms (it is not a marketing or an accounting case). Try to get to underlying causes of problems, not just symptoms. Seek advice from your tutor on the layout of this information. You should link each problem identified to relevant theory and also to actual evidence from the case. Remember you MUST integrate theory and reference all non-original work. 5. Statement of Major Problems In most case studies you will identify a number of problems - too many to actually 'solve' in the number of words allowed. Hence it is crucial to make it very clear which are the major two or three problems or key issues, that must be solved first. Therefore this section is just a short concise statement of what problems you are going to solve in the remainder of the case. Half a page is adequate. Having once identified the key problems, you can continually check back to ensure that you are actually attempting to solve them and not some other minor problems you identified. This section is crucial to a good case report. 6. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions While most problems will have a very large number of possible solutions it is your task to identify and evaluate a number of the more appropriate (at least 2-3 for each major problem identified). Each alternative solution should be briefly outlined and then evaluated in terms of its advantages and disadvantages (strong and weak points). Note: You must evaluate alternatives. It is not necessary to make a statement in this section as to which alternative is considered best - this is the next section. Do not integrate theory in this section and do not recommend theory. Practical solutions to the problems are required. 7. Recommendation This section should state which of the alternative solutions (either singly or in combination) identified in section six is recommended for implementation. You should briefly justify your choice, explaining how it will solve the major problems identified in section six. Integration of relevant theory is appropriate here. 8. Implementation In this section you should specifically explain how you will implement the recommended solutions. Theory cannot be implemented; you must translate it into actions. What should be done, by whom, when, in what sequence, what will it cost (rough estimates only) and other such issues. Remember if a recommended solution cannot be realistically implemented then it is no solution at all. 9. Appendices (if any) 10. Bibliography/References This will contain an alphabetical list of all the references you have cited in the body of the report. Do not include details of any sources you have not cited. Ensure the style used is correct and consistent. Skills for writing in Management In this section, you have the opportunity to learn and practise different aspects of writing Management case studies. The materials and the tasks in this module specifically cover the Problem Identification and Recommendations sections. The information contained in them however, is relevant to the whole case study. A range of practice tasks is included in each topic. If you wish to explore all topic areas, work on these in the order given. Topics: Identify problems <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/2.1.xml> - Writing the problem identification section Alternative solutions <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/2.2.xml> - Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions Recommendations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/2.3.xml> - Writing the recommendations section Identifying problems Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. The Problem Identification section is the most important section of the case study report. In it, you will need to: identify all the major problems in the case in terms of the management concepts you have studied; focus on the underlying causes of problems, not just their symptoms; link each problem identified to both relevant theory and evidence from the case study (i.e. integrate theory with your analysis); reference all non-original work. Before starting on the tasks below, read the [1]Case Study Summary. Please note that the Summary does not contain all the events discussed in the original. If you prefer, you can go straight to the [2]full case study Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors. For further advice you can also consult the [3]Notes on the Case Study Method. Ordering and presenting information Good writing in Management, as in other subject areas, requires the structured presentation of information. The normal pattern for this in English is Introduction - Body - Conclusion, and this structure broadly applies in the Problem Identification section as well. As your focus is the solution of a managerial problem, the body of the Problem Identification section will also need to cover the following information: theory (theories, concepts, issues raised by other writers/experts) case evidence your own comments (ideas about, or evaluation of, the problem). The table below shows how this information is incorporated within the Introduction-Body-Conclusion structure. Notice how the Body includes two stages: Problem identification Introduction 1 - Introductory Stage Body 2 - Case Evidence Stage 3 - Commentary Stage Conclusion 4 - Conclusion Stage identifies the problem arising out of the case study usually introduces some initial theory as background to the problem identified introduces case evidence to illustrate the problem identified may also incorporate further theory comments on the problem presented through interpretation, discussion of possible outcomes, etc. is based on student's own thinking can also incorporate theory makes a concluding general statement about the problem before moving on to the next section or sub-section Remember, you can use theory anywhere within any stage. (Adapted from Notes on the Case Study Method: Department of Management, Monash University) [1] Case Study Summary Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless is a large Sydney legal firm. Among its staff are 22 data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre (WPC). Their job is to process the large volume of legal documents produced by the firm's solicitors. WPC clerks are carefully selected and must have a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in specialised legal documents, and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure they keep their knowledge up-to-date. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The WPC is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The centre is very well equipped with excellent furnishings and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many other benefits. However, all is not well. Senior staff and solicitors have complained to Arthur Lawton, the Managing Partner, that they need to check the work of WPC clerks who work as relief secretaries, because of the frequent errors made. They also believe that these workers are unreliable and lack initiative. Personnel records show that WPC staff do not stay with the firm for very long, despite the opportunities for promotion. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the WPC supervisor, who has worked with the firm for over 20 years. Indeed, they tend to see the problem as the result of something wrong "with young people today." When Mr Lawton raises the matter of the WPC's problems, Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily. She defends her clerks, saying that despite the errors, they do complete a lot of work. She admits that many of them find the job boring, as it mostly involves keying in information. The clerks also, often come to work late, chat at every opportunity, and generally don't work too hard. To stop this, she keeps a firm eye on them but she believes she can't be too hard or they will leave the firm. Mrs Blakely then explains the WPC system. The work to be done arrives from each solicitor and is allocated to the clerks on a daily basis. To ensure they know what to do, she goes over each piece of work with them before they do the job. When information needs to be clarified, Mrs Blakely goes to the relevant solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the job is finished and returns it to the solicitors. Her job however, also means she liaises with solicitors on other floors, so she is often away from the Centre. Mrs Blakely agrees that the workers do not perform very well as relief secretaries, but thinks this is because the work is more complex than they are trained to do. She says the solicitors do not help the relief secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. When questioned, the WPC clerks say they like working for the firm and would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces everyday as they are isolated on the 35th floor and have no contact with other staff, except with each other and Mrs Blakely. After trying to improve efficiency through the use of piped music - an experiment which fails - Mr Lawton turns to you, as an external management consultant, for advice. [2] MGM 1300 INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT Semester One, 1996 GROUP CASE STUDY Using the Case Study Method analyse the problems, generate solutions and make recommendations for the following case. DUE DATE: Tutorial, Week 11, Week Beginning May 20, 1996 Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Peter Lawless looked over his desk at Arthur Lawton and frowned. "Look, Arthur, I need a new secretary now. I thought the idea of the Word Processing Centre was, that we recruited talented people and trained them there, so they were ready and available when we need them. We spend a lot of money on the Centre and I hear on the grapevine that the work is often sub standard, and now you're telling me that there is no one there really qualified to be my new secretary. What's going wrong! I have had Kathleen Pearce temporarily for the past two weeks, but if she is the best qualified person in the Centre, then it's not doing the job. Her skills are fine, but she has no initiative and doesn't have much of a clue about what we do in this firm - and she has worked here for 18 months! She is a nice girl, but she is not up to it." Arthur Lawton sighed. "Obviously something is not working. We do recruit well trained, bright, young people and hope that one to two years in the WPC will teach them all they need to know about our firm, and I believe Kathleen Pearce is the best qualified there. I am afraid you will have to persevere with Kathleen. There's nobody else." Arthur Lawton and Peter Lawless are senior partners in the legal firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Arthur is also the Managing Partner responsible for handling the administration of the large firm which consists of 25 partners and 48 employed solicitors, plus approximately 80 support staff working in the Sydney office. Twenty two of the support staff are data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre. Their job is to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports, etc. Only well qualified people are employed, usually with a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in the specialised legal documents and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure up to date knowledge of legal documents. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The Word Processing Centre is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The office is very well equipped with modern, ergonomic furniture and equipment, excellent furnishings, and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many benefits such as a superannuation scheme, health scheme, social club and other non salary benefits. After his discussion with Peter Lawless, the Managing Partner, Mr Lawton, feels it is time to find out why the centre is having problems, so he asks around the firm, having talks with other partners and solicitors. He discovers that, although the centre is very productive, there are several concerns. Most solicitors feel they must check each piece of work carefully because there are often errors made. Not necessarily typing errors, but careless errors such as the wrong names or facts keyed into documents. As the clerks are well qualified and trained by the firm, there is a belief that the error rate is unacceptable. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the supervisor, and suggest that there is something wrong "with young people today". Mr Lawton's personnel records also suggest that the turnover rate in the centre is also unacceptable. Only three clerks in the Centre have worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only 12 months or so, despite careful selection of excellent staff. The partners of the firm each have their own secretary, and it is the firm's policy that these secretaries be recruited from the Word Processing Centre workers. Three to five of these vacancies arise each year, with workers from the Centre also relieving when the secretaries are on holidays. Although this opportunity for promotion attracts new workers to the firm, it does not seem to keep many of them long enough to take up the chance. There have also been complaints that, when a clerk has been used as a relief for a secretary, they have proved unreliable if left to their own devices and they lacked initiative. Mr Lawton then talks with Mrs Lorraine Blakely, the supervisor, about the Centre. She has worked with the firm in various administrative capacities for over 20 years and is greatly liked and admired by all the partners and lawyers in the firm. They found her very pleasant and helpful to deal with and always efficient in getting their work through the centre in a short time. She enjoys her job, particularly dealing with the solicitors in the firm, most of whom have worked with her for years. They believe that she is very efficient and they all like to deal with her on a regular basis. Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily when Mr Lawton brings up the matter of the WPC's problems. She springs to the defence of her "girls", saying that although there are errors made, they do get through a lot of work. She does admit that, she believes not many of the clerks like their job very much as they find it boring, as most of the work is simply keying in information into the forms provided on the firm's computer network. She finds that they will come late to work, chat with each other at every opportunity, take long breaks and generally "slack off". To stop this she keeps a firm eye on them, but on the other hand, she tells him, you can't be too hard on them or they will leave quickly, and it is very hard to get good people to stay long. She insists that she must keep her "girls" happy if they are to be productive and stay with the firm, and she doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer or help them to be better secretaries. She states that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun and there is nothing that she can do about that. Mrs Blakely explains the WPC's system to him. The work to be done in the Centre arrives from each solicitor with a request sheet with details of what is required. Mrs Blakely then allocates work to the clerks each day. To ensure they know what to do she is in the habit of going over each piece of work with them before they do the job. There is often a need to clarify some issue with the solicitor. When this is the case, Mrs Blakely goes to the solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the clerks have finished and returns it to the solicitors. She emphasises again to Mr Lawton that she does keep a stern eye on the workers to ensure that they are not wasting time. She insists that tea and lunch break times are strictly adhered to, and discourages chatting during working hours, although as her job means she must be liaising with solicitors on other floors, she is not in the Centre quite a lot. She agrees that the workers do not do very well when they relieve a secretary, but feels it is all so strange to them, much more complex work than they have been used to, but her staff are the best available, and the solicitors just need to put a bit of effort into helping them to learn the job. She says the solicitors do not help their new secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. She suggests to Mr Lawton that she could check every piece of work before it leaves the centre, though this would slow the turnaround time considerably. When questioned about their job the clerks say they like working for the firm, would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces every day as they are isolated in the WPC on the 35th Floor and have no contact with anyone apart from each other and Mrs Blakely. Peter Lawless's temporary secretary, Kathleen Pearce, who is the longest serving clerk, tells Mr Lawton that, although she loves working with so many people her own age, and Mrs Blakely is a lovely boss, always friendly and helpful, she feels like she is still in school, with someone always watching what you are doing and telling her what to do. She has stayed with the firm because the conditions are good and she hopes to achieve promotion. She does, however, express doubts about her ability as "eighteen months of straight keying have made me forget most of what I learned in TAFE and I don't seem to have learnt much about what the solicitors do working in the WPC". Mr Lawton decides to install a piped music system, believing this will add interest to their day's work and aid concentration. The workers are very pleased with this and even say that it speeds up their work. Unfortunately six months later the error rate has even increased, the turnover is still high, and Kathleen Pearce, after six months as secretary to Peter Lawless is just beginning to show more confidence and initiative in her job. Although Peter is happy with her now, he feels he has wasted a lot of time and energy in helping her settle into the job and he tells Arthur Lawton that he believes the problems with the WPC would not be solved by the piped music. Mr Lawton has approached you, an external management consulting firm, to help them identify the real problems, to suggest some possible solutions and make recommendations. Your brief is to examine and analyse the case material and to produce a report, based on the problem solving case method, for Mr Lawton. [3] MONASH UNIVERSITY FACULTY OF BUSINESS AND ECONOMICS DEPARTMENT OF MANAGEMENT MGX1010 MANAGING PEOPLE AND ORGANISATIONS Notes on the Case Study Method The use of case studies is a widely accepted means of bringing theoretical concepts and practical situations together. It is not possible to take a class into an organisation and observe the subject matter of management or organisational behaviour in real life - hence a written case study outlining a real, or realistic, situation is the best available alternative. When reading and studying a case study it is possible to take two different approaches. The first of these is the 'analytical' approach where a case structure is examined to try to understand what has happened and why. In this approach you do not identify problems or attempt to develop solutions. The second approach is the problem-oriented method. In this approach a case is analysed to identify the major problems that exist, the causes of and possible solutions to the problems and finally a recommendation as to the best solution to implement. In this course we mainly utilise a 'PROBLEM SOLVING' case study method. As with most things in the management area there is not 'one best way' to analyse or write up a case report. Everyone develops their own methods of sorting and sifting through the information and presenting their findings. However, in this subject we have a set format which we would like you to utilise when presenting your case reports. This format is outlined briefly below. Some General Issues: In a case study it is crucial that you integrate relevant theory from the course and evidence from the case. Failure to attempt to integrate theory will lead to severe mark reduction or failure. Referencing of all non-original material is essential. You will lose marks for poor referencing. The Faculty of Business and Economic's Q Manual should be used as a guide. This is available in the library, for sale in the bookshop and on the web (see Unit Outline for address). The Q Manual should also be used as a guide for correct presentation of written material. Check your completed work for internal consistency, for example make sure that you attempt to solve the key issues you have identified., Don't say 'X' is the major problem and then recommend a solution to 'Y'. Try not to be overly descriptive. Remember you are trying to identify, analyse and solve the problems of the case using the relevant theories from the course - not just repeating what the text book, or case information, has said. PRESENTATION OF WRITTEN MATERIAL The following notes are to be used as a guide to students preparing the case studies for assessment in MGX1010. GUIDELINES A high standard of presentation is required. Typing, or word processing, of all is expected. Work that is submitted in an illegible or untidy fashion may, at your tutor's discretion, be returned unmarked or with marks deducted for poor presentation. In no circumstances should an assignment be written/typed on both sides of the paper. Work should be double or 1.5 spaced. A margin of 30mm should be left on both sides of the page. This provides adequate room for examiner's comments as well as creating an uncluttered presentation. All quotations should be enclosed within inverted commas. The exception is quotations of two or more sentences which run to four or more lines. These should be single-spaced and indented from the main body of the text. In these cases inverted commas are unnecessary (see Q Manual). Assignments should be bound firmly into a cover, such as a manilla folder, plastic folder, ring binder, etc. Please do not use envelope folders or submit loose sheets. It should be possible to read every page without undoing any fastenings. Every assignment must be clearly identified. The following details must be on the front of all assignments: o Name: o Student Number: o Assignment Name: o Subject Code/Name: o Lecturer/Tutor: o Due Date: o Date Submitted: It is recommended that students KEEP A COPY OF ALL WORK SUBMITTED. While it is extremely rare for student work to be misplaced, it does sometimes occur. The onus is on you to prove that a piece of work was submitted. Grammar, spelling and punctuation are matters which should not be neglected. Failure to take care of these matters causes confusion and ambiguity. Ask someone to read and comment critically on your work prior to submitting it; can they understand what you are trying to say? If not, re-write it! PROBLEM SOLVING CASE FORMAT FOR PRESENTATION 1. Title Page 2. Table of Contents 3. Executive Summary This section should comprise a brief overview of the case, giving a brief background and noting any important assumptions made. (You will not have all the information you would like - so you may need to make some assumptions). As well as this, you should give a synopsis of your case report, noting very briefly the major problems identified and the recommended solutions. One page is enough. 4. Problem Identification and Analysis In this section you should identify all the major problems in the case in behavioural terms, ie. in Management/OB related terms (it is not a marketing or an accounting case). Try to get to underlying causes of problems, not just symptoms. Seek advice from your tutor on the layout of this information. You should link each problem identified to relevant theory and also to actual evidence from the case. Remember you MUST integrate theory and reference all non-original work. 5. Statement of Major Problems In most case studies you will identify a number of problems - too many to actually 'solve' in the number of words allowed. Hence it is crucial to make it very clear which are the major two or three problems or key issues, that must be solved first. Therefore this section is just a short concise statement of what problems you are going to solve in the remainder of the case. Half a page is adequate. Having once identified the key problems, you can continually check back to ensure that you are actually attempting to solve them and not some other minor problems you identified. This section is crucial to a good case report. 6. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions While most problems will have a very large number of possible solutions it is your task to identify and evaluate a number of the more appropriate (at least 2-3 for each major problem identified). Each alternative solution should be briefly outlined and then evaluated in terms of its advantages and disadvantages (strong and weak points). Note: You must evaluate alternatives. It is not necessary to make a statement in this section as to which alternative is considered best - this is the next section. Do not integrate theory in this section and do not recommend theory. Practical solutions to the problems are required. 7. Recommendation This section should state which of the alternative solutions (either singly or in combination) identified in section six is recommended for implementation. You should briefly justify your choice, explaining how it will solve the major problems identified in section six. Integration of relevant theory is appropriate here. 8. Implementation In this section you should specifically explain how you will implement the recommended solutions. Theory cannot be implemented; you must translate it into actions. What should be done, by whom, when, in what sequence, what will it cost (rough estimates only) and other such issues. Remember if a recommended solution cannot be realistically implemented then it is no solution at all. 9. Appendices (if any) 10. Bibliography/References This will contain an alphabetical list of all the references you have cited in the body of the report. Do not include details of any sources you have not cited. Ensure the style used is correct and consistent. Ordering information Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Read the model Problem Identification below. It analyses problems of inappropriate leadership in the Word Processing Centre (WPC) at the law firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors. Then do the exercise below. Problem Identification 1.1 Leadership Mismatch [1] The Path-Goal Theory suggests that it is a leader's job to assist his/her followers in attaining goals as well as providing direction and support (Schermerhorn, Hunt and Osborn, 1994). [2] There are four types of leader behaviour that can be used to affect a subordinates's motivation, but leadership behaviour which is effective in one situation may not always be effective in another (Schermerhorn et al., 1994). [3] According to the case study, Mrs Blakely, the staff supervisor, checks each piece of work with the WPC staff before they do the job. [4] Since the workers are qualified for their work and well-trained, this leads to annoyance and frustration. [5] According to Kathleen Pearce, Mrs. Blakely makes the WPC staff feel they are still in school because of her constant supervision. [6] As pointed out by Bartol, Martin, Tein and Matthews (1995:471), "using directive leadership to clarify task demands that are already clear will be ineffectual; it might frustrate employees and reduce the work's intrinsic valence." [7] Workers do not need a manager telling them how to do something they already know how to do because "redundant behaviour by the leader will not help and may even hinder performance" (Schermerhorn et al., 1994:504). [8] Thus a major problem in the WPC is that Mrs Blakely is too concerned with the work of her staff which results in their frustration because they are not allowed to be independent and show initiative. Complete the following table. For each of the four stages listed below, identify: the sentences that make up that stage, and whether or not theory has been incorporated in that stage. Stage Sentences Theory? Correct Answers Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 1. Introduction Sentence 4 1-2 and Yes Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 7 Sentence 8 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 2. Case Evidence Sentence 4 Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 7 Sentence 8 3-5 and Yes Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 3. Commentary Sentence 4 6-7 and Yes Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 7 Sentence 8 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 4. Conclusion Sentence 4 8 and No Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 7 Sentence 8 Using theory and evidence Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. This task is designed to give you further insight into the process of problem analysis by modelling how theory, evidence, and commentary can be combined. Read the following two student samples which discuss problems of motivation among the WPC staff. See if you can identify which stage (Introduction, Case Evidence, Commentary, Conclusion) each sentence belongs to. Sample 1 [1] There are three major motivators which stimulate better work (Robbins, 2000, pg. 555). [2] The girls in the WPC need to experience achievement. [3] They do this with their data entry and word processing, but perhaps the girls have a stronger need to succeed through harder and more demanding tasks. [4] They need to experience power. [5] The ability to make someone act in a different way or to be in control of someone is a big motivator. [6] They need to feel a sense of affiliation with other employees, they need to develop interpersonal relations with other staff (Robbins, 2000, pg. 555). Complete the following table, trying to identify which sentence numbers belong to the four stages. Stage Sentence number(s) Correct Answers 1. Introduction 2. Case Evidence 3. Commentary 4. Conclusion Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 1 Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 ? Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 None Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sample 2 [1] Carlopio et al. (1997, pp.232). . . observe that the result of being egalitarian and flexible in communication is two-way communication. [2] This concept has not been able to evolve in the firm of Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton, and Lawless Solicitors, since the WPC staff are not consulted about any issues at the firm. [3] For example, one reason that may explain errors made in written reports could be that solicitors have not taken the time to explain tasks in enough detail. [4] They assume that the staff know exactly what they are doing . . . [5] As no two-way discussion has taken place at the firm, agreement, the final attribute and by-product of discussion, cannot be reached. [6] Having said all this, it becomes obvious that communication at the firm is extremely poor. Complete the following table, trying to identify which sentence numbers belong to the four stages. Stage 1. Introduction Sentence number(s) Correct Answers Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 1 Sentence 5 Sentence 6 2. Case Evidence 3. Commentary 4. Conclusion Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 ? Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Sentence 1 Sentence 2 Sentence 3 Sentence 4 None Sentence 5 Sentence 6 Which is better - sample 1 or sample 2? Referring to theory Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. When referring to theory in the Problem Identification section, you have the choice of using: Direct quotation - the actual words of another writer contained in "quotation marks" and inserted into your own sentence. A reference (citation) + page number(s) must also be supplied. Indirect quotation - the use of another writer's ideas but using your own words (i.e. paraphrasing). A citation must be supplied, but a page number is not necessary. REMEMBER: 1. Indirect quotation is the usual way to report facts/information in academic writing. 2. Direct quotation is normally used only to emphasise: o o o o definitions viewpoints which are not your own key information (i.e. first principles or statements of a theory) information expressed in an original way Note: NEVER use a direct quotation as a substitute for your own sentence. Instead, insert the quotation (inside quotation marks) into your own sentence. An example follows: As pointed out by Bartol, Martin, Tein and Matthews (1995:471), "using directive leadership to clarify task demands that are already clear will be ineffectual; it might frustrate employees and reduce the work's intrinsic valence." Re-read the sample on Leader Mismatch below which contains four references to journal articles on organisational behaviour. Then, do the exercises that follow to check your ability to recognise the use of direct and indirect quotations, and the use of referencing. Sample 1.1 Leadership Mismatch [1] The Path-Goal Theory suggests that it is a leader's job to assist his/her followers in attaining goals as well as providing direction and support (Schermerhorn, Hunt and Osborn, 1994). [2] There are four types of leader behaviour that can be used to affect a subordinate's motivation, but leadership behaviour which is effective in one situation may not always be effective in another (Schermerhorn et al., 1994). [3] According to the case study, Mrs Blakely, the staff supervisor, checks each piece of work with the WPC staff before they do the job. [4] Since the workers are qualified for their work and well-trained, this leads to annoyance and frustration. According to Kathleen Pearce, Mrs. Blakely makes the WPC staff feel they are still in school because of her constant supervision. [6] As pointed out by Bartol, Martin, Tein and Matthews (1995:471), "using directive leadership to clarify task demands that are already clear will be ineffectual; it might frustrate employees and reduce the work's intrinsic valence." [7] Workers do not need a manager telling them how to do something they already know how to do because "redundant behaviour by the leader will not help and may even hinder performance" (Schermerhorn et al., 1994:504). [ 8] Thus a major problem in the WPC is that Mrs Blakely is too concerned with the work of her staff which results in their frustration because they are not allowed to be independent and show initiative. For each sentence (below), tick the description which best fits. Sentence 1: The Path-Goal Theory suggests that it is a leader's job to assist his/her followers in attaining goals as well as providing direction and support (Schermerhorn, Hunt and Osborn, 1994). Description Answer Feedback contains a direct quote + full reference No contains a direct quote + abbreviated reference No contains an indirect quote + full reference Yes contains an indirect quote + abbreviated reference No Sentence 2: There are four types of leader behaviour that can be used to affect a subordinate's motivation, but leadership behaviour which is effective in one situation may not always be effective in another (Schermerhorn et al., 1994). Description contains a direct quote + full reference Answer Feedback No contains a direct quote + abbreviated reference No contains an indirect quote + full reference No contains an indirect quote + abbreviated reference Yes Sentence 6: As pointed out by Bartol, Martin, Tein and Matthews (1995:471), "using directive leadership to clarify task demands that are already clear will be ineffectual; it might frustrate employees and reduce the work's intrinsic valence." Description Answer Feedback contains a direct quote + full reference Yes contains a direct quote + abbreviated reference No contains an indirect quote + full reference No contains an indirect quote + abbreviated reference No Sentence 7: Workers do not need a manager telling them how to do something they already know how to do because "redundant behaviour by the leader will not help and may even hinder performance" (Schermerhorn et al., 1994:504). Description Answer Feedback contains a direct quote + full reference No contains a direct quote + abbreviated reference Yes contains an indirect quote + full reference No contains an indirect quote + abbreviated reference No Alternative solutions When generating and evaluating alternative solutions, it is important that this information is set out as clearly and as economically as possible. This can be done through the use of: a. Brief headings which present each alternative b. Subsections based on an advantages/disadvantages structure c. Bullets (or numbers) to enumerate each advantage and disadvantage d. Concise use of language The following extract from a student assignment describes the advantages of a specific solution in the form of a paragraph. Read the extract and consider how it might be turned into a series of bullet points. Sample 1 3.1 MOTIVATING THE WPC EMPLOYEES 3.1.1 Create different levels of data clerks Creating different levels of data clerks would result in a work environment where the staff would be willing to work harder in order to receive more interesting work tasks. Consequently, it would limit undisciplined work behaviour. It would provide better efficiency and create fewer errors because in order to graduate to the next level, the employees would need to perform their tasks correctly. It would also identify where the errors are occurring. The clerks on the highest level would be capable of relieving the firm secretaries during their holidays. To turn the text into bullet points: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Remove any unnecessary words or repetition Break long statements into smaller chunks of information Ensure each statement has the same verbal form as the previous one (where possible) Group similar ideas together (clearer for the reader) Make word choice as informative and as concise as possible Sample 1 (bullet point style) Advantages: creates a challenging work environment limits undisciplined work behaviour identifies where errors are occurring stimulates staff to work harder to receive more interesting tasks stimulates staff to perform better to graduate to the next level creates staff able to relieve the (firm's) secretaries during their holidays Stating disadvantages Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Now, see if you can develop disadvantages in bullet point form from the text below: Sample 2 Nevertheless because staff are basically doing the same work everyday, work could still be considered boring and this may still result in errors occurring. Different levels of data clerks may also create a working atmosphere where animosities are present between the employees, because of the bureaucratic environment. They may not solve the problem of the staff feeling isolated. Disadvantages: [1] Check your answer [1] Task Feedback Disadvantages: staff may still basically do the same work everyday work may still be considered boring errors may still result different staff levels may create animosities between employees because of the bureaucratic environment different staff levels may not solve the problem of staff isolation. Combining advantages and disadvantages Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Develop a list of both advantages and disadvantages in bullet point form from the following text. Sample 3 3.1 MOTIVATING THE WPC EMPLOYEES 3.1.2 Appoint one WPC employee to two solicitors Each data clerk should be appointed to two solicitors where possible. This would allow the WPC employees to have increased contact with other people in the firm. Each WPC employee's work area could be near the office of their designated solicitor. All data clerks on the same floor should be located together. This would enable them to perform a greater number of activities instead of doing the same thing all day. Consequently, this would improve their work skills and allow the WPC employees to show greater initiative, establishing responsibility and loyalty. It would also provide better training for becoming a relief secretary. Also the data clerks could meet as a group every week to discuss problems and issues. However, WPC employee skills may not improve because the clerks could feel intimated by the solicitors. It may be difficult to discipline the girls and prevent them from arriving late, talking and slacking off. They may not be able to keep up with the extra workload and their skills may not improve. Advantages: Disadvantages: [1] Check your answer [1] Task 2 Feedback. 3.1 MOTIVATING THE WPC EMPLOYEES 3.1.1 Appoint one WPC employee to two solicitors Advantages: allows staff to have increased contact with other people in the firm enables them to perform a greater number of activities will improve their work skills allows employees to show greater initiative and establish responsibility and loyalty provides better training of relief secretaries Disadvantages: employee skills may not improve because staff could feel intimated by the solicitors it may be difficult to discipline staff it may be difficult to prevent old behaviours occurring (i.e. arriving late, talking, and 'slacking off') staff may not be able to keep up with the extra workload staff skills may not improve Recommendations In the Recommendations section, a manager is expecting to find a specific recommendation for each of the problems presented in the case study. He or she will therefore expect those specific solutions to be clearly stated. This is normally done in the Management case study using the following structure: an overall heading (Motivation, Communication, etc.) a subheading which summarises the recommendation in a clear, concise way a section of text which justifies the specific recommendation by referring to specific theory NB: The Recommendation text is structured in a similar way to the Problem Identification section. The following tasks are designed to help you with the task of writing concisely - that is, conveying the maximum amount of information in the minimum amount of words. Creating recommendations Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Compare the following two sets of recommendation headings. What are their possible strengths and weaknesses? Set A Set B 4.1 Motivation - Provide attainable goals, recognise the WPC clerks if they reach these goals, and reward them. 4.1 Motivation - Increase motivation amongst the WPC employees. 4.2 Communication - Organise weekly meetings as well as retrain Mrs. Blakely to ensure that the communication flow is constant. 4.2 Communication - Increase communication in the law firm. 4.3 Leadership - Retrain Mrs. Blakely. 4.3 Leadership - Create effective leadership of the WPC. [1] Feedback [1] Feedback The Set A recommendations are more informative than Set B. However, with the exception of 4.3, they are too wordy to be effective subheadings. Set B, on the other hand, is too vaguely worded to be useful to a manager looking for specific solutions. The ideal approach would be to combine the best features of both, i.e. combine information with conciseness. Creating subheadings Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Now, try to create improved subheadings for Concepts 4.1 and 4.2, Motivation and Communication. You can combine information, cut out what is unnecessary, and restructure and reword where necessary. make one key point in your subheading focus on being concise - don't waste words keep each subheading in parallel structure, i.e. make sure each one has the same grammatical form as the next. (Hint: Each bullet point in this list has the same grammatical form as the next.) 4.3 Leadership has been done for you. 4.1 Motivation 4.2 Communication 4.3 Leadership [1] Check your answer [1] Feedback 4.1 Motivation Provide attainable goals through recognition and/or rewards 4.2 Communication Maintain a constant communication flow in the WPC through weekly meetings 4.3 Leadership Create effective leadership of the WPC by retraining Mrs. Blakely Other Management resources Faculty of Business and Economics: Q Manual <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/qmanual/qmanual.pdf> Annotated assignments These are three first-year students from the Management subject Managing People and Organisations. Use the menu on the left to navigate through this tutorial, reading about their lecturer's expectations, and seeing the assignments that they wrote for class. The annotated assignments and the writing approaches described by students should not be seen as ideal models for you to copy. They are intended to be a general guide to writing in your subject and to help you to reflect on your own approach. Topic: Management Case Study assignment Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer wanted from this assignment. Amy's sample assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.2.xml> : See Amy's assignment before she received feedback on it. Amy's assignment and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.3.xml> : See the assignment along with comments explaining the lecturer's thoughts. Interview with Amy <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml> : Listen to Amy talk about the writing process. Topic: Management Case Study assignment Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer wanted from this assignment. Angus's sample assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.2.xml> : See Angus's assignment before she received feedback on it. Angus's assignment and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.3.xml> : See the assignment along with comments explaining the lecturer's thoughts. Topic: Management Case Study assignment Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer wanted from this assignment. Cindy's sample assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.2.xml> : See Cindy's assignment before he received feedback on it. Cindy's assignment and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.3.xml> : See the assignment along with comments explaining the lecturer's thoughts. Amy's assignment Amy is a first-year Management student. The main assignment in the subject is a case study on a firm of solicitors: Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment question 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Amy's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.2.xml> . o How well do you think the assignment responds to the topic? o Do you think the assignment could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.3.xml> about Amy's assignment. 4. Finally, listen to Amy <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml> talk about how she wrote her assignment and read feedback about how to overcome the difficulties she faced. [1] Assignment Questions MGM 1300 INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT Semester One, 1996 CASE STUDY Using the Case Study Method analyse the problems, generate solutions and make recommendations for the following case. DUE DATE: Tutorial, Week 11, Week Beginning May 20, 1996 Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Peter Lawless looked over his desk at Arthur Lawton and frowned. "Look, Arthur, I need a new secretary now. I thought the idea of the Word Processing Centre was, that we recruited talented people and trained them there, so they were ready and available when we need them. We spend a lot of money on the Centre and I hear on the grapevine that the work is often sub standard, and now you're telling me that there is no one there really qualified to be my new secretary. What's going wrong! I have had Kathleen Pearce temporarily for the past two weeks, but if she is the best qualified person in the Centre, then it's not doing the job. Her skills are fine, but she has no initiative and doesn't have much of a clue about what we do in this firm - and she has worked here for 18 months! She is a nice girl, but she is not up to it." Arthur Lawton sighed. "Obviously something is not working. We do recruit well trained, bright, young people and hope that one to two years in the WPC will teach them all they need to know about our firm, and I believe Kathleen Pearce is the best qualified there. I am afraid you will have to persevere with Kathleen. There's nobody else." Arthur Lawton and Peter Lawless are senior partners in the legal firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Arthur is also the Managing Partner responsible for handling the administration of the large firm which consists of 25 partners and 48 employed solicitors, plus approximately 80 support staff working in the Sydney office. Twenty two of the support staff are data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre. Their job is to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports, etc. Only well qualified people are employed, usually with a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in the specialised legal documents and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure up to date knowledge of legal documents. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The Word Processing Centre is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The office is very well equipped with modern, ergonomic furniture and equipment, excellent furnishings, and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many benefits such as a superannuation scheme, health scheme, social club and other non salary benefits. After his discussion with Peter Lawless, the Managing Partner, Mr Lawton, feels it is time to find out why the centre is having problems, so he asks around the firm, having talks with other partners and solicitors. He discovers that, although the centre is very productive, there are several concerns. Most solicitors feel they must check each piece of work carefully because there are often errors made. Not necessarily typing errors, but careless errors such as the wrong names or facts keyed into documents. As the clerks are well qualified and trained by the firm, there is a belief that the error rate is unacceptable. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the supervisor, and suggest that there is something wrong "with young people today". Mr Lawton's personnel records also suggest that the turnover rate in the centre is also unacceptable. Only three clerks in the Centre have worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only 12 months or so, despite careful selection of excellent staff. The partners of the firm each have their own secretary, and it is the firm's policy that these secretaries be recruited from the Word Processing Centre workers. Three to five of these vacancies arise each year, with workers from the Centre also relieving when the secretaries are on holidays. Although this opportunity for promotion attracts new workers to the firm, it does not seem to keep many of them long enough to take up the chance. There have also been complaints that, when a clerk has been used as a relief for a secretary, they have proved unreliable if left to their own devices and they lacked initiative. Mr Lawton then talks with Mrs Lorraine Blakely, the supervisor, about the Centre. She has worked with the firm in various administrative capacities for over 20 years and is greatly liked and admired by all the partners and lawyers in the firm. They found her very pleasant and helpful to deal with and always efficient in getting their work through the centre in a short time. She enjoys her job, particularly dealing with the solicitors in the firm, most of whom have worked with her for years. They believe that she is very efficient and they all like to deal with her on a regular basis. Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily when Mr Lawton brings up the matter of the WPC's problems. She springs to the defence of her "girls", saying that although there are errors made, they do get through a lot of work. She does admit that, she believes not many of the clerks like their job very much as they find it boring, as most of the work is simply keying in information into the forms provided on the firm's computer network. She finds that they will come late to work, chat with each other at every opportunity, take long breaks and generally "slack off". To stop this she keeps a firm eye on them, but on the other hand, she tells him, you can't be too hard on them or they will leave quickly, and it is very hard to get good people to stay long. She insists that she must keep her "girls" happy if they are to be productive and stay with the firm, and she doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer or help them to be better secretaries. She states that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun and there is nothing that she can do about that. Mrs Blakely explains the WPC's system to him. The work to be done in the Centre arrives from each solicitor with a request sheet with details of what is required. Mrs Blakely then allocates work to the clerks each day. To ensure they know what to do she is in the habit of going over each piece of work with them before they do the job. There is often a need to clarify some issue with the solicitor. When this is the case, Mrs Blakely goes to the solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the clerks have finished and returns it to the solicitors. She emphasises again to Mr Lawton that she does keep a stern eye on the workers to ensure that they are not wasting time. She insists that tea and lunch break times are strictly adhered to, and discourages chatting during working hours, although as her job means she must be liaising with solicitors on other floors, she is not in the Centre quite a lot. She agrees that the workers do not do very well when they relieve a secretary, but feels it is all so strange to them, much more complex work than they have been used to, but her staff are the best available, and the solicitors just need to put a bit of effort into helping them to learn the job. She says the solicitors do not help their new secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. She suggests to Mr Lawton that she could check every piece of work before it leaves the centre, though this would slow the turnaround time considerably. When questioned about their job the clerks say they like working for the firm, would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces every day as they are isolated in the WPC on the 35th Floor and have no contact with anyone apart from each other and Mrs Blakely. Peter Lawless's temporary secretary, Kathleen Pearce, who is the longest serving clerk, tells Mr Lawton that, although she loves working with so many people her own age, and Mrs Blakely is a lovely boss, always friendly and helpful, she feels like she is still in school, with someone always watching what you are doing and telling her what to do. She has stayed with the firm because the conditions are good and she hopes to achieve promotion. She does, however, express doubts about her ability as "eighteen months of straight keying have made me forget most of what I learned in TAFE and I don't seem to have learnt much about what the solicitors do working in the WPC". Mr Lawton decides to install a piped music system, believing this will add interest to their day's work and aid concentration. The workers are very pleased with this and even say that it speeds up their work. Unfortunately six months later the error rate has even increased, the turnover is still high, and Kathleen Pearce, after six months as secretary to Peter Lawless is just beginning to show more confidence and initiative in her job. Although Peter is happy with her now, he feels he has wasted a lot of time and energy in helping her settle into the job and he tells Arthur Lawton that he believes the problems with the WPC would not be solved by the piped music. Mr Lawton has approached you, an external management consulting firm, to help them identify the real problems, to suggest some possible solutions and make recommendations. Your brief is to examine and analyse the case material and to produce a report, based on the problem solving case method, for Mr Lawton. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Loretta Inglis - sets out what she expects from student assignments on this topic. I expect that you will read all the information that has been given in the subject outline to help you to write the case study. There is a wealth of information there. Ideally, I expect consistent quality throughout all the sections of the report. You need to leave enough time to plan and write each section carefully. I expect that your Problem Identification section will succinctly identify problems (not just repeat case information), explain the problems using case evidence, and show how the theory relates to the problem. Possible Solutions should have clear, concise headings and include advantages and disadvantages in bullet point form. The Recommendations should be very specific - showing who has which responsibility - and should be justified using the theory. The Implementation section should summarise the changes which need to be made as specifically as possible, with someone responsible for seeing that they happen. To do your best, I also expect that you attend tutorials over the weeks before the assignment is due. There your tutor will work with you on practice case studies. Finally, a look at the information on this site will help you to understand how you might tackle the demanding task of integrating problem identification with case evidence and theoretical discussion - as well as the other challenging areas in the case study. Notes on the case study method The use of case studies is a widely accepted means of bringing theoretical concepts and practical situations together. It is not possible to take a class into an organisation and observe the subject matter of management or organisational behaviour in real life - hence a written case study outlining a real, or realistic, situation is the best available alternative. When reading and studying a case study it is possible to take two different approaches. The first of these is the 'analytical' approach where a case structure is examined to try to understand what has happened and why. In this approach you do not identify problems or attempt to develop solutions. The second approach is the problem-oriented method. In this approach a case is analysed to identify the major problems that exist, the causes of and possible solutions to the problems, and finally a recommendation as to the best solution to implement. In this course we mainly utilise a 'problem solving' case study method. As with most things in the management area there is not 'one best way' to analyse or write up a case report. Everyone develops their own methods of sorting and sifting through the information and presenting their findings. However, in this subject we have a set format which we would like you to utilise when presenting your case reports. This format is outlined briefly below. Presentation of written material The following notes are to be used as a guide to students preparing the case studies for assessment in firstyear Management. Guidelines A high standard of presentation is required. Typing, or word processing, of all is expected. Work that is submitted in an illegible or untidy fashion may, at your tutor's discretion, be returned unmarked or with marks deducted for poor presentation. In no circumstances should an assignment be written/typed on both sides of the paper. Work should be double or 1-1/2 spaced. A margin of 30mm should be left on both sides of the page. This provides adequate room for examiner's comments as well as creating an uncluttered presentation. All quotations should be enclosed within inverted commas. The exception is quotations of two or more sentences which run to four or more lines. These should be single-spaced and indented from the main body of the text. In these cases inverted commas are unnecessary (see Q Manual). Assignments should be bound firmly into a cover, such as a manilla folder, plastic folder, ring binder, etc. Please do not use envelope folders or submit loose sheets. It should be possible to read every page without undoing any fastenings. Every assignment must be clearly identified. The following details must be on the front of all assignments: Name: Student Number: Assignment Name: Subject Code/Name: Lecturer/Tutor: Due Date: Date Submitted: It is recommended that students KEEP A COPY OF ALL WORK SUBMITTED. While it is extremely rare for student work to be misplaced, it does sometimes occur. The onus is on you to prove that a piece of work was submitted. Grammar, spelling and punctuation are matters which should not be neglected. Failure to take care of these matters causes confusion and ambiguity. Ask someone to read and comment critically on your work prior to submitting it; can they understand what you are trying to say? If not, rewrite it! Problem solving case format for presentation 1. Title Page 2. Table of Contents 3. Executive Summary This section should comprise a brief overview of the case, giving a brief background and noting any important assumptions made. (You will not have all the information you would like - so you may need to make some assumptions). As well as this, you should give a synopsis of your case report, noting very briefly the major problems identified and the recommended solutions. One page is enough. 4. Problem Identification and Analysis In this section you should identify all the major problems in the case in behavioural terms, i.e. in Management/OB related terms (it is not a marketing or an accounting case). Try to get to underlying causes of problems, not just symptoms. Seek advice from your tutor on the layout of this information. You should link each problem identified to relevant theory and also to actual evidence from the case. Remember you MUST integrate theory and reference all non-original work. 5. Statement of Major Problems In most case studies you will identify a number of problems - too many to actually 'solve' in the number of words allowed. Hence it is crucial to make it very clear which are the major two or three problems or key issues, that must be solved first. Therefore this section is just a short concise statement of what problems you are going to solve in the remainder of the case. Half a page is adequate. Having once identified the key problems, you can continually check back to ensure that you are actually attempting to solve them and not some other minor problems you identified. This section is crucial to a good case report. 6. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions While most problems will have a very large number of possible solutions, it is your task to identify and evaluate a number of the more appropriate (at least 2-3 for each major problem identified). Each alternative solution should be briefly outlined and then evaluated in terms of its advantages and disadvantages (strong and weak points). Note: You must evaluate alternatives. It is not necessary to make a statement in this section as to which alternative is considered best - this is the next section. Do not integrate theory in this section and do not recommend theory. Practical solutions to the problems are required. 7. Recommendations This section should state which of the alternative solutions (either singly or in combination) identified in section six is recommended for implementation. You should briefly justify your choice, explaining how it will solve the major problems identified in Section 6. Integration of relevant theory is appropriate here. 8. Implementation In this section you should specifically explain how you will implement the recommended solutions. Theory cannot be implemented; you must translate it into actions. What should be done, by whom, when, in what sequence, what will it cost (rough estimates only) and other such issues. Remember if a recommended solution cannot be realistically implemented then it is no solution at all. 9. Appendices (if any) 10. Bibliography/References This will contain an alphabetical list of all the references you have cited in the body of the report. Do not include details of any sources you have not cited. Ensure the style used is correct and consistent. Some general issues: In a case study it is crucial that you integrate relevant theory from the course and evidence from the case. Failure to attempt to integrate theory will lead to severe mark reduction or failure. Referencing of all non-original material is essential. You will lose marks for poor referencing. The Faculty of Business and Economics Q Manual should be used as a guide. This is available in the library, for sale in the bookshop, and on the web. The Q Manual should also be used as a guide for correct presentation of written material. Check your completed work for internal consistency. For example make sure that you attempt to solve the key issues you have identified. Don't say X is the major problem and then recommend a solution to Y. Try not to be overly descriptive. Remember you are trying to identify, analyse, and solve the problems of the case using the relevant theories from the course - not just repeating what the text book, or case information, has said. Amy's sample assignment Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic Assignment topic question 1 Internal Organisational Problems of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Prepared for Arthur Lawton Managing Partner By Effective Management Consultants Table of contents Executive Summary 1 Problem Identification and Analysis 1.1 The lack of motivation amongst the WPC employees 1.2 Mrs Blakely's leadership style 1.3 Insufficient communication at the firm 1.4 No teamwork exists in the WPC unit 2 Statement of Key Problems 3 Generation and Evaluation of a Range of Alternative Solutions 3.1 Solutions for motivating the WPC employees 3.1.1 Appoint a WPC employee to two solicitors 3.1.2 Have different levels of data clerks 3.1.3 Create goals for the WPC employee 3.2 Solutions for effective communication 3.2.1 Have regular meetings in each department and also between the different divisions 3.2.2 Have regular informal events for all employees 3.2.3 Develop non-identification questionnaires and discuss the findings 3.3 Solutions for providing effective leadership of the WPC employees 3.3.1 Fire Mrs Blakely 3.3.2 Have Mrs Blakely take a personal evaluation 3.3.3 Create a manager of the WPC 4 Recommendations 4.1 Increase Motivation amongst the WPC employees 4.2 Increase communication in the firm 4.3 Create effective leadership for the WPC employees 5 Implementation 5.1 Implementing motivation of the WPC employees 5.2 Implement effective communication in the firm 5.3 Implementing effective leadership of the WPC employees References Executive summary The purpose of this report is to investigate the major problems that are prevalent at Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors. One of the major problems that the firm is experiencing, is that the data clerks possess a lack of motivation. This is because they are isolated on the 35th floor and their work is monotonous. Also they are not given any responsibility which then results in a lack of initiative. Furthermore they do not possess any goals. Another major problem is that Mrs Blakely, the WPC unit supervisor, does not possess adequate leadership skills. She does not encourage or inspire the girls, delegate simple tasks, or teach them. She also does not try to solve the problem of data error. Lack of effective communication is also another problem that the firm suffers from. Ineffective communication is present in the WPC unit and between the different divisions of the law firm. This was illustrated when Mr Lawton held a meeting with the WPC employees. The girls told him that they found the work boring and that they felt isolated. His solution was to install a sound system. He did not ask them what was the best solution, hence no active listening was present, nor did he ask whether installing a sound system was the best answer to their problem, hence not allowing feedback to occur. It is recommended that if the law firm resolved the symptoms of ineffective communication, the lack of motivation amongst the data clerks and Mrs Blakely's poor leadership style, then the two other problems, the weak organisational culture and the lack of teamwork would also be eradicated. Therefore the solution to the lack of motivation of the data clerks is to assign a WPC employee to a maximum of two solicitors, on the same floor as the solicitors. This would then allow them to improve communication with the other employees of the firm. Another solution is for goals to be set by individual employees and departments. This would create a more motivated employee base that would possess clear objectives. Therefore solutions to the lack of communication is to implement informal social events as well as regular meetings for each department, and meetings for all the department heads. This would allow all the employees to communicate with one another. In regards to establishing better leadership skills in the WPC unit, it is recommended that Mrs Blakely should undertake a work appraisal, which would identify to her and the organisation that she is not managing the WPC unit very well. A manager should then be appointed to the WPC. Mrs Blakely could still remain as a supervisor of the WPC unit and meet weekly with the new manager. In regards to the lack of motivation in the WPC, it is suggested that as individuals and as groups they create goals. WPC employees working on the same level could have their own work area. Consequently, this would increase their skills, sense of responsibility and motivation. 1. Problem identification and analysis 1.1 The lack of motivation amongst the Word Processing Centre (WPC) employees The WPC employees greatly suffer from a lack of motivation. Motivation is the willingness to exert high levels of effort to reach organisational goals, conditioned by the efforts to satisfy some individual need (Robbins, Bergman, Stagg and Coulter, 2000, p.549). Maslow's Hierarchy of Needs Theory identifies those symptoms, which contribute to the WPC clerks' lack of motivation. The clerks state that they feel isolated on the 35th floor and have contact only with one another and Mrs Blakely. Also there is a high turnover rate, with only three clerks in the WPC having worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only about 12 months. As a result they do not possess the initiative for growth and achievement of their potential. The clerks' esteem needs are also undermined because they perform the same monotonous activities. They possess no autonomy as Mrs Blakely assigns the tasks. Moreover, they would like to earn a promotion but find it hard to stay interested. Herzberg's Motivation-Hygiene Theory is also relevant. It identifies the intrinsic factors, the motivators, that are related to job satisfaction and motivation, whereas extrinsic factors, the hygiene factors, are associated with job dissatisfaction (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). As previously identified above, the ones that are relevant are supervision, relationship with the supervisor, working conditions and relationship with peers (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). 1.2 Mrs Blakely's Leadership style Mrs. Blakely's leadership style is what the University of Iowa Studies has determined as autocratic: she is a leader who tends to centralise authority, dictate work methods, make unilateral decisions and limit subordinate participation (Robbins et al., 2000, p.596). She achieves this by allocating what is to be done by the clerks each day instead of letting them decide. Also she limits their interaction with people from the other levels by not allowing the clerks to clarify issues with the solicitors. Kathleen Pearce stated that she felt like she was "in school, with someone watching what you are doing and telling you what to do" (Managing People and Organisations Case Study, Semester 2, 2000, p.4.). The Ohio State studies (Robbins et al., 2000, p.596) suggest that a successful style of leadership will provide initiating structure, the extent to which a leader is likely to define and structure her role and those of subordinates, in search for goal attainment. Mrs Blakely is aware that the clerks think their jobs are boring, but she has not established any goals. She lacks interpersonal skills and she does not spend a great deal of time on the WPC level. She does not teach the clerks how to do their job correctly because if she did, there would not be any errors. No feedback is provided because she does not have enough time to check their work. Her statement to Mr Lawton "...that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work..." illustrates that she does not believe in her work unit. She also does not possess discipline skills as she allows the clerks to arrive late and take long breaks. 1.3 Insufficient communication at the law firm There is a lack of communication between the other levels of the law firm and the WPC unit. As mentioned previously, the WPC clerks generally do not associate with the employees. Furthermore Mr Lawton did not listen effectively to the clerks' grievances. If he had, he would have realised that installing a new music system in the WPC, would not make the clerks work more productively. After speaking to Kathleen Pearce, he should have realised that the girls' secretarial skills were deteriorating, and that Mrs Blakely does not give them adequate training, preparing them for work as a solicitor's secretary. The solicitors do not know the clerks very well but only know Mrs Blakely, as is suggested by Peter Lawless's remark, "and I hear on the grapevine that a lot of work is sub-standard... ." 1.4 No teamwork exists in the WPC unit There are nine characteristics that reflect whether a team is effective. Unfortunately, in regard to the WPC unit, the group of data clerks and Mrs Blakley do not possess these. The data clerks have no clear goals. By their arriving late and taking long work breaks illustrates they are uncommitted to their jobs. This then hinders the opportunity to establish unified commitment amongst the WPC employees. They also do not possess the relevant skills for being data clerks because they continually make mistakes. Because the organisation has a weak culture they cannot develop any mutual trust. As previously mentioned, the organisation lacks good communication, which then affects the WPC unit. The clerks also appear to lack negotiating skills because if they had these, the WPC problems would probably have been fixed. Mr Lawton in his meeting with the data clerks shows he lacks these skills too. As previously mentioned, Mrs Blakely does not possess the appropriate leadership skill, to properly establish an effective team environment. She is not present a lot of the time and she does not encourage group behaviour. In terms of the internal environment of the firm, the isolation of the WPC employees also affects the development of team spirit. 2. Statement of key problems and issues Although it is evident that Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors suffers from a number of dilemmas, the major problems are the lack of communication and motivation amongst the WPC staff, and Mrs Blakely's inappropriate leadership style. If the firm can eradicate these three problems, the other minor ones will be fixed. If the WPC staff can gain a high degree of motivation, the different units of the firm communicate effectively, and Mrs Blakely changes her leadership style, then a strong organisational culture will be created and a positive teamwork environment. 3. Generation and evaluation of a range of alternative solutions 3.1 Solutions for Motivating the WPC Employees 3.1.1 Appoint a WPC employee to two solicitors Each data clerk should be appointed to two solicitors where possible. This would allow the WPC employees to have increased contact with other people in the firm. Each WPC employee's work area could be near the office of their designated solicitor. All data clerks on the same floor should be located together. This would enable them to perform a greater number of activities instead of doing the same thing all day. Consequently, this would improve their work skills and allow the WPC employees to show greater initiative, establishing responsibility and loyalty. It would also provide better training for becoming a relief secretary. Also the data clerks could meet as a group every week to discuss problems and issues. However, WPC employee skills may not improve because the clerks could feel intimated by the solicitors. It may be difficult to discipline the girls and prevent them from arriving late, talking and slacking off. They may not be able to keep up with the extra workload and their skills may not improve. 3.1.2 Have different levels of data clerks This would create a work environment where the girls would be willing to work harder in order to receive more interesting work tasks. Consequently, it would limit undisciplined work behaviour. It would provide better efficiency and create fewer errors because in order to graduate to the next level, the employees would need to perform their tasks correctly. It would also identify where the errors are occurring. The clerks on the highest level would be the most capable of relieving the secretaries during their holidays. Nevertheless because the girls are basically doing the same work everyday it could still be considered boring and still may result in errors occurring. It may create a working atmosphere where animosities are present between the employees, because of the bureaucratic environment. It does not solve the problem of the girls feeling isolated. [Please note: for reasons of length, sections have been removed below.] 3.1.3 Create goals for the WPC unit ... 3.2 Solutions for Establishing Effective Communication 3.2.1 Have regular meetings in each department, and also between the different divisions. ... 3.2.2 Have regular informal events for all firm employees ... 3.2.3 Develop non-identification questionnaires and discuss the findings ... 3.3 Solutions for Providing Effective Leadership in the WPC 3.3.1 Fire Mrs Blakely Firing Mrs. Blakely could increase the clerks' initiative because they could gain more responsibility. At present, she does not give them enough responsibility nor does she respect them, although she genuinely seems to care for them. She has not tried to motivate the girls even though she is aware that they find their jobs boring. Further, she cannot discipline them. However Mrs Blakely is widely respected by the solicitors, and she is efficient. Because she has worked for the firm for over twenty years it would be difficult to find a replacement with the same amount of knowledge. 3.3.2 Have Mrs. Blakely undergo a work appraisal It is evident that Mrs. Blakely has become complacent in carrying out the role of supervisor. By undertaking a work appraisal evaluation she would be able to redefine her role in the firm. She could review and change her ineffective leadership skills. It would also identify to the firm that Mrs. Blakely needs to improve her leadership skills, as Mr Lawton would undertake the evaluation. However, the review may not be productive because the firm already thinks very highly of her. It is evident that Mrs Blakely does not believe her leadership skills are inadequate, so she may not benefit from the evaluation. The evaluation may not contain the correct questions which identify that Mrs Blakley is largely an incompetent leader. 3.3.3 Create a manager of the WPC unit. ... 4. Recommendations 4.1 Increase motivation amongst the WPC employees In order to reduce the lack of motivation amongst the WPC employees a combination of allocating them to solicitors and setting individual goals should be implemented. Goal setting is very important as it will motivate each individual to assess her role in the firm. Goals can be established for each WPC employee, the WPC employees as a group, and also for the WPC senior staff and solicitors. By appointing a WPC employee to a solicitor, each clerk can learn to recognise their needs, especially their esteem, social and self-actualisation needs in the firm. Motivators such as achievement, recognition, responsibility, advancement and growth can also be achieved (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). 4.2 Increase communication in the firm. There should be a combination of all three suggestions, the regular meetings in each division and with the department heads, the informal events between the different departments, and the questionnaires. The questionnaires could be administered every six months and the findings could be discussed at the meetings. These channels are effective and would allow the firm to communicate more effectively because they permit different methods of communication to be used including oral, non-verbal and written communication. The meetings would encourage active listening and provide an opportunity for feedback. 4.3 Create effective leadership of the WPC employees A combination of Mrs Blakely undergoing a work appraisal and appointing a manager to the WPC unit would combat inadequate leadership skills there. Mrs Blakely should still remain as supervisor of the WPC unit; however, there should be a manager present at all times with the WPC staff, who is able to discipline and motivate them. With the presence of a manager, there is a high possibility that a more democratic style of leadership would be adopted and an initiating structure created. This manager could then contact Mrs Blakely if any problem occurs, given her knowledge. Mrs Blakely should take a personal evaluation because it would identify both to her and the firm that she is unable to effectively lead the WPC unit. 5. Implementation [Please note that the assignment table cannot be displayed on this screen because it is too complex.] 6. Referencing Robbins, S., Bergman, R., Stagg, I. And Coulter, M., (2000), Management, Prentice Hall, (2nd edn), Sydney. [1] Assignment Topic Case study summary Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless is a large Sydney legal firm. Among its staff are 22 data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre (WPC). Their job is to process the large volume of legal documents produced by the firm's solicitors. WPC clerks are carefully selected and must have a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in specialised legal documents, and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure they keep their knowledge up-to-date. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The WPC is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The centre is very well equipped with excellent furnishings and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many other benefits. However, all is not well. Senior staff and solicitors have complained to Arthur Lawton, the Managing Partner, that they need to check the work of WPC clerks who work as relief secretaries, because of the frequent errors made. They also believe that these workers are unreliable and lack initiative. Personnel records show that WPC staff do not stay with the firm for very long, despite the opportunities for promotion. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the WPC supervisor, who has worked with the firm for over 20 years. Indeed, they tend to see the problem as the result of something wrong "with young people today." When Mr Lawton raises the matter of the WPC's problems, Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily. She defends her clerks, saying that despite the errors, they do complete a lot of work. She admits that many of them find the job boring, as it mostly involves keying in information. The clerks also, often come to work late, chat at every opportunity, and generally don't work too hard. To stop this, she keeps a firm eye on them but she believes she can't be too hard or they will leave the firm. Mrs Blakely then explains the WPC system. The work to be done arrives from each solicitor and is allocated to the clerks on a daily basis. To ensure they know what to do, she goes over each piece of work with them before they do the job. When information needs to be clarified, Mrs Blakely goes to the relevant solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the job is finished and returns it to the solicitors. Her job however, also means she liaises with solicitors on other floors, so she is often away from the Centre. Mrs Blakely agrees that the workers do not perform very well as relief secretaries, but thinks this is because the work is more complex than they are trained to do. She says the solicitors do not help the relief secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. When questioned, the WPC clerks say they like working for the firm and would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces everyday as they are isolated on the 35th floor and have no contact with other staff, except with each other and Mrs Blakely. After trying to improve efficiency through the use of piped music - an experiment which fails - Mr Lawton turns to you, as an external management consultant, for advice. Amy's assignment and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Assignment topic question 1 Internal Organisational Problems of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Prepared for Arthur Lawton Managing Partner By Effective Management Consultants Table of contents Executive Summary 1 Problem Identification and Analysis 1.1 The lack of motivation amongst the WPC employees 1.2 Mrs Blakely's leadership style 1.3 Insufficient communication at the firm 1.4 No teamwork exists in the WPC unit 2 Statement of Key Problems 3 Generation and Evaluation of a Range of Alternative Solutions 3.1 Solutions for motivating the WPC employees 3.1.1 Appoint a WPC employee to two solicitors 3.1.2 Have different levels of data clerks 3.1.3 Create goals for the WPC employee 3.2 Solutions for effective communication 3.2.1 Have regular meetings in each department and also between the different divisions 3.2.2 Have regular informal events for all employees 3.2.3 Develop non-identification questionnaires and discuss the findings 3.3 Solutions for providing effective leadership of the WPC employees 3.3.1 Fire Mrs Blakely 3.3.2 Have Mrs Blakely take a personal evaluation 3.3.3 Create a manager of the WPC 4 Recommendations 4.1 Increase Motivation amongst the WPC employees 4.2 Increase communication in the firm 4.3 Create effective leadership for the WPC employees 5 Implementation 5.1 Implementing motivation of the WPC employees 5.2 Implement effective communication in the firm 5.3 Implementing effective leadership of the WPC employees References [IMG-1] [1]Executive summary The purpose of this report is to investigate the major problems that are prevalent at Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors. One of the major problems that the firm is experiencing, is that the data clerks possess a lack of motivation. This is because they are isolated on the 35th floor and their work is monotonous. Also they are not given any responsibility which then results in a lack of initiative. Furthermore they do not possess any goals. Another major problem is that Mrs Blakely, the WPC unit supervisor, does not possess adequate leadership skills. She does not encourage or inspire the girls, delegate simple tasks, or teach them. She also does not try to solve the problem of data error. Lack of effective communication is also another problem that the firm suffers from. Ineffective communication is present in the WPC unit and between the different divisions of the law firm. This was illustrated when Mr Lawton held a meeting with the WPC employees. The girls told him that they found the work boring and that they felt isolated. His solution was to install a sound system. He did not ask them what was the best solution, hence no active listening was present, nor did he ask whether installing a sound system was the best answer to their problem, hence not allowing feedback to occur. It is recommended that if the law firm resolved the symptoms of ineffective communication, the lack of motivation amongst the data clerks and Mrs Blakely's poor leadership style, then the two other problems, the weak organisational culture and the lack of teamwork would also be eradicated. Therefore the solution to the lack of motivation of the data clerks is to assign a WPC employee to a maximum of two solicitors, on the same floor as the solicitors. This would then allow them to improve communication with the other employees of the firm. Another solution is for goals to be set by individual employees and departments. This would create a more motivated employee base that would possess clear objectives. Therefore solutions to the lack of communication is to implement informal social events as well as regular meetings for each department, and meetings for all the department heads. This would allow all the employees to communicate with one another. In regards to establishing better leadership skills in the WPC unit, it is recommended that Mrs Blakely should undertake a work appraisal, which would identify to her and the organisation that she is not managing the WPC unit very well. A manager should then be appointed to the WPC. Mrs Blakely could still remain as a supervisor of the WPC unit and meet weekly with the new manager. In regards to the lack of motivation in the WPC, it is suggested that as individuals and as groups they create goals. WPC employees working on the same level could have their own work area. Consequently, this would increase their skills, sense of responsibility and motivation. 1. Problem identification and analysis 1.1 The lack of motivation amongst the Word Processing Centre (WPC) employees The WPC employees greatly suffer from a lack of motivation. Motivation is the willingness to exert high levels of effort to reach organisational goals, conditioned by the efforts to satisfy some individual need (Robbins, Bergman, Stagg and Coulter, 2000, p.549). [IMG-2] [2]Maslow's Hierarchy of Needs Theory identifies those symptoms, which contribute to the WPC clerks' lack of motivation. The clerks state that they feel isolated on the 35th floor and have contact only with one another and Mrs Blakely. Also there is a high turnover rate, with only three clerks in the WPC having worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only about 12 months. As a result they do not possess the initiative for growth and achievement of their potential. The clerks' esteem needs are also undermined because they perform the same monotonous activities. They possess no autonomy as Mrs Blakely assigns the tasks. Moreover, they would like to earn a promotion but find it hard to stay interested. Herzberg's Motivation-Hygiene Theory is also relevant. It identifies the intrinsic factors, the motivators, that are related to job satisfaction and motivation, whereas extrinsic factors, the hygiene factors, are associated with job dissatisfaction (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). As previously identified above, the ones that are relevant are supervision, relationship with the supervisor, working conditions and relationship with peers (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). 1.2 Mrs Blakely's Leadership style Mrs. Blakely's leadership style is what the University of Iowa Studies has determined as autocratic: she is a leader who tends to centralise authority, dictate work methods, make unilateral decisions and limit subordinate participation (Robbins et al., 2000, p.596). She achieves this by allocating what is to be done by the clerks each day instead of letting them decide. Also she limits their interaction with people from the other levels by not allowing the clerks to clarify issues with the solicitors. Kathleen Pearce stated that she felt like she was "in school, with someone watching what you are doing and telling you what to do" (Managing People and Organisations Case Study, Semester 2, 2000, p.4.). [IMG-3] [3]The Ohio State studies (Robbins et al., 2000, p.596) suggest that a successful style of leadership will provide initiating structure, the extent to which a leader is likely to define and structure her role and those of subordinates, in search for goal attainment. Mrs Blakely is aware that the clerks think their jobs are boring, but she has not established any goals. She lacks interpersonal skills and she does not spend a great deal of time on the WPC level. She does not teach the clerks how to do their job correctly because if she did, there would not be any errors. No feedback is provided because she does not have enough time to check their work. Her statement to Mr Lawton "...that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work..." illustrates that she does not believe in her work unit. She also does not possess discipline skills as she allows the clerks to arrive late and take long breaks. 1.3 Insufficient communication at the law firm There is a lack of communication between the other levels of the law firm and the WPC unit. As mentioned previously, the WPC clerks generally do not associate with the employees. [IMG-4] [4]Furthermore Mr Lawton did not listen effectively to the clerks' grievances. If he had, he would have realised that installing a new music system in the WPC, would not make the clerks work more productively. After speaking to Kathleen Pearce, he should have realised that the girls' secretarial skills were deteriorating, and that Mrs Blakely does not give them adequate training, preparing them for work as a solicitor's secretary. The solicitors do not know the clerks very well but only know Mrs Blakely, as is suggested by Peter Lawless's remark, "and I hear on the grapevine that a lot of work is sub-standard... ." 1.4 No teamwork exists in the WPC unit There are nine characteristics that reflect whether a team is effective. Unfortunately, in regard to the WPC unit, the group of data clerks and Mrs Blakley do not possess these. The data clerks have no clear goals. By their arriving late and taking long work breaks illustrates they are uncommitted to their jobs. This then hinders the opportunity to establish unified commitment amongst the WPC employees. They also do not possess the relevant skills for being data clerks because they continually make mistakes. Because the organisation has a weak culture they cannot develop any mutual trust. As previously mentioned, the organisation lacks good communication, which then affects the WPC unit. The clerks also appear to lack negotiating skills because if they had these, the WPC problems would probably have been fixed. Mr Lawton in his meeting with the data clerks shows he lacks these skills too. As previously mentioned, Mrs Blakely does not possess the appropriate leadership skill, to properly establish an effective team environment. She is not present a lot of the time and she does not encourage group behaviour. In terms of the internal environment of the firm, the isolation of the WPC employees also affects the development of team spirit. [IMG-5] [5]2. Statement of key problems and issues Although it is evident that Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors suffers from a number of dilemmas, the major problems are the lack of communication and motivation amongst the WPC staff, and Mrs Blakely's inappropriate leadership style. If the firm can eradicate these three problems, the other minor ones will be fixed. If the WPC staff can gain a high degree of motivation, the different units of the firm communicate effectively, and Mrs Blakely changes her leadership style, then a strong organisational culture will be created and a positive teamwork environment. 3. Generation and evaluation of a range of alternative solutions 3.1 Solutions for Motivating the WPC Employees [IMG-6] [6] 3.1.1 Appoint a WPC employee to two solicitors Each data clerk should be appointed to two solicitors where possible. This would allow the WPC employees to have increased contact with other people in the firm. Each WPC employee's work area could be near the office of their designated solicitor. All data clerks on the same floor should be located together. This would enable them to perform a greater number of activities instead of doing the same thing all day. Consequently, this would improve their work skills and allow the WPC employees to show greater initiative, establishing responsibility and loyalty. It would also provide better training for becoming a relief secretary. Also the data clerks could meet as a group every week to discuss problems and issues. However, WPC employee skills may not improve because the clerks could feel intimated by the solicitors. It may be difficult to discipline the girls and prevent them from arriving late, talking and slacking off. They may not be able to keep up with the extra workload and their skills may not improve. 3.1.2 Have different levels of data clerks This would create a work environment where the girls would be willing to work harder in order to receive more interesting work tasks. Consequently, it would limit undisciplined work behaviour. It would provide better efficiency and create fewer errors because in order to graduate to the next level, the employees would need to perform their tasks correctly. It would also identify where the errors are occurring. The clerks on the highest level would be the most capable of relieving the secretaries during their holidays. Nevertheless because the girls are basically doing the same work everyday it could still be considered boring and still may result in errors occurring. It may create a working atmosphere where animosities are present between the employees, because of the bureaucratic environment. It does not solve the problem of the girls feeling isolated. [Please note: for reasons of length, sections have been removed below.] 3.1.3 Create goals for the WPC unit ... 3.2 Solutions for Establishing Effective Communication 3.2.1 Have regular meetings in each department, and also between the different divisions ... 3.2.2 Have regular informal events for all firm employees ... 3.2.3 Develop non-identification questionnaires and discuss the findings ... 3.3 Solutions for Providing Effective Leadership in the WPC 3.3.1 Fire Mrs Blakely Firing Mrs. Blakely could increase the clerks' initiative because they could gain more responsibility. At present, she does not give them enough responsibility nor does she respect them, although she genuinely seems to care for them. She has not tried to motivate the girls even though she is aware that they find their jobs boring. Further, she cannot discipline them. However Mrs Blakely is widely respected by the solicitors, and she is efficient. Because she has worked for the firm for over twenty years it would be difficult to find a replacement with the same amount of knowledge. 3.3.2 Have Mrs. Blakely undergo a work appraisal It is evident that Mrs. Blakely has become complacent in carrying out the role of supervisor. By undertaking a work appraisal evaluation she would be able to redefine her role in the firm. She could review and change her ineffective leadership skills. It would also identify to the firm that Mrs. Blakely needs to improve her leadership skills, as Mr Lawton would undertake the evaluation. However, the review may not be productive because the firm already thinks very highly of her. It is evident that Mrs Blakely does not believe her leadership skills are inadequate, so she may not benefit from the evaluation. The evaluation may not contain the correct questions which identify that Mrs Blakley is largely an incompetent leader. 3.3.3 Create a manager of the WPC unit ... 4. Recommendations [IMG-7] [7] 4.1 Increase motivation amongst the WPC employees In order to reduce the lack of motivation amongst the WPC employees a combination of allocating them to solicitors and setting individual goals should be implemented. [IMG-8] [8]Goal setting is very important as it will motivate each individual to assess her role in the firm. Goals can be established for each WPC employee, the WPC employees as a group, and also for the WPC senior staff and solicitors. By appointing a WPC employee to a solicitor, each clerk can learn to recognise their needs, especially their esteem, social and self-actualisation needs in the firm. Motivators such as achievement, recognition, responsibility, advancement and growth can also be achieved (Robbins et al., 2000, p.553). [IMG-9] [9] 4.2 Increase communication in the firm. There should be a combination of all three suggestions, the regular meetings in each division and with the department heads, the informal events between the different departments, and the questionnaires. The questionnaires could be administered every six months and the findings could be discussed at the meetings. These channels are effective and would allow the firm to communicate more effectively because they permit different methods of communication to be used including oral, non-verbal and written communication. The meetings would encourage active listening and the opportunity to for feedback. 4.3 Create effective leadership of the WPC employees A combination of Mrs Blakely undergoing a work appraisal and appointing a manager to the WPC unit would combat inadequate leadership skills there. Mrs Blakely should still remain as supervisor of the WPC unit; however, there should be a manager present at all times with the WPC staff, who is able to discipline and motivate them. With the presence of a manager, there is a high possibility that a more democratic style of leadership would be adopted and an initiating structure created. This manager could then contact Mrs Blakely if any problem occurs, given her knowledge. Mrs Blakely should take a personal evaluation because it would identify both to her and the firm that she is unable to effectively lead the WPC unit. [IMG-10] [10]5. Implementation [Please note that the assignment table cannot be displayed on this screen because it is too complex.] 6. Referencing Robbins, S., Bergman, R., Stagg, I. & Coulter, M. (2000). Management (2nd ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. [1] Too much detail There is much too much detail here for an Executive Summary. Ideally, you should aim for a half-page summary of your whole report. State your purpose, the main problems, and the recommendations. The detail is presented in the rest of the report. A good example of an Executive Summary can be found in Cindy's report. [2] Discuss theory in more detail The student has not outlined the symptoms Maslow describes in his Hierarchy of Needs theory. Without this detail, it is impossible for the reader to see how the theory relates to the situation and symptoms in the WPC. The student needs to summarise this information so that the reader can follow her analysis. Her discussion of Herzberg's theories in the section that follows is much more effective. [3] Evidence unrelated to theory The evidence presented (symptoms) does not support the theory given (the Ohio State studies). Think through what you are writing and make sure that the theory explains the evidence, or vice versa. [4] Focus on the organisation The student needs to focus on the systemic/organisational problems at the law firm rather than apportioning blame to individuals (i.e. Mrs Blakely). Ensure that you discuss theory in relation to the symptoms noted. The point of the Problem Identification section is to demonstrate your understanding of theory by showing and analysing the links between theory and evidence. [5] Outline and reference this information Don't assume too much about the reader's knowledge. As in Section 1.1 above, the student needs to outline the characteristics of effective teamwork and provide a reference. Without this summarised information, the reader cannot judge whether the analysis of the WPC's problems is justified. [6] Good, but use bullet point form The student has made some good points in this section but point form would have made the whole section much more direct and readable. The Alternative Solutions section needs to be crisp and precise, so: Ensure solutions are stated clearly. Specify who is responsible for performing an action and whom the action affects. Organise supporting points as bullets under the subheadings of 'Advantages' and 'Disadvantages'. Look at Cindy's essay for an example of organising points as bullets under subheadings. [7] Make subheadings more focussed Make sure each subheading states the recommendation clearly and concisely. Specify who is responsible for performing an action and whom the action affects. See Skills for Writing in Management - Recommendations section. [8] Good, but... Solid, detailed account of the goal-setting approach. However, the student should have focused on 'motivators' with the same depth. [9] Recommendations require specific theory The student needs to provide a specific theory for each specific recommendation. References, of course, must also be provided. Unlike the theory used in Problem Identification section which emphasises larger concepts (Motivation, Communication, Leadership, etc.), the theory in the Recommendations section focuses on specific solutions to specific problems. Although concepts like 'goal setting' (4.1) and 'active listening' (4.2) may not be directly associated with a particular "researcher", they are still elements in communication theory, and therefore require discussion. The textbook provides good justification of these ideas, so start there as a source of information. [10] State specific goals The Implementation section is very specific because it is meant to change behaviour. Therefore, avoid any vague wording of implementation goals. Make them as specific and as concise as possible, with no wasted words. To be effective, one person in the organisation needs to be made responsible for the goals to be delivered. Amy's comments Support in VCE and first year <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I think that in Year 12 you received a lot of help, in that you were able to contact teacher whenever you wanted, and that they would help you; and that you were able to give them drafts and that they corrected your work and they gave you their opinion on your work; whereas at Uni you don't receive that sort of attention, and it's very much individual like, and that even at Uni you don't make friends that you can rely upon and see every day and say oh, can you help me; 'cause sometimes you sit in a tute and you don't know anyone; so you really have to work all by yourself. How I approached the topic <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The first thing I did was I read the case study and then I reread it and then I reread it and I think the third time I even got out my highlighter, started highlighting the major parts of the essay which corresponded with the major issues such as motivation, and I just basically kept on rereading it in reference to the major issues. Looking up sources <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Okay, because it was Management and because it was a case study, we didn't have to do any extra research, we didn't have to go to the library - all the information was in our management book, and also the case study handout. So what I did as I sort of answered the last question, I read the case study, and then identified one of the major issues – say, motivation – so then I read the case study again just into motivation, in reference to motivation, and then I opened up my case book in the chapter on motivation, and read everything on motivation, and then correlated that onto a separate piece of paper, and then typed it up; and then I repeated that for leadership, and I repeated that for communications. My effectiveness <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I thought that my approach was quite effective. First I discussed it with individuals, classmates and things, and just determined whether I was on the correct track. And then I thought that I was able to identify the issues properly and analyze them in accordance with the theories. I thought that my word count was...I mean I was very much over the word count about 1000 words; which put pressure on me to try to maintain the analysis correctly. Lecturer help <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> For about four weeks prior to handing in the assignment, we went through similar case studies, and they just taught us how to set it out, and how to identify the issues. Our lecturer told us that there were five major issues, which was easy for us, because basically it's always motivation and leadership. So we – yes, they did. And we could go up and talk to tutors if we were having problems with it. Dealing with unit requirements <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> It's sort of standard now that your essay is 3000 words, and just different types of writing for example in this essay it was a case study, but in the last...In our last assignment for this subject it was a normal report and in another you have different types of Arts format. You have all these different formats, and even referencing – like, you can fail a subject if you don't reference correctly. I tend to find that with an Arts subject it does require more research, because you have to develop your arguments more, and there's more emphasis on your arguments and your opinion on a subject, whereas with a business subject, it really just tends to be regurgitated information on other people's opinions, whilst with an Arts subject, you really have to develop your own... Download the full interview with Amy (mp3, 2.54 MB). <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/assets/utilities/download.php?file=assets/audio/amy/amy-all.mp3> Angus's assignment Angus is a first-year Management student. The main assignment in the subject is a case study on a firm of solicitors: Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Angus's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.2.xml> . o How well do you think the assignment responds to the topic? o Do you think the assignment could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.2.3.xml> about Angus's assignment. [1] Assignment Questions MGM 1300 INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT Semester One, 1996 CASE STUDY Using the Case Study Method analyse the problems, generate solutions and make recommendations for the following case. DUE DATE: Tutorial, Week 11, Week Beginning May 20, 1996 Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Peter Lawless looked over his desk at Arthur Lawton and frowned. "Look, Arthur, I need a new secretary now. I thought the idea of the Word Processing Centre was, that we recruited talented people and trained them there, so they were ready and available when we need them. We spend a lot of money on the Centre and I hear on the grapevine that the work is often sub standard, and now you're telling me that there is no one there really qualified to be my new secretary. What's going wrong! I have had Kathleen Pearce temporarily for the past two weeks, but if she is the best qualified person in the Centre, then it's not doing the job. Her skills are fine, but she has no initiative and doesn't have much of a clue about what we do in this firm - and she has worked here for 18 months! She is a nice girl, but she is not up to it." Arthur Lawton sighed. "Obviously something is not working. We do recruit well trained, bright, young people and hope that one to two years in the WPC will teach them all they need to know about our firm, and I believe Kathleen Pearce is the best qualified there. I am afraid you will have to persevere with Kathleen. There's nobody else." Arthur Lawton and Peter Lawless are senior partners in the legal firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Arthur is also the Managing Partner responsible for handling the administration of the large firm which consists of 25 partners and 48 employed solicitors, plus approximately 80 support staff working in the Sydney office. Twenty two of the support staff are data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre. Their job is to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports, etc. Only well qualified people are employed, usually with a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in the specialised legal documents and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure up to date knowledge of legal documents. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The Word Processing Centre is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The office is very well equipped with modern, ergonomic furniture and equipment, excellent furnishings, and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many benefits such as a superannuation scheme, health scheme, social club and other non salary benefits. After his discussion with Peter Lawless, the Managing Partner, Mr Lawton, feels it is time to find out why the centre is having problems, so he asks around the firm, having talks with other partners and solicitors. He discovers that, although the centre is very productive, there are several concerns. Most solicitors feel they must check each piece of work carefully because there are often errors made. Not necessarily typing errors, but careless errors such as the wrong names or facts keyed into documents. As the clerks are well qualified and trained by the firm, there is a belief that the error rate is unacceptable. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the supervisor, and suggest that there is something wrong "with young people today". Mr Lawton's personnel records also suggest that the turnover rate in the centre is also unacceptable. Only three clerks in the Centre have worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only 12 months or so, despite careful selection of excellent staff. The partners of the firm each have their own secretary, and it is the firm's policy that these secretaries be recruited from the Word Processing Centre workers. Three to five of these vacancies arise each year, with workers from the Centre also relieving when the secretaries are on holidays. Although this opportunity for promotion attracts new workers to the firm, it does not seem to keep many of them long enough to take up the chance. There have also been complaints that, when a clerk has been used as a relief for a secretary, they have proved unreliable if left to their own devices and they lacked initiative. Mr Lawton then talks with Mrs Lorraine Blakely, the supervisor, about the Centre. She has worked with the firm in various administrative capacities for over 20 years and is greatly liked and admired by all the partners and lawyers in the firm. They found her very pleasant and helpful to deal with and always efficient in getting their work through the centre in a short time. She enjoys her job, particularly dealing with the solicitors in the firm, most of whom have worked with her for years. They believe that she is very efficient and they all like to deal with her on a regular basis. Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily when Mr Lawton brings up the matter of the WPC's problems. She springs to the defence of her "girls", saying that although there are errors made, they do get through a lot of work. She does admit that, she believes not many of the clerks like their job very much as they find it boring, as most of the work is simply keying in information into the forms provided on the firm's computer network. She finds that they will come late to work, chat with each other at every opportunity, take long breaks and generally "slack off". To stop this she keeps a firm eye on them, but on the other hand, she tells him, you can't be too hard on them or they will leave quickly, and it is very hard to get good people to stay long. She insists that she must keep her "girls" happy if they are to be productive and stay with the firm, and she doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer or help them to be better secretaries. She states that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun and there is nothing that she can do about that. Mrs Blakely explains the WPC's system to him. The work to be done in the Centre arrives from each solicitor with a request sheet with details of what is required. Mrs Blakely then allocates work to the clerks each day. To ensure they know what to do she is in the habit of going over each piece of work with them before they do the job. There is often a need to clarify some issue with the solicitor. When this is the case, Mrs Blakely goes to the solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the clerks have finished and returns it to the solicitors. She emphasises again to Mr Lawton that she does keep a stern eye on the workers to ensure that they are not wasting time. She insists that tea and lunch break times are strictly adhered to, and discourages chatting during working hours, although as her job means she must be liaising with solicitors on other floors, she is not in the Centre quite a lot. She agrees that the workers do not do very well when they relieve a secretary, but feels it is all so strange to them, much more complex work than they have been used to, but her staff are the best available, and the solicitors just need to put a bit of effort into helping them to learn the job. She says the solicitors do not help their new secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. She suggests to Mr Lawton that she could check every piece of work before it leaves the centre, though this would slow the turnaround time considerably. When questioned about their job the clerks say they like working for the firm, would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces every day as they are isolated in the WPC on the 35th Floor and have no contact with anyone apart from each other and Mrs Blakely. Peter Lawless's temporary secretary, Kathleen Pearce, who is the longest serving clerk, tells Mr Lawton that, although she loves working with so many people her own age, and Mrs Blakely is a lovely boss, always friendly and helpful, she feels like she is still in school, with someone always watching what you are doing and telling her what to do. She has stayed with the firm because the conditions are good and she hopes to achieve promotion. She does, however, express doubts about her ability as "eighteen months of straight keying have made me forget most of what I learned in TAFE and I don't seem to have learnt much about what the solicitors do working in the WPC". Mr Lawton decides to install a piped music system, believing this will add interest to their day's work and aid concentration. The workers are very pleased with this and even say that it speeds up their work. Unfortunately six months later the error rate has even increased, the turnover is still high, and Kathleen Pearce, after six months as secretary to Peter Lawless is just beginning to show more confidence and initiative in her job. Although Peter is happy with her now, he feels he has wasted a lot of time and energy in helping her settle into the job and he tells Arthur Lawton that he believes the problems with the WPC would not be solved by the piped music. Mr Lawton has approached you, an external management consulting firm, to help them identify the real problems, to suggest some possible solutions and make recommendations. Your brief is to examine and analyse the case material and to produce a report, based on the problem solving case method, for Mr Lawton. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Loretta Inglis - sets out what she expects from student assignments on this topic. I expect that you will read all the information that has been given in the subject outline to help you to write the case study. There is a wealth of information there. Ideally, I expect consistent quality throughout all the sections of the report. You need to leave enough time to plan and write each section carefully. I expect that your Problem Identification section will succinctly identify problems (not just repeat case information), explain the problems using case evidence, and show how the theory relates to the problem. Possible Solutions should have clear, concise headings and include advantages and disadvantages in bullet point form. The Recommendations should be very specific - showing who has which responsibility - and should be justified using the theory. The Implementation section should summarise the changes which need to be made as specifically as possible, with someone responsible for seeing that they happen. To do your best, I also expect that you attend tutorials over the weeks before the assignment is due. There your tutor will work with you on practice case studies. Finally, a look at the information on this site will help you to understand how you might tackle the demanding task of integrating problem identification with case evidence and theoretical discussion - as well as the other challenging areas in the case study. Notes on the case study method The use of case studies is a widely accepted means of bringing theoretical concepts and practical situations together. It is not possible to take a class into an organisation and observe the subject matter of management or organisational behaviour in real life - hence a written case study outlining a real, or realistic, situation is the best available alternative. When reading and studying a case study it is possible to take two different approaches. The first of these is the 'analytical' approach where a case structure is examined to try to understand what has happened and why. In this approach you do not identify problems or attempt to develop solutions. The second approach is the problem-oriented method. In this approach a case is analysed to identify the major problems that exist, the causes of and possible solutions to the problems, and finally a recommendation as to the best solution to implement. In this course we mainly utilise a 'problem solving' case study method. As with most things in the management area there is not 'one best way' to analyse or write up a case report. Everyone develops their own methods of sorting and sifting through the information and presenting their findings. However, in this subject we have a set format which we would like you to utilise when presenting your case reports. This format is outlined briefly below. Presentation of written material The following notes are to be used as a guide to students the case studies for assessment in first-year Management. Guidelines A high standard of presentation is required. Typing, or word processing, of all is expected. Work that is submitted in an illegible or untidy fashion may, at your tutor's discretion, be returned unmarked or with marks deducted for poor presentation. In no circumstances should an assignment be written/typed on both sides of the paper. Work should be double or 1-1/2 spaced. A margin of 30mm should be left on both sides of the page. This provides adequate room for examiner's comments as well as creating an uncluttered presentation. All quotations should be enclosed within inverted commas. The exception is quotations of two or more sentences which run to four or more lines. These should be single-spaced and indented from the main body of the text. In these cases inverted commas are unnecessary (see Q Manual). Assignments should be bound firmly into a cover, such as a manilla folder, plastic folder, ring binder, etc. Please do not use envelope folders or submit loose sheets. It should be possible to read every page without undoing any fastenings. Every assignment must be clearly identified. The following details must be on the front of all assignments: Name: Student Number: Assignment Name: Subject Code/Name: Lecturer/Tutor: Due Date: Date Submitted: It is recommended that students KEEP A COPY OF ALL WORK SUBMITTED. While it is extremely rare for student work to be misplaced, it does sometimes occur. The onus is on you to prove that a piece of work was submitted. Grammar, spelling and punctuation are matters which should not be neglected. Failure to take care of these matters causes confusion and ambiguity. Ask someone to read and comment critically on your work prior to submitting it; can they understand what you are trying to say? If not, rewrite it! Problem solving case format for presentation 1. Title Page 2. Table of Contents 3. Executive Summary This section should comprise a brief overview of the case, giving a brief background and noting any important assumptions made. (You will not have all the information you would like - so you may need to make some assumptions). As well as this, you should give a synopsis of your case report, noting very briefly the major problems identified and the recommended solutions. One page is enough. 4. Problem Identification and Analysis In this section you should identify all the major problems in the case in behavioural terms, i.e. in Management/OB related terms (it is not a marketing or an accounting case). Try to get to underlying causes of problems, not just symptoms. Seek advice from your tutor on the layout of this information. You should link each problem identified to relevant theory and also to actual evidence from the case. Remember you MUST integrate theory and reference all non-original work. 5. Statement of Major Problems In most case studies you will identify a number of problems - too many to actually 'solve' in the number of words allowed. Hence it is crucial to make it very clear which are the major two or three problems or key issues, that must be solved first. Therefore this section is just a short concise statement of what problems you are going to solve in the remainder of the case. Half a page is adequate. Having once identified the key problems, you can continually check back to ensure that you are actually attempting to solve them and not some other minor problems you identified. This section is crucial to a good case report. 6. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions While most problems will have a very large number of possible solutions, it is your task to identify and evaluate a number of the more appropriate (at least 2-3 for each major problem identified). Each alternative solution should be briefly outlined and then evaluated in terms of its advantages and disadvantages (strong and weak points). Note: You must evaluate alternatives. It is not necessary to make a statement in this section as to which alternative is considered best - this is the next section. Do not integrate theory in this section and do not recommend theory. Practical solutions to the problems are required. 7. Recommendations This section should state which of the alternative solutions (either singly or in combination) identified in section six is recommended for implementation. You should briefly justify your choice, explaining how it will solve the major problems identified in Section 6. Integration of relevant theory is appropriate here. 8. Implementation In this section you should specifically explain how you will implement the recommended solutions. Theory cannot be implemented; you must translate it into actions. What should be done, by whom, when, in what sequence, what will it cost (rough estimates only) and other such issues. Remember if a recommended solution cannot be realistically implemented then it is no solution at all. 9. Appendices (if any) 10. Bibliography/References This will contain an alphabetical list of all the references you have cited in the body of the report. Do not include details of any sources you have not cited. Ensure the style used is correct and consistent. Some general issues: In a case study it is crucial that you integrate relevant theory from the course and evidence from the case. Failure to attempt to integrate theory will lead to severe mark reduction or failure. Referencing of all non-original material is essential. You will lose marks for poor referencing. The Faculty of Business and Economics Q Manual should be used as a guide. This is available in the library, for sale in the bookshop, and on the web. The Q Manual should also be used as a guide for correct presentation of written material. Check your completed work for internal consistency. For example make sure that you attempt to solve the key issues you have identified. Don't say X is the major problem and then recommend a solution to Y. Try not to be overly descriptive. Remember you are trying to identify, analyse, and solve the problems of the case using the relevant theories from the course - not just repeating what the text book, or case information, has said. Angus's sample assignment Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Assignment topic: [1]View the assignment topic Case study report Contents Executive Summary Problem Identification and Analysis Statement of Major Problems Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions Recommendations Implementation Bibliography Executive summary Lawton, Langridge, Lypton, and Lawless Solicitors The company is a large firm consisting of 25 partners, 48 employed solicitors and 80 support staff. As the company has grown it has developed new initiatives to keep, train and develop systems to promote staff. One of its initiatives was to set up the Word Processing Centre (WPC). The WPC has been in operation for only a few years and the concept behind it was to employ high quality staff that the firm could train and promote to be secretaries for the partners and solicitors. The staff in the WPC are employed to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports etc. Unfortunately the WPC has not been working as it was hoped. Those that have been promoted to secretarial positions have not been able to carry out tasks as well as they probably should have, and just as importantly have not shown any forward thinking or initiative. Other staff, still working in the WPC are producing sloppy, substandard work, display a no-care attitude and have no real idea about what the firm is out to achieve. The senior partners having witnessed this first hand through their new secretaries, and complaints from solicitors, now want to know why. This report will set out to find why. It will do this through firstly identifying the major problems, offer solutions, form recommendations on how to fix the problems and then show how to implement these recommendations. Some of the major problems that the Centre has are that the staff in the WPC are not motivated, they do not seem to enjoy their work for various reasons. They need to be stimulated. They also need to be given more opportunity to voice their opinions and concerns. Problem identification and analysis The Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless Solicitor firm has many problems that need to be worked through. The problems that have been identified are: The staff in the WPC suffer from a lack of job satisfaction. This is shown through a number of behaviours. Firstly, the work that is produced by the staff is of a poor standard. Secondly, the workers find the work they are required to do boring and uninspiring. As satisfaction is linked to motivation, Maslow's hierarchy of needs can provide an insight into this reaction by the workers. Robbins et al. (1997, pp. 535) shows the hierarchy of needs in a way that resembles a pyramid. Maslow stated that within every human there exists five needs. As each need is satisfied the next need higher in the pyramid becomes more dominant. Maslow states that the lowest need for workers is physiological (food, clothing, shelter). Workers then work their way up the pyramid through safety needs (protection from harm), up to social needs (belongingness), then on to esteem needs (self-respect and achievement) before reaching self-actualisation needs which is the highest of all the needs. The staff in the WPC are achieving the first three needs but they are not able to reach their esteem needs. Esteem needs are satisfied through internal and external factors. Internal factors such as selfrespect, autonomy and achievement and external factors such as status, recognition and attention have not been provided from their boring and repetitive work. Therefore they have not achieved their esteem needs. Having not achieved their esteem needs they cannot achieve their self-actualization needs (Robbins et al., 1997). The communication between the management and the staff of the WPC only goes one way. One of the reasons this may have been was that they were not provided with the opportunity to ask questions and learn about the business that they were working in. Carlopio et al., (1997, Chapter 5, pp 231-232) observe that communication has four main attributes. It must be egalitarian, flexible, two-way, and based on an agreement. Taking an egalitarian stance is treating the employees as worthwhile, competent and insightful. A manager taking this tact emphasises joint decision making rather than projecting a superior position. The management of this firm appears to be taking the superior position. One worker recently promoted from the WPC feels that the workers are treated like they are in school, with someone constantly watching over them and telling them what to do. Carlopio et al., (1997, pp. 232) discuss the attribute of flexibility in communication. Flexibility in communication is the willingness of the manager to realise and accept that other ideas do exist, and that other individuals apart from themselves may be able to make significant contributions. Carlopio et al., (1997, pp. 232) then observe that the result of being egalitarian and flexible in communication is two-way communication. This concept has not been able to evolve in the firm of Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless solicitors, since the staff in the WPC are not consulted about any issues at the firm. For example, one reason that may explain errors made in written reports could be that solicitors have not taken the time to explain tasks in enough detail. They assume that the staff in the WPC know exactly what they are doing and hence only need to provide brief notes. Then when mistakes are made they don't provide feedback to address these problems. The same mistakes will then be made time and time again. The only feedback given is in the form of a complaint to a senior partner or Mrs Blakely, the staff supervisor of the WPC. As no two-way discussion has taken place at the firm, an agreement, the final attribute and by product of discussion, cannot be reached. Having said all this it becomes obvious that communication at the firm is extremely poor. The WPC staff know little about the staff above them (Management and Solicitors) and how the firm works. Staff are being left in the dark as to where the firm is trying to go, how it is going to get there, and how the staff in the WPC will help it to get there. As David McClelland states in his three-need theory, all workers have a need for achievement, a need for power and a need for affiliation. In this instance, the workers are not able to satisfy their need for affiliation which means that they are not able to form relationships with the workers around them and so restricting their ability to learn and grow in the firm (Robbins et al., 1997). Apart from the week of training at the beginning of their employment, the staff employed to work at the WPC do not receive any additional training. As Peter Critten states (1992, pp. 83-90), it is important for a worker to want to learn and be trained and for them to see training as a continual allyear-round process that can improve skills in areas that need improvement. Likewise it is important for workers to want this of their employees and see it as an opportunity to improve staff and the business. The company, Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless, have not been provided any learning opportunities and even Peter Lawless' new secretary stated that all she had learnt at TAFE had been forgotten in the 18 months that she had been at the firm. She learnt nothing except the skills that she was required to do each day so she was always going to find it difficult to move from the job she was doing at the WPC to the secretarial job that she received a promotion to. The management at the firm doesn't feel it is necessary to delegate responsibility on to the staff of the WPC. It appears that the management knowingly or unknowingly has prescribed to McGregor's theory X view of a worker (Robbins et al., 1997). McGregor stated that managers view their workers in two distinct ways. Firstly there is the negative view, theory X. Under this theory managers hold 4 assumptions: 1) workers dislike work and therefore will attempt to avoid work wherever possible; 2) because of this dislike they must be threatened with punishment to achieve goals; 3) workers will take no initiative and will avoid responsibility wherever possible; 4) workers will possess no ambition and require security above all else. Then there is the positive view, theory Y, the view which the management at the firm do not seem to have taken. Under this theory, the manager also holds four main assumptions. Those assumptions are; 1) workers see work as a natural part of life; 2) workers can be trusted to be self motivated and able to achieve objectives on there own; 3) the average worker seeks responsibility; 4) workers believe that it is not just the responsibility of the managers to make decisions, they too can provide useful input. This theory X view held by the partners has restricted the way the staff in the WPC have developed. It has meant that the workers now do not know how to take responsibility or show initiative. The likely reason for this could be the fact that the firm does not promote this sort of forward thinking when the staff begin working at the firm. Statement of major problems The study of this case has produced two main problems. The study has found those two main problems to be communication and job satisfaction. Communication is the essence of good management and the only way to implement good company policy and procedures is through effective communication. One important aspect of effective communication of managers is the extent to which they provide feedback to their employees and the extent to which they offer them opportunities to provide feedback so that the employees feel that they are being supported (Carlopio et al., 1997, p 244). The firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless do not provide this aspect of communication. Job satisfaction too is important, as the workers need to feel that work is an enjoyable place that provides some intrinsic and extrinsic rewards. They should be able to take more responsibility and feel that they can be left to deal with situations themselves. No worker likes being watched over the whole time they are working. It is an incredible boost of a worker's self-esteem to be given responsibility and the trust that they can be given a task and not have to be watched over while it is being done. Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions Three possible solutions the firm could use to improve communication between staff of all levels have been listed below. 1) Regular appraisals Allows workers to meet with management and discuss their needs. If needs cannot be met there and then, ways have to be developed to meet those needs. It is also an opportunity for the manager to provide feedback to staff on how they are going, and for staff to speak honestly and openly about how they think they are going. Disadvantages of appraisals are that in firms of this size it would take a long period of time to provide every staff member with an appraisal. Also in this company some senior management may not know the staff in the WPC, therefore leaving appraisals up to lower or middle management. They may not be able to deal with the staffs' problems and may dismiss them, not passing them on to the partners. 2) Open door management Open door management provides the opportunity for staff from the WPC to go and see one of the partners about problems at any time. It would show that the management is friendly and willing to listen to the concerns of its employees. It is whether or not anything is done about these concerns as to whether this solution will be effective. This solution may not be viable as the partners may be dealing with complaints all day long if workers have a lot of concerns. This would allow no time for work and instead their offices could become just a form of a complaints box. This is probably not likely, but could occur to some extent. 3) Regular company meetings Staff meetings are vital to all businesses and this firm is no exception. A meeting is a chance for all staff that work in the WPC to congregate and voice their concerns with all levels of management. Meetings could be held weekly or every two weeks and different solicitors and different partners could attend each meeting. It is vital too, that the meetings are conducted by the same person, or persons so that some form of consistency is maintained. The second major issue that needs to be dealt with is to increase job satisfaction. Some solutions have been provided to solve these issues and they have been listed below. 1) Reward quality work Staff at the Centre are presenting work to the solicitors that is of a poor standard. Peter Lawless wants to know why. At the moment the workers do not seem to care whether or not the work that they do is correct or not. It is necessary for the company to reward staff when they do a good job. Monthly staff awards could be presented to the staff member who has the best month work wise or team rewards could be given if the whole WPC has a good month. A downfall of these types of rewards are that they can produce unhealthy competition which could lead to discontent within the Centre. This may provide even less willingness to work. 2) Be given more responsibility The partners should feel that they are able to provide the staff at the WPC with tasks that involve a greater amount of responsibility. They may be able to give the staff work that they may not have time to do, or work that would provide a valuable learning experience for them. This would give the staff more of an insight into the workings of the company and would also help with the integration for the staff when promoted. The only disadvantage of doing this would be that the partners may spend too much time explaining or fixing work done by their staff in the WPC. 3) Provide Training To keep workers learning and aid integration between the WPC and secretarial roles, training in various aspects of the business could be given to the staff. Recommendations The major problems that needed to be solved at the firm of Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless were communication and a distinct lack of job satisfaction. Recommendations will now be made as to how the firm can combat these problems. Companies with the highest morale and the least turnover are the ones that keep their people informed about goals and policies and listen to them. Employees should be able to talk, and the senior partners should listen to them (LeBoeuf, 1988, pp 82). In my opinion, the staff at the WPC have no voice in the company at all. This needs to be remedied. To attack this problem the firm will need to hear the concerns of the staff. It should hold regular meetings with the staff of the WPC and seek to fix problems that arise out of these meetings. The meetings should be held weekly by one of the senior partners and at least one meeting should be attended by all of the partners during the course of a month. As Raymond Smith stated in an interview in Kanter (1990, pp. 79) "partners should be seen to be leading the way and if they are asking everyone to work together they should be seen to be doing the same." Meetings will provide an outlet for the staff of the WPC and make them feel that they are a part of the firm. At the moment they feel they are stuck up on the 35'h floor where no one can see or hear them. Regular appraisals also should be held. It would be good to hold one every six months however time restraints may not mean that this is possible, so policy should be made that staff receive an appraisal yearly. This will provide direct feedback to all staff and give staff that may not be as open as some their chance to have a voice. Appraisals should be held with both the WPC supervisor and one of the partners. Lack of job satisfaction has also been identified as a problem. This is reflected through little responsibility given to the workers and little reward also given. As a result of this work standard is poor and no initiative is displayed. No encouragement is given to staff of the WPC from anyone higher than the WPC supervisor. There is no intrinsic motivation for working to a good standard. If senior partners became more visible to the staff, if they are seen to be socialising and more importantly encouraging the workers then the workers will become more motivated as it doesn't seem as far to the top. Also the company needs to integrate the staff into the firm a lot more. The staff need to know more about the firm and how it works. This could be done by giving them tasks that management don't have time to do, or that can provide learning opportunities for them. It can also be done through providing training. Computer training, time management, and organisational management would benefit the staff. This training would benefit both the individual and the company. Implementation To implement these solutions will not require a huge outlay of funds. It will require written policy so that the staff of the WPC can see that changes have been made. Staff as well as partners and solicitors should be involved in the writing up of policy. Firstly a staff meeting should be held. Everyone who works at the WPC should be in attendance, partners too should be there. This meeting will outline the changes that are going to be made. It will be at this meeting that the dates for the weekly meetings will be set and also an announcement of who will head these meetings. The senior partner, in consultation with the WPC supervisor will write up an agenda for these meetings. The WPC supervisor will then set dates for each staff member's appraisal. A date for each employer will reinforce that the company is making changes and that it wants to hear the opinions of the staff right away. Training could be provided either internally or externally. Courses that focus on computer skills, management skills, and organisational skills would be a good start for the employees. Training is essential so that skills already leant at TAFE or other schooling do not wane. The cost of the training should be built into, but on top of, staff salary. Bibliography Andrewartha, G., Armstrong, H., Carlopio, J., (1997), Developing management Skills, Addison Wesley Longman Australia Bergmann, R., Robbins, S.P., Stagg, I., (1997), Management, Prentice Hall Australia Critten, Peter (1 993), Butterworth-Heinemann Ltd, Linaere House, Jordan House, Oxford Kanter, Rosabeth Moss (1990), On the Frontiers of Management, Henry Holt and Co. and James Lee Burke LeBoeuf, M. (1988), How to Motivate People, The Garden City Press, Letchworth, Hertfordshire [1] Assignment topic Case study summary Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless is a large Sydney legal firm. Among its staff are 22 data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre (WPC). Their job is to process the large volume of legal documents produced by the firm's solicitors. WPC clerks are carefully selected and must have a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in specialised legal documents, and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure they keep their knowledge up-to-date. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The WPC is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The centre is very well equipped with excellent furnishings and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many other benefits. However, all is not well. Senior staff and solicitors have complained to Arthur Lawton, the Managing Partner, that they need to check the work of WPC clerks who work as relief secretaries, because of the frequent errors made. They also believe that these workers are unreliable and lack initiative. Personnel records show that WPC staff do not stay with the firm for very long, despite the opportunities for promotion. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the WPC supervisor, who has worked with the firm for over 20 years. Indeed, they tend to see the problem as the result of something wrong "with young people today." When Mr Lawton raises the matter of the WPC's problems, Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily. She defends her clerks, saying that despite the errors, they do complete a lot of work. She admits that many of them find the job boring, as it mostly involves keying in information. The clerks also, often come to work late, chat at every opportunity, and generally don't work too hard. To stop this, she keeps a firm eye on them but she believes she can't be too hard or they will leave the firm. Mrs Blakely then explains the WPC system. The work to be done arrives from each solicitor and is allocated to the clerks on a daily basis. To ensure they know what to do, she goes over each piece of work with them before they do the job. When information needs to be clarified, Mrs Blakely goes to the relevant solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the job is finished and returns it to the solicitors. Her job however, also means she liaises with solicitors on other floors, so she is often away from the Centre. Mrs Blakely agrees that the workers do not perform very well as relief secretaries, but thinks this is because the work is more complex than they are trained to do. She says the solicitors do not help the relief secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. When questioned, the WPC clerks say they like working for the firm and would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces everyday as they are isolated on the 35th floor and have no contact with other staff, except with each other and Mrs Blakely. After trying to improve efficiency through the use of piped music - an experiment which fails - Mr Lawton turns to you, as an external management consultant, for advice. Angus's assignment and what his lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Case study report Contents Executive summary Problem identification and analysis Statement of major problems Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions Recommendations Implementation Bibliography Executive summary [IMG-1] [1] Lawton, Langridge, Lypton, and Lawless Solicitors The company is a large firm consisting of 25 partners, 48 employed solicitors and 80 support staff. As the company has grown it has developed new initiatives to keep, train and develop systems to promote staff. One of its initiatives was to set up the Word Processing Centre (WPC). The WPC has been in operation for only a few years and the concept behind it was to employ high quality staff that the firm could train and promote to be secretaries for the partners and solicitors. The staff in the WPC are employed to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports etc. Unfortunately the WPC has not been working as it was hoped. Those that have been promoted to secretarial positions have not been able to carry out tasks as well as they probably should have, and just as importantly have not shown any forward thinking or initiative. Other staff, still working in the WPC are producing sloppy, substandard work, display a no-care attitude and have no real idea about what the firm is out to achieve. The senior partners having witnessed this first hand through their new secretaries, and complaints from solicitors, now want to know why. [IMG-2] [2]This report will set out to find why. It will do this through firstly identifying the major problems, offer solutions, form recommendations on how to fix the problems and then show how to implement these recommendations. Some of the major problems that the Centre has are that the staff in the WPC are not motivated, they do not seem to enjoy their work for various reasons. They need to be stimulated. They also need to be given more opportunity to voice their opinions and concerns. Problem identification and analysis The Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless Solicitor firm has many problems that need to be worked through. The problems that have been identified are: The staff in the WPC suffer from a lack of job satisfaction. This is shown through a number of behaviours. Firstly, the work that is produced by the staff is of a poor standard. Secondly, the workers find the work they are required to do boring and uninspiring. [IMG-3] [3]As satisfaction is linked to motivation, Maslow's hierarchy of needs can provide an insight into this reaction by the workers. Robbins et al. (1997, pp. 535) shows the hierarchy of needs in a way that resembles a pyramid. Maslow stated that within every human there exists five needs. As each need is satisfied the next need higher in the pyramid becomes more dominant. Maslow states that the lowest need for workers is physiological (food, clothing, shelter). Workers then work their way up the pyramid through safety needs (protection from harm), up to social needs (belongingness), then on to esteem needs (self-respect and achievement) before reaching self-actualisation needs which is the highest of all the needs. The staff in the WPC are achieving the first three needs but that are not able to reach their esteem needs. Esteem needs are satisfied through internal and external factors. Internal factors such as selfrespect, autonomy and achievement and external factors such as status, recognition and attention have not been provided from their boring and repetitive work. Therefore they have not achieved their esteem needs. Having not achieved their esteem needs they cannot achieve their self-actualization needs (Robbins et al., 1997). The communication between the management and the staff of the WPC only goes one way. One of the reasons this may have been was that they were not provided with the opportunity to ask questions and learn about the business that they were working in. Carlopio et al., (1997, Chapter 5, pp 231-232) observe that communication has four main attributes. It must be egalitarian, flexible, two-way, and based on an agreement. Taking an egalitarian stance is treating the employees as worthwhile, competent and insightful. A manager taking this tact emphasises joint decision making rather than projecting a superior position. The management of this firm appears to be taking the superior position. One worker recently promoted from the WPC feels that the workers are treated like they are in school, with someone constantly watching over them and telling them what to do. Carlopio et al., (1997, pp. 232) discuss the attribute of flexibility in communication. Flexibility in communication is the willingness of the manager to realise and accept that other ideas do exist, and that other individuals apart from themselves may be able to make significant contributions. Carlopio et al., (1997, pp. 232) then observe that the result of being egalitarian and flexible in communication is two-way communication. This concept has not been able to evolve in the firm of Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless solicitors, since the staff in the WPC are not consulted about any issues at the firm. For example, one reason that may explain errors made in written reports could be that solicitors have not taken the time to explain tasks in enough detail. They assume that the staff in the WPC know exactly what they are doing and hence only need to provide brief notes. Then when mistakes are made they don't provide feedback to address these problems. The same mistakes will then be made time and time again. The only feedback given is in the form of a complaint to a senior partner or Mrs Blakely, the staff supervisor of the WPC. [IMG-4] [4]As no two-way discussion has taken place at the firm, an agreement, the final attribute and by product of discussion, cannot be reached. Having said all this it becomes obvious that communication at the firm is extremely poor. The WPC staff know little about the staff above them (Management and Solicitors) and how the firm works. Staff are being left in the dark as to where the firm is trying to go, how it is going to get there, and how the staff in the WPC will help it to get there. As David McClelland states in his three-need theory, all workers have a need for achievement, a need for power and a need for affiliation. In this instance, the workers are not able to satisfy their need for affiliation which means that they are not able to form relationships with the workers around them and so restricting their ability to learn and grow in the firm (Robbins et al., 1997). Apart from the week of training at the beginning of their employment, the staff employed to work at the WPC do not receive any additional training. As Peter Critten states (1992, pp. 83-90), it is important for a worker to want to learn and be trained and for them to see training as a continual allyear-round process that can improve skills in areas that need improvement. Likewise it is important for workers to want this of their employees and see it as an opportunity to improve staff and the business. The company, Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless, have not been provided any learning opportunities and even Peter Lawless' new secretary stated that all she had learnt at TAFE had been forgotten in the 18 months that she had been at the firm. She learnt nothing except the skills that she was required to do each day so she was always going to find it difficult to move from the job she was doing at the WPC to the secretarial job that she received a promotion to. The management at the firm doesn't feel it is necessary to delegate responsibility on to the staff of the WPC. It appears that the management knowingly or unknowingly has prescribed to McGregor's theory X view of a worker (Robbins et al., 1997). McGregor stated that managers view their workers in two distinct ways. Firstly there is the negative view, theory X. Under this theory managers hold 4 assumptions: 1) workers dislike work and therefore will attempt to avoid work wherever possible; 2) because of this dislike they must be threatened with punishment to achieve goals; 3) workers will take no initiative and will avoid responsibility wherever possible; 4) workers will possess no ambition and require security above all else. Then there is the positive view, theory Y, the view which the management at the firm do not seem to have taken. Under this theory, the manager also holds four main assumptions. Those assumptions are; 1) workers see work as a natural part of life; 2) workers can be trusted to be self motivated and able to achieve objectives on there own; 3) the average worker seeks responsibility; 4) workers believe that it is not just the responsibility of the managers to make decisions, they too can provide useful input. This theory X view held by the partners has restricted the way the staff in the WPC have developed. It has meant that the workers now do not know how to take responsibility or show initiative. The likely reason for this could be the fact that the firm does not promote this sort of forward thinking when the staff begin working at the firm. Statement of major problems The study of this case has produced two main problems. The study has found those two main problems to be communication and [IMG-5] [5]job satisfaction. Communication is the essence of good management and the only way to implement good company policy and procedures is through effective communication. One important aspect of effective communication of managers is the extent to which they provide feedback to their employees and the extent to which they offer them opportunities to provide feedback so that the employees feel that they are being supported (Carlopio et al., 1997, p 244). The firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless do not provide this aspect of communication. Job satisfaction too is important, as the workers need to feel that work is an enjoyable place that provides some intrinsic and extrinsic rewards. They should be able to take more responsibility and feel that they can be left to deal with situations themselves. No worker likes being watched over the whole time they are working. It is an incredible boost of a worker's self-esteem to be given responsibility and the trust that they can be given a task and not have to be watched over while it is being done. Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions Three possible solutions the firm could use to improve communication between staff of all levels have been listed below. [IMG-6] [6] 1) Regular appraisals Allows workers to meet with management and discuss their needs. If needs cannot be met there and then, ways have to be developed to meet those needs. It is also an opportunity for the manager to provide feedback to staff on how they are going, and for staff to speak honestly and openly about how they think they are going. Disadvantages of appraisals are that in firms of this size it would take a long period of time to provide every staff member with an appraisal. Also in this company some senior management may not know the staff in the WPC, therefore leaving appraisals up to lower or middle management. They may not be able to deal with the staffs' problems and may dismiss them, not passing them on to the partners. 2) Open door management Open door management provides the opportunity for staff from the WPC to go and see one of the partners about problems at any time. It would show that the management is friendly and willing to listen to the concerns of its employees. It is whether or not anything is done about these concerns as to whether this solution will be effective. This solution may not be viable as the partners may be dealing with complaints all day long if workers have a lot of concerns. This would allow no time for work and instead their offices could become just a form of a complaints box. This is probably not likely, but could occur to some extent. 3) Regular company meetings Staff meetings are vital to all businesses and this firm is no exception. A meeting is a chance for all staff that work in the WPC to congregate and voice their concerns with all levels of management. Meetings could be held weekly or every two weeks and different solicitors and different partners could attend each meeting. It is vital too, that the meetings are conducted by the same person, or persons so that some form of consistency is maintained. The second major issue that needs to be dealt with is to increase job satisfaction. Some solutions have been provided to solve these issues and they have been listed below. 1) Reward quality work Staff at the Centre are presenting work to the solicitors that is of a poor standard. Peter Lawless wants to know why. At the moment the workers do not seem to care whether or not the work that they do is correct or not. It is necessary for the company to reward staff when they do a good job. Monthly staff awards could be presented to the staff member who has the best month work wise or team rewards could be given if the whole WPC has a good month. A downfall of these types of rewards are that they can produce unhealthy competition which could lead to discontent within the Centre. This may provide even less willingness to work. 2) Be given more responsibility The partners should feel that they are able to provide the staff at the WPC with tasks that involve a greater amount of responsibility. They may be able to give the staff work that they may not have time to do, or work that would provide a valuable learning experience for them. This would give the staff more of an insight into the workings of the company and would also help with the integration for the staff when promoted. The only disadvantage of doing this would be that the partners may spend too much time explaining or fixing work done by their staff in the WPC. 3) Provide Training To keep workers learning and aid integration between the WPC and secretarial roles, training in various aspects of the business could be given to the staff. Recommendations The major problems that needed to be solved at the firm of Lawton, Langbridge, Lypton and Lawless were communication and a distinct lack of job satisfaction. Recommendations will now be made as to how the firm can combat these problems. Companies with the highest morale and the least turnover are the ones that keep their people informed about goals and policies and listen to them. Employees should be able to talk, and the senior partners should listen to them (LeBoeuf, 1988, pp 82). In my opinion, the staff at the WPC have no voice in the company at all. This needs to be remedied. To attack this problem the firm will need to hear the concerns of the staff. It should hold regular meetings with the staff of the WPC and seek to fix problems that arise out of these meetings. The meetings should be held weekly by one of the senior partners and at least one meeting should be attended by all of the partners during the course of a month. As Raymond Smith stated in an interview in Kanter (1990, pp. 79) "partners should be seen to be leading the way and if they are asking everyone to work together they should be seen to be doing the same." Meetings will provide an outlet for the staff of the WPC and make them feel that they are a part of the firm. At the moment they feel they are stuck up on the 35'h floor where no one can see or hear them. Regular appraisals also should be held. It would be good to hold one every six months however time restraints may not mean that this is possible, so policy should be made that staff receive an appraisal yearly. This will provide direct feedback to all staff and give staff that may not be as open as some their chance to have a voice. Appraisals should be held with both the WPC supervisor and one of the partners. [IMG-7] [7]Lack of job satisfaction has also been identified as a problem. This is reflected through little responsibility given to the workers and little reward also given. As a result of this work standard is poor and no initiative is displayed. No encouragement is given to staff of the WPC from anyone higher than the WPC supervisor. There is no intrinsic motivation for working to a good standard. If senior partners became more visible to the staff, if they are seen to be socialising and more importantly encouraging the 'workers' then the workers will become more motivated as it doesn't seem as far to the top. Also the company needs to integrate the staff into the firm a lot more. The staff need to know more about the firm and how it works. This could be done by giving them tasks that management don't have time to do, or that can provide learning opportunities for them. It can also be done through providing training. Computer training, time management, and organisational management would benefit the staff. This training would benefit both the individual and the company. Implementation [IMG-8] [8]To implement these solutions will not require a huge outlay of funds. It will require written policy so that the staff of the WPC can see that changes have been made. Staff as well as partners and solicitors should be involved in the writing up of policy. Firstly a staff meeting should be held. Everyone who works at the WPC should be in attendance, partners too should be there. This meeting will outline the changes that are going to be made. It will be at this meeting that the dates for the weekly meetings will be set and also an announcement of who will head these meetings. The senior partner, in consultation with the WPC supervisor will write up an agenda for these meetings. The WPC supervisor will then set dates for each staff member's appraisal. A date for each employer will reinforce that the company is making changes and that it wants to hear the opinions of the staff right away. Training could be provided either internally or externally. Courses that focus on computer skills, management skills, and organisational skills would be a good start for the employees. Training is essential so that skills already leant at TAFE or other schooling do not wane. The cost of the training should be built into, but on top of, staff salary. [IMG-9] [10]Bibliography [IMG-10] [9]Andrewartha, G., Armstrong, H. & Carlopio, J. (1997). Developing management skills. South Melbourne: Longman. Bergmann, R., Robbins, S.P. & Stagg, I. (1997). Management. Prentice Hall Australia [IMG-11] [11]Critten, P. (1993). Oxford: Butterworth-Heinemann. [IMG-12] [12]Kanter, R. M. (1990). On the frontiers of management. Henry Holt and Co. LeBoeuf, M. (1988). How to motivate people. Letchworth, Hertfordshire: The Garden City Press. [1] Unnecessary repetition of case material The manager reading the report is usually the person who commissions the report (case study). As he or she is familiar with the problems being identified, there is no need to repeat background details from the case such as the facilities offered by the firm, number of personnel, etc. [2] Outline these briefly here In the Executive Summary in a report or case study, state 1) the purpose of the report, 2) the main problems identified, 3) your recommendations and the expected outcomes. Key aspects of the case should be very briefly summarised. Length should be no more than half a page to a page. A good example of an executive summary can be found in Cindy's report. [3] Write all authors' names the first time When citing a source for the first time, write all the authors' names, e.g. Robbins, Bergmann and Stagg (1997, p. 535). For a second or third reference to the same authors, use the "et al." form, eg. Robbins et al. (1997). [4] A very good section overall, but where is 'Leadership'? Theory has been very well integrated throughout the Problem Identification section. Each writer's concepts has been briefly introduced by outlining them and these ideas have then been linked to evidence from the case study. The section on Carlopio et al. in regard to two-way communication is particularly well done. Leadership as a concept, however, is not covered in this section, but is an essential element in the problem situation. Refer to Skills for Writing in Management - Problem Identification for advice on how to incorporate and discuss theory in your writing. [5] "Motivation", not job satisfaction! "Job satisfaction" is an aspect of motivation but it cannot substitute for the whole concept. Recognising the differences between the everyday meanings of a word and the more specialised academic meanings is part of the learning task in this subject. [6] Improve headings and formatting The Alternative Solutions section needs to be crisp and precise, so: 1. Ensure headings are quite clear. Specify who is responsible for performing an action and whom the action affects (e.g. a heading like "Regular Appraisals" does not tell the reader who is to be appraised). Formatting could also be improved by using major headings such as "Solutions for Improving Communication" and "Solutions for Improving Motivation" rather than "Job Satisfaction". 2. Organise supporting points as bullets under the subheadings of "Advantages" and "Disadvantages". For advice on writing subheadings, refer to Skills for Writing in Management - Recommendations. [7] Lacks theoretical justification. It's a pity to throw away marks just because you are near the end! All recommendations should be equally covered which means providing the relevant theoretical discussion for each recommendation. [8] Very vague. Practical steps are missing! The Implementation section needs to make the maximum impact in the most effective way. The best way of doing this is to table the relevant information, focusing on the practical steps needed. Use headings such as Who? What ? When? Where? How much? Clear headings are essential so the reader can follow the advice. As this section is a summary of the changes that need to be made in the problem situation, avoid any vague wording of implementation goals. Instead, make them as specific and as concise as possible, with no wasted words. The Implementation section in Cindy's assignment provides a good example. [9] Referencing problems Carlopio, J., Andrewartha, G. & Armstrong, H. (1997). Developing management skills. South Melbourne: Longman. Primary author to be listed first. Robbins, S.P., Bergman, R. & Stagg, I. (1997). Management. Sydney: Prentice Hall. Primary author to be listed first, place of publication should be the city and be listed before the publisher. [10] In APA Style this is called References. [11] Add missing title information in italics. [12] Add missing place of publication. Cindy's assignment Cindy is a first-year Management student. The main assignment in the subject is a case study on a firm of solicitors: Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Cindy's assignment <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.2.xml> . o How well do you think the assignment responds to the topic? o Do you think the assignment could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/management/3.3.3.xml> about Cindy's assignment. [1] Assignment questions MGM 1300 INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT Semester One, 1996 CASE STUDY Using the Case Study Method analyse the problems, generate solutions and make recommendations for the following case. DUE DATE: Tutorial, Week 11, Week Beginning May 20, 1996 Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless, Solicitors Peter Lawless looked over his desk at Arthur Lawton and frowned. "Look, Arthur, I need a new secretary now. I thought the idea of the Word Processing Centre was, that we recruited talented people and trained them there, so they were ready and available when we need them. We spend a lot of money on the Centre and I hear on the grapevine that the work is often sub standard, and now you're telling me that there is no one there really qualified to be my new secretary. What's going wrong! I have had Kathleen Pearce temporarily for the past two weeks, but if she is the best qualified person in the Centre, then it's not doing the job. Her skills are fine, but she has no initiative and doesn't have much of a clue about what we do in this firm - and she has worked here for 18 months! She is a nice girl, but she is not up to it." Arthur Lawton sighed. "Obviously something is not working. We do recruit well trained, bright, young people and hope that one to two years in the WPC will teach them all they need to know about our firm, and I believe Kathleen Pearce is the best qualified there. I am afraid you will have to persevere with Kathleen. There's nobody else." Arthur Lawton and Peter Lawless are senior partners in the legal firm of Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless. Arthur is also the Managing Partner responsible for handling the administration of the large firm which consists of 25 partners and 48 employed solicitors, plus approximately 80 support staff working in the Sydney office. Twenty two of the support staff are data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre. Their job is to word process the large volumes of legal documents produced by the solicitors, together with their long reports, etc. Only well qualified people are employed, usually with a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in the specialised legal documents and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure up to date knowledge of legal documents. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The Word Processing Centre is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The office is very well equipped with modern, ergonomic furniture and equipment, excellent furnishings, and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many benefits such as a superannuation scheme, health scheme, social club and other non salary benefits. After his discussion with Peter Lawless, the Managing Partner, Mr Lawton, feels it is time to find out why the centre is having problems, so he asks around the firm, having talks with other partners and solicitors. He discovers that, although the centre is very productive, there are several concerns. Most solicitors feel they must check each piece of work carefully because there are often errors made. Not necessarily typing errors, but careless errors such as the wrong names or facts keyed into documents. As the clerks are well qualified and trained by the firm, there is a belief that the error rate is unacceptable. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the supervisor, and suggest that there is something wrong "with young people today". Mr Lawton's personnel records also suggest that the turnover rate in the centre is also unacceptable. Only three clerks in the Centre have worked for the firm for more than eighteen months, with the majority staying only 12 months or so, despite careful selection of excellent staff. The partners of the firm each have their own secretary, and it is the firm's policy that these secretaries be recruited from the Word Processing Centre workers. Three to five of these vacancies arise each year, with workers from the Centre also relieving when the secretaries are on holidays. Although this opportunity for promotion attracts new workers to the firm, it does not seem to keep many of them long enough to take up the chance. There have also been complaints that, when a clerk has been used as a relief for a secretary, they have proved unreliable if left to their own devices and they lacked initiative. Mr Lawton then talks with Mrs Lorraine Blakely, the supervisor, about the Centre. She has worked with the firm in various administrative capacities for over 20 years and is greatly liked and admired by all the partners and lawyers in the firm. They found her very pleasant and helpful to deal with and always efficient in getting their work through the centre in a short time. She enjoys her job, particularly dealing with the solicitors in the firm, most of whom have worked with her for years. They believe that she is very efficient and they all like to deal with her on a regular basis. Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily when Mr Lawton brings up the matter of the WPC's problems. She springs to the defence of her "girls", saying that although there are errors made, they do get through a lot of work. She does admit that, she believes not many of the clerks like their job very much as they find it boring, as most of the work is simply keying in information into the forms provided on the firm's computer network. She finds that they will come late to work, chat with each other at every opportunity, take long breaks and generally "slack off". To stop this she keeps a firm eye on them, but on the other hand, she tells him, you can't be too hard on them or they will leave quickly, and it is very hard to get good people to stay long. She insists that she must keep her "girls" happy if they are to be productive and stay with the firm, and she doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer or help them to be better secretaries. She states that the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun and there is nothing that she can do about that. Mrs Blakely explains the WPC's system to him. The work to be done in the Centre arrives from each solicitor with a request sheet with details of what is required. Mrs Blakely then allocates work to the clerks each day. To ensure they know what to do she is in the habit of going over each piece of work with them before they do the job. There is often a need to clarify some issue with the solicitor. When this is the case, Mrs Blakely goes to the solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the clerks have finished and returns it to the solicitors. She emphasises again to Mr Lawton that she does keep a stern eye on the workers to ensure that they are not wasting time. She insists that tea and lunch break times are strictly adhered to, and discourages chatting during working hours, although as her job means she must be liaising with solicitors on other floors, she is not in the Centre quite a lot. She agrees that the workers do not do very well when they relieve a secretary, but feels it is all so strange to them, much more complex work than they have been used to, but her staff are the best available, and the solicitors just need to put a bit of effort into helping them to learn the job. She says the solicitors do not help their new secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. She suggests to Mr Lawton that she could check every piece of work before it leaves the centre, though this would slow the turnaround time considerably. When questioned about their job the clerks say they like working for the firm, would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces every day as they are isolated in the WPC on the 35th Floor and have no contact with anyone apart from each other and Mrs Blakely. Peter Lawless's temporary secretary, Kathleen Pearce, who is the longest serving clerk, tells Mr Lawton that, although she loves working with so many people her own age, and Mrs Blakely is a lovely boss, always friendly and helpful, she feels like she is still in school, with someone always watching what you are doing and telling her what to do. She has stayed with the firm because the conditions are good and she hopes to achieve promotion. She does, however, express doubts about her ability as "eighteen months of straight keying have made me forget most of what I learned in TAFE and I don't seem to have learnt much about what the solicitors do working in the WPC". Mr Lawton decides to install a piped music system, believing this will add interest to their day's work and aid concentration. The workers are very pleased with this and even say that it speeds up their work. Unfortunately six months later the error rate has even increased, the turnover is still high, and Kathleen Pearce, after six months as secretary to Peter Lawless is just beginning to show more confidence and initiative in her job. Although Peter is happy with her now, he feels he has wasted a lot of time and energy in helping her settle into the job and he tells Arthur Lawton that he believes the problems with the WPC would not be solved by the piped music. Mr Lawton has approached you, an external management consulting firm, to help them identify the real problems, to suggest some possible solutions and make recommendations. Your brief is to examine and analyse the case material and to produce a report, based on the problem solving case method, for Mr Lawton. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Loretta Inglis - sets out what she expects from student assignments on this topic. I expect that you will read all the information that has been given in the subject outline to help you to write the case study. There is a wealth of information there. Ideally, I expect consistent quality throughout all the sections of the report. You need to leave enough time to plan and write each section carefully. I expect that your Problem Identification section will succinctly identify problems (not just repeat case information), explain the problems using case evidence, and show how the theory relates to the problem. Possible Solutions should have clear, concise headings and include advantages and disadvantages in bullet point form. The Recommendations should be very specific - showing who has which responsibility - and should be justified using the theory. The Implementation section should summarise the changes which need to be made as specifically as possible, with someone responsible for seeing that they happen. To do your best, I also expect that you attend tutorials over the weeks before the assignment is due. There your tutor will work with you on practice case studies. Finally, a look at the information on this site will help you to understand how you might tackle the demanding task of integrating problem identification with case evidence and theoretical discussion - as well as the other challenging areas in the case study. Notes on the case study method The use of case studies is a widely accepted means of bringing theoretical concepts and practical situations together. It is not possible to take a class into an organisation and observe the subject matter of management or organisational behaviour in real life - hence a written case study outlining a real, or realistic, situation is the best available alternative. When reading and studying a case study it is possible to take two different approaches. The first of these is the 'analytical' approach where a case structure is examined to try to understand what has happened and why. In this approach you do not identify problems or attempt to develop solutions. The second approach is the problem-oriented method. In this approach a case is analysed to identify the major problems that exist, the causes of and possible solutions to the problems, and finally a recommendation as to the best solution to implement. In this course we mainly utilise a 'problem solving' case study method. As with most things in the management area there is not 'one best way' to analyse or write up a case report. Everyone develops their own methods of sorting and sifting through the information and presenting their findings. However, in this subject we have a set format which we would like you to utilise when presenting your case reports. This format is outlined briefly below. Presentation of written material The following notes are to be used as a guide to students the case studies for assessment in first-year Management. Guidelines A high standard of presentation is required. Typing, or word processing, of all is expected. Work that is submitted in an illegible or untidy fashion may, at your tutor's discretion, be returned unmarked or with marks deducted for poor presentation. In no circumstances should an assignment be written/typed on both sides of the paper. Work should be double or 1-1/2 spaced. A margin of 30mm should be left on both sides of the page. This provides adequate room for examiner's comments as well as creating an uncluttered presentation. All quotations should be enclosed within inverted commas. The exception is quotations of two or more sentences which run to four or more lines. These should be single-spaced and indented from the main body of the text. In these cases inverted commas are unnecessary (see Q Manual). Assignments should be bound firmly into a cover, such as a manilla folder, plastic folder, ring binder, etc. Please do not use envelope folders or submit loose sheets. It should be possible to read every page without undoing any fastenings. Every assignment must be clearly identified. The following details must be on the front of all assignments: Name: Student Number: Assignment Name: Subject Code/Name: Lecturer/Tutor: Due Date: Date Submitted: It is recommended that students KEEP A COPY OF ALL WORK SUBMITTED. While it is extremely rare for student work to be misplaced, it does sometimes occur. The onus is on you to prove that a piece of work was submitted. Grammar, spelling and punctuation are matters which should not be neglected. Failure to take care of these matters causes confusion and ambiguity. Ask someone to read and comment critically on your work prior to submitting it; can they understand what you are trying to say? If not, rewrite it! Problem solving case format for presentation 1. Title Page 2. Table of Contents 3. Executive Summary This section should comprise a brief overview of the case, giving a brief background and noting any important assumptions made. (You will not have all the information you would like - so you may need to make some assumptions). As well as this, you should give a synopsis of your case report, noting very briefly the major problems identified and the recommended solutions. One page is enough. 4. Problem Identification and Analysis In this section you should identify all the major problems in the case in behavioural terms, i.e. in Management/OB related terms (it is not a marketing or an accounting case). Try to get to underlying causes of problems, not just symptoms. Seek advice from your tutor on the layout of this information. You should link each problem identified to relevant theory and also to actual evidence from the case. Remember you MUST integrate theory and reference all non-original work. 5. Statement of Major Problems In most case studies you will identify a number of problems - too many to actually 'solve' in the number of words allowed. Hence it is crucial to make it very clear which are the major two or three problems or key issues, that must be solved first. Therefore this section is just a short concise statement of what problems you are going to solve in the remainder of the case. Half a page is adequate. Having once identified the key problems, you can continually check back to ensure that you are actually attempting to solve them and not some other minor problems you identified. This section is crucial to a good case report. 6. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions While most problems will have a very large number of possible solutions, it is your task to identify and evaluate a number of the more appropriate (at least 2-3 for each major problem identified). Each alternative solution should be briefly outlined and then evaluated in terms of its advantages and disadvantages (strong and weak points). Note: You must evaluate alternatives. It is not necessary to make a statement in this section as to which alternative is considered best - this is the next section. Do not integrate theory in this section and do not recommend theory. Practical solutions to the problems are required. 7. Recommendations This section should state which of the alternative solutions (either singly or in combination) identified in section six is recommended for implementation. You should briefly justify your choice, explaining how it will solve the major problems identified in Section 6. Integration of relevant theory is appropriate here. 8. Implementation In this section you should specifically explain how you will implement the recommended solutions. Theory cannot be implemented; you must translate it into actions. What should be done, by whom, when, in what sequence, what will it cost (rough estimates only) and other such issues. Remember if a recommended solution cannot be realistically implemented then it is no solution at all. 9. Appendices (if any) 10. Bibliography/References This will contain an alphabetical list of all the references you have cited in the body of the report. Do not include details of any sources you have not cited. Ensure the style used is correct and consistent. Some general issues: In a case study it is crucial that you integrate relevant theory from the course and evidence from the case. Failure to attempt to integrate theory will lead to severe mark reduction or failure. Referencing of all non-original material is essential. You will lose marks for poor referencing. The Faculty of Business and Economics Q Manual should be used as a guide. This is available in the library, for sale in the bookshop, and on the web. The Q Manual should also be used as a guide for correct presentation of written material. Check your completed work for internal consistency. For example make sure that you attempt to solve the key issues you have identified. Don't say X is the major problem and then recommend a solution to Y. Try not to be overly descriptive. Remember you are trying to identify, analyse, and solve the problems of the case using the relevant theories from the course - not just repeating what the text book, or case information, has said. Cindy's sample assignment Assignment topic: [1]Click to view the assignment topic Executive Summary 1. Problem Identification 1.1 Lack of Motivation 1.2 Communication Problems 1.3 Leadership Problems 1.4 Employees Lack of Interpersonal Skills 1.5 Lack of Initiative 2. Statement of Major Problems 3. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions 3.1 Motivation 3.1.1 Rewards and Recognition 3.1.2 Recognition 3.1.3 Attainable Goals 3.2 Communication Problems 3.2.1 Weekly Meetings 3.2.2 Consultation 3.2.3 Retrain Mrs. Blakely 3.2.4 Informal Communication 3.3 Leadership Problems 3.3.1 Retrain Mrs. Blakely 3.3.2 Re-delegation 4. Recommendation 4.1 Motivation 4.2 Communication 4.3 Leadership 5. Implementation 6. References Executive summary The following report is based on a case study of Lawton, Langridge, Lipton and Lawless, Solicitors. The main problems that have been identified are major problems of staff motivation, lack of communication (informal), and Mrs. Blakely's lack of leadership skills. A recommendation for the motivation problem is that Mrs. Blakely set attainable goals for the employees and reward and recognize the clerks when they have achieved their goals. For the problem of lack of communication, it has been recommended in this report that weekly meetings be held and that Mrs. Blakely be retrained both for development of communication skills and leadership skills. The reward program is expected to cost the company approximately $450.00 per month whilst the setting of attainable goals is not expected to cost the company anything. Because Mrs. Blakely will have to read 22 documents per month in order to recognize the employees appropriately, she will need to be paid extra for this work i.e. overtime pay. Assuming it will take half an hour to read one document, there will be approximately eleven hours spent on reading. It has been assumed that Mrs. Blakely earns $18.00 per hour while the clerks earn $15.00. Therefore, approximately, it will cost the firm $500.00 per week for ten weeks. The weekly meetings will be run one hour before the end of the working day, beginning at 4:00 pm. and ending at 5:00 pm. eliminating the need to pay overtime. 1. Problem identification 1.1 Lack of Motivation There is much evidence pointing towards a severe lack of motivation in the WPC department, these being the employees' constantly running late to get to work, a high error-rate through carelessness and also a high turnover rate. Mrs. Blakely views her employees from the 'theory x' perspective as defined by Douglas McGregor (Robbins et al., 1997). Mrs. Blakely assumes that her employees dislike their work and makes statements such as "there is something wrong with young people today", that her employees "slack off" and that " the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun". Although there is evidence that this kind of motivation can successfully work in some organizations, it is evident that it is not successful in the WPC department. Although the WPC department offers its employees excellent facilities such as the location, excellent furnishings and equipment which satisfy their hygiene factors, these are not a motivator (Robbins et al., 1997). There is an opportunity for growth in the work itself which is in fact, a motivator; however, the monotonous and boring nature of the work at the WPC, and the lack of achievement, recognition and responsibility means that the motivating factors are not enough to satisfy the employees. 1.2 Communication Problems It is evident that there is a lack of informal communication in the WPC as a result of Mrs. Blakely emphasizing that she does not want employees in the department to chat during working hours. Mrs. Blakely also seems unaware of why the employees are so unhappy in their position and doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer. This is because she does not consult with the staff about the problems they may be having with the organisation. Mrs. Blakely only communicates with the "girls" on a formal level; she only communicates what is expected of them. However, it is apparent that Mrs. Blakely does not provide them with feedback, neither positive nor negative, so it is not really possible for the employees to know exactly where they are going wrong and then proceed to correct their mistakes. This may be because she is afraid of offending the "girls" or dealing with their defensiveness which is a common problem for many managers (Robbins, Bergman and Stagg, 1997). 1.3 Leadership Problems Mrs. Blakely is lacking in real leadership skills and fails to consult with her staff. Rather she tells them what to do, and how, where and when to do the various tasks. In terms of Hershey and Blanchard's Situational Leadership Model, this is defined as being high task and low relationship (Robbins et al., 1997). Hershey and Blanchard also discuss the maturity level of followers. The clerks employed in the WPC department are all talented people, usually well qualified with a TAFE or year 12 certificate with good pass levels in business subjects. So it is evident that in defining the level of maturity, the staff of the WPC would be viewed as being at level M3 i.e. people whom are able, but unwilling, to do what the leader wants (Robbins et al., 1997). As a result of this mixture, there is understandably going to be resistance from both parties. This leads onto the evidence of a lack in employee empowerment leading to employee unhappiness. The employees are given orders rather than being left to their own devices: every step is outlined and is expected to be followed to the 'dot', instead of letting the girls develop their own way of 'tackling' the problem. 1.4 Employees' Lack of Interpersonal Skills Although the staff of the WPC department know how to do their jobs and at the same time make plenty of careless mistakes, this is not because they lack the technical skills that are required in that specific department. There are other underlying causes for the carelessness. However, the clerks are expected to be able to undertake secretarial roles when positions become vacant. Mrs. Blakely is always the middle person communicating between the clerks and the solicitors, and the employees complain that they have no contact with anyone else in the organisation bar the other clerks in the WPC department and Mrs. Blakely. It is therefore understandable that the clerks are going to find it difficult to deal with other people in the organisation such as the solicitors and partners of the firm. Their lack of interpersonal skills to a large extent are a result of this seclusion. 1.5 Lack of Initiative Due to the lack of empowerment of the clerks in the WPC department, the clerks have learnt to simply obey orders. By the time the clerks have the opportunity to work as a secretary for one of the partners of the firm, they find it difficult to do anything else but follow rules, rather than understand the tasks at hand, and to use their own initiative to solve the problems and tasks. The initial identification of problems only deals with five major problems. This is because the other problems such as high turnover rates and the clerks making careless mistakes are simply symptoms of much larger (or major) problems in the firm. 2. Statement of major problems Three major problems have been identified: 2.1 Lack of Motivation 2.2 Communication Problems 2.3 Leadership Problems These problems must be solved first before the other problems. The WPC department will likely find that once these problems are solved the other problems will possibly disappear. 3. Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions 3.1 Motivation 3.1.1 Rewards and Recognition A reward program which consists of monetary bonuses when each clerk produces work with less errors. As well there should be a team award if a certain number of documents by the WPC as a team, go through as correct. Advantages: The advantage of setting up a reward program would be an increase in motivation for the clerks. It gives them attainable goals, because the clerks are very capable of doing their job. It's just their lack of motivation which results in the carelessness evident in their work. Will result in job enrichment for the clerks. Clerks will be happier to work harder if they know that they will gain from such efforts. The organisation will benefit from the lower error rates, particularly the solicitors. Improved image of the law firm as a result of the release of more professional documentation from the WPC department. Disadvantages: It will cost more for the firm in terms of the monetary rewards going out to each successful employee. Takes time for the work to be assessed. For instance, Mrs. Blakely would most likely be the one reading each document in order to grant the award, and this will increase the length of time for the papers to pass through the WPC. 3.1.2 Recognition Require Mrs. Blakely to verbally recognize each clerk's efforts and good work. Advantages: easy to implement lifts staff morale doesn't cost anything improves clerks' self confidence improves quality of work as clerks will be encouraged by the recognition, and the staff will be likely to display this in an improvement in their work. Disadvantages: Mrs. Blakely may resist recognizing the employees. 3.1.3 Attainable Goals Create attainable goals. For instance, insisting on 100% accuracy in the typing up of documents may be asking for too much, instead of finding a reasonable accuracy rate that the clerks can aim for. Advantages Gives staff focus Can improve the quality of work Does not cost anything Creates teamwork Disadvantages Resistance to goals Inconsistent participation Participating employees may find it incongruous and may view it as manipulative and therefore be turned off If goals are viewed as unattainable staff may be turned off. 3.2 Communication Problems 3.2.1 Weekly Meetings Organise weekly meetings that all WPC clerks will attend as well as Mrs. Blakely, to encourage flow of information and so clerks can voice their concerns. Arthur Lawton will hold the meeting himself, acting as a mediator. Advantages Open communication Both parties can listen to each other Invites feedback Disadvantages Arthur Lawton may not have time to be in charge Mrs. Blakely may not listen Clerks may not attend or may resist attending 3.2.2 Consultation Organise one-on-one consultations with Mrs. Blakely where clerks can voice their concerns in privacy, and vice-versa. Advantages Makes Mrs. Blakely aware of the situation It is individual and one-on-one Increases feedback and creates open communication Disadvantages Time consuming (one-on-one) Mrs. Blakely may be unwilling to listen or to change. 3.2.3 Retrain Mrs. Blakely Retrain Mrs. Blakely in order to improve her interpersonal communication skills. This will allow her to find out where she has gone wrong and improve her communication skills. Advantages Improvement in communication skills. Increase in employee happiness Disadvantages Costs money Mrs. Blakely may not change 3.2.4 Informal Communication Encourage informal communication during tea breaks ie. the tearoom could be designed in a way to encourage communication. For instance, the layout could be open rather than people hiding behind walls and sitting in corners. Advantages Clerks are able to vent their need to chatter in the right environment rather than during work time. Encourages a friendly environment Disadvantages: Mrs. Blakely may resist this as an implementation. Clerks may still talk a lot during work time anyway. 3.3 Leadership Problems 3.3.1 Retrain Mrs. Blakely Retrain Mrs. Blakely, i.e. formally train Mrs. Blakely in order to improve her leadership skills. Advantages Improvement in leadership Happier employees Disadvantages Costs money Mrs. Blakely may not improve or she may resist training altogether 3.3.2 Re-delegation Re-delegation of Mrs. Blakely to another job and appointment of a new supervisor. Advantages Quicker than re-training Increase in employee satisfaction Increase in efficiency Disadvantages Whoever else is put in charge, may be just as bad Insulting to Mrs. Blakely Creates resistance to change 4.1 Motivation Provide employees with attainable goals, then recognize the clerks if they reach the goals and reward them accordingly. In terms of Herzberg's Motivation - Hygiene theory, the clerks in the WPC department have their hygiene factors satisfied (Robbins et al., 1997). The clerks have excellent working conditions; i.e. ergonomic furniture, great views of the city, excellent furnishings and a pleasant staff room. Although these hygiene factors have been satisfied, motivation factors such as achievement, recognition, the work itself and responsibility are not satisfied, and therefore according to this theory, the clerks are not motivated. Recognition is theorized by Herzberg to be a major element as a motivator, and by recognizing the employees, they will feel a sense of achievement. Goal incentives have yielded an approximate 16% increase in productivity and a reward program consisting of a monetary incentive, can dramatically improve productivity by an estimated 30% (Robbins et al., 1997). When Mrs. Blakely recognizes employees for their achievements she is sending the message out that she doesn't view them from a "Theory X" perspective, as proposed by theorist Douglas McGregor, which is a rather negative view, for instance, that the clerks dislike their work, are lazy and that they avoid responsibility and must be coerced to perform. Recognition encourages a more positive approach, "Theory Y", which assumes employees are creative when left to their own devices and seek responsibility and can exercise their own sense of direction (Robbins et al., 1997). According to Maslow's Hierarchy of Needs theory ,as one need is satisfied, ie. a "safety need", the next level of needs, for instance, "social needs," needs to be satisfied. The employees in the WPC have most of their needs satisfied up until the esteem needs. By recognizing the employees for their achievement in reaching the set goals, the organisation will in turn be satisfying their "esteem needs" (Robbins et al., 1997). Arthur Lawton assumes that by playing music he could perhaps solve the low motivational problems, and although it was initially assumed that it did in fact help the employees work, it failed after a few months. This is because as Maslow points out, once a need is substantially satisfied, it no longer motivates. The physiological needs have been more than satisfied by the conditions of the work environment and there is no complaint about the salary. The music was only an added physiological factor, and therefore no longer has a motivating impact. 4.2 Communication Organise weekly meetings as well as retrain Mrs. Blakely. The weekly meetings will ensure that the communication flow is constant. The weekly meetings will solve the problem of lack of feedback by providing an environment where there is a mediator, Arthur Lawton, Mrs. Blakely and the clerks. The set up is informal, as there is a lack of this kind of communication. The clerks and Mrs. Blakely would be able to communicate both positive and negative feedback on the performance of the parties involved. Mrs. Blakely will be retrained in terms of communication along with development of her interpersonal skills. Through training, her skills in communication would improve and she will become more aware of the needs of employees. Currently, Mrs. Blakely spends a majority of her time in networking and conducting traditional management roles and significantly less time communicating with the clerks and participating in human resource management. As Fred Luthan theorized, the best way for a manager to be an effective manager is to spend 44% of their time in communicating, 26% in human resource management, 11% of their time in networking and 19% of their time taking part in traditional management activities (Robbins et al. 1997) . Mrs. Blakely is effectively managing opposite to the way she should be in order to be effective. 4.3 Leadership Retrain Mrs. Blakely. In terms of Hershey and Blanchard's theory (Robbins et al., 1997), Mrs. Blakely is at the stage of simply telling her staff what to do. With significant training, it is hoped that Mrs. Blakely will develop the skills to sell her ideas to the clerks, or even include the clerks in decision-making processes. 5. Implementation [Please note that the assignment table cannot be displayed on this screen.] References Robbins, S.P., Bergman, R and Stagg, I. (1997), Management, (1st edn), Prentice Hall, Australia. [1] Assignment topic Case study summary Lawton, Langridge, Lypton and Lawless is a large Sydney legal firm. Among its staff are 22 data entry clerks who work in the Word Processing Centre (WPC). Their job is to process the large volume of legal documents produced by the firm's solicitors. WPC clerks are carefully selected and must have a TAFE diploma or Year 12 with good passes in business subjects. When they join the firm they receive a week of training in specialised legal documents, and extra training sessions are held regularly to ensure they keep their knowledge up-to-date. The firm occupies 10 floors of a new building in the centre of Sydney. The WPC is located on the 35th floor and has wonderful views around the city and harbour. The centre is very well equipped with excellent furnishings and a very pleasant staff room. The firm is able to attract good quality workers because it offers above average wages and many other benefits. However, all is not well. Senior staff and solicitors have complained to Arthur Lawton, the Managing Partner, that they need to check the work of WPC clerks who work as relief secretaries, because of the frequent errors made. They also believe that these workers are unreliable and lack initiative. Personnel records show that WPC staff do not stay with the firm for very long, despite the opportunities for promotion. None of the solicitors know the workers in the Centre very well, but all praise the hard work and service provided by Mrs Blakely, the WPC supervisor, who has worked with the firm for over 20 years. Indeed, they tend to see the problem as the result of something wrong "with young people today." When Mr Lawton raises the matter of the WPC's problems, Mrs Blakely reacts a little angrily. She defends her clerks, saying that despite the errors, they do complete a lot of work. She admits that many of them find the job boring, as it mostly involves keying in information. The clerks also, often come to work late, chat at every opportunity, and generally don't work too hard. To stop this, she keeps a firm eye on them but she believes she can't be too hard or they will leave the firm. Mrs Blakely then explains the WPC system. The work to be done arrives from each solicitor and is allocated to the clerks on a daily basis. To ensure they know what to do, she goes over each piece of work with them before they do the job. When information needs to be clarified, Mrs Blakely goes to the relevant solicitor herself and then passes the information on to the clerks. She collects the output when the job is finished and returns it to the solicitors. Her job however, also means she liaises with solicitors on other floors, so she is often away from the Centre. Mrs Blakely agrees that the workers do not perform very well as relief secretaries, but thinks this is because the work is more complex than they are trained to do. She says the solicitors do not help the relief secretaries enough and expect them to know everything straight away. When questioned, the WPC clerks say they like working for the firm and would like to earn promotion, but find it hard to stay interested in a job that is so repetitious and boring. Most say they get sick of seeing the same faces everyday as they are isolated on the 35th floor and have no contact with other staff, except with each other and Mrs Blakely. After trying to improve efficiency through the use of piped music - an experiment which fails - Mr Lawton turns to you, as an external management consultant, for advice. Cindy's assignment and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Executive summary 1. Problem Identification 1.1 Lack of Motivation 1.2 Communication Problems 1.3 Leadership Problems 1.4 Employees Lack of Interpersonal Skills 1.5 Lack of Initiative 2. Statement of Major Problems 3. Generation and Evaluation of Alternative Solutions 3.1 Motivation 3.1.1 Rewards and Recognition 3.1.2 Recognition 3.1.3 Attainable Goals 3.2 Communication Problems 3.2.1 Weekly Meetings 3.2.2 Consultation 3.2.3 Retrain Mrs. Blakely 3.2.4 Informal Communication 3.3 Leadership Problems 3.3.1 Retrain Mrs. Blakely 3.3.2 Re-delegation 4. Recommendation 4.1 Motivation 4.2 Communication 4.3 Leadership 5. Implementation 6. References Executive summary The following report is based on a case study of Lawton, Langridge, Lipton and Lawless, Solicitors. The main problems that have been identified are major problems of staff motivation, lack of communication (informal), and Mrs. Blakely's lack of leadership skills. A recommendation for the motivation problem is that Mrs. Blakely set attainable goals for the employees and reward and recognize the clerks when they have achieved their goals. For the problem of lack of communication, it has been recommended in this report that weekly meetings be held and that Mrs. Blakely be retrained both for development of communication skills and leadership skills. The reward program is expected to cost the company approximately $450.00 per month whilst the setting of attainable goals is not expected to cost the company anything. Because Mrs. Blakely will have to read 22 documents per month in order to recognize the employees appropriately, she will need to be paid extra for this work i.e. overtime pay. Assuming it will take half an hour to read one document, there will be approximately eleven hours spent on reading. It has been assumed that Mrs. Blakely earns $18.00 per hour while the clerks earn $15.00. Therefore, approximately, it will cost the firm $500.00 per week for ten weeks. The weekly meetings will be run one hour before the end of the working day, beginning at 4:00 pm. and ending at 5:00 pm. eliminating the need to pay overtime. 1. Problem identification 1.1 Lack of Motivation There is much evidence pointing towards a severe lack of motivation in the WPC department, these being the employees' constantly running late to get to work, a high error-rate through carelessness and also a high turnover rate. Mrs. Blakely views her employees from the 'theory x' perspective as defined by Douglas McGregor (Robbins et al., 1997). Mrs. Blakely assumes that her employees dislike their work and makes statements such as "there is something wrong with young people today", that her employees "slack off" and that " the trouble is that young people these days don't want to work, but just want to have fun". [IMG-1] [1]Although there is evidence that this kind of motivation can successfully work in some organizations, it is evident that it is not successful in the WPC department. [IMG-2] [2]Although the WPC department offers its employees excellent facilities such as the location, excellent furnishings and equipment which satisfy their hygiene factors, these are not a motivator [3](Robbins et al., 1997). There is an opportunity for growth in the work itself which is in fact, a motivator; however, the monotonous and boring nature of the work at the WPC, and the lack of achievement, [IMG-3] recognition and responsibility means that the motivating factors are not enough to satisfy the employees. 1.2 Communication Problems It is evident that there is a lack of informal communication in the WPC as a result of Mrs. Blakely emphasizing that she does not want employees in the department to chat during working hours. Mrs. Blakely also seems unaware of why the employees are so unhappy in their position and doesn't know what to do to keep them with the firm longer. This is because she does not consult with the staff about the problems they may be having with the organisation. Mrs. Blakely only communicates with the "girls" on a formal level; she only communicates what is expected of them. However, it is apparent that Mrs. Blakely does not provide them with feedback, neither positive nor negative, so it is not really possible for the employees to know exactly where they are going wrong and then proceed to correct their mistakes. This may be because she is afraid of offending the "girls" or dealing with their defensiveness which is a common problem for many managers (Robbins, Bergman and Stagg, 1997). 1.3 Leadership Problems Mrs. Blakely is lacking in real leadership skills and fails to consult with her staff. Rather she tells them what to do, and how, where and when to do the various tasks. In terms of Hershey and Blanchard's Situational Leadership Model, this is defined as being high task and low relationship (Robbins et al., 1997). [IMG-4] [4]Hershey and Blanchard also discuss the maturity level of followers. The clerks employed in the WPC department are all talented people, usually well qualified with a TAFE or year 12 certificate with good pass levels in business subjects. So it is evident that in defining the level of maturity, the staff of the WPC would be viewed as being at level M3 i.e. people whom are able, but unwilling, to do what the leader wants (Robbins et al., 1997). As a result of this mixture, there is understandably going to be resistance from both parties. This leads onto the evidence of a lack in employee empowerment leading to employee unhappiness. The employees are given orders rather than being left to their own devices: every step is outlined and is expected to be followed to the 'dot', instead of letting the girls develop their own way of 'tackling' the problem. 1.4 Employees' Lack of Interpersonal Skills [IMG-5] [5]Although the staff of the WPC department know how to do their jobs and at the same time make plenty of careless mistakes, this is not because they lack the technical skills that are required in that specific department. There are other underlying causes for the carelessness. However, the clerks are expected to be able to undertake secretarial roles when positions become vacant. Mrs. Blakely is always the middle person communicating between the clerks and the solicitors, and the employees complain that they have no contact with anyone else in the organisation bar the other clerks in the WPC department and Mrs. Blakely. It is therefore understandable that the clerks are going to find it difficult to deal with other people in the organisation such as the solicitors and partners of the firm. Their lack of interpersonal skills to a large extent are a result of this seclusion. 1.5 Lack of Initiative Due to the lack of empowerment of the clerks in the WPC department, the clerks have learnt to simply obey orders. By the time the clerks have the opportunity to work as a secretary for one of the partners of the firm, they find it difficult to do anything else but follow rules, rather than understand the tasks at hand, and to use their own initiative to solve the problems and tasks. The initial identification of problems only deals with five major problems. This is because the other problems such as high turnover rates and the clerks making careless mistakes are simply symptoms of much larger (or major) problems in the firm. 2. Statement of major problems Three major problems have been identified: 2.1 Lack of Motivation 2.2 Communication Problems 2.3 Leadership Problems These problems must be solved first before the other problems. The WPC department will likely find that once these problems are solved the other problems will possibly disappear. 3. Generation and evaluation of alternative solutions 3.1 Motivation [IMG-6] [6] 3.1.1 Rewards and Recognition A reward program which consists of monetary bonuses when each clerk produces work with less errors. As well there should be a team award if a certain number of documents by the WPC as a team, go through as correct. Advantages: The advantage of setting up a reward program would be an increase in motivation for the clerks. It gives them attainable goals, because the clerks are very capable of doing their job. It's just their lack of motivation which results in the carelessness evident in their work. Will result in job enrichment for the clerks. Clerks will be happier to work harder if they know that they will gain from such efforts. The organisation will benefit from the lower error rates, particularly the solicitors. Improved image of the law firm as a result of the release of more professional documentation from the WPC department. Disadvantages: It will cost more for the firm in terms of the monetary rewards going out to each successful employee. Takes time for the work to be assessed. For instance, Mrs. Blakely would most likely be the one reading each document in order to grant the award, and this will increase the length of time for the papers to pass through the WPC. 3.1.2 Recognition Require Mrs. Blakely to verbally recognize each clerk's efforts and good work. Advantages: easy to implement lifts staff morale doesn't cost anything improves clerks' self confidence improves quality of work as clerks will be encouraged by the recognition, and the staff will be likely to display this in an improvement in their work. Disadvantages: Mrs. Blakely may resist recognizing the employees. 3.1.3 Attainable Goals [IMG-7] [7]Create attainable goals. For instance, insisting on 100% accuracy in the typing up of documents may be asking for too much, instead of finding a reasonable accuracy rate that the clerks can aim for. Advantages Gives staff focus Can improve the quality of work Does not cost anything Creates teamwork Disadvantages Resistance to goals Inconsistent participation Participating employees may find it incongruous and may view it as manipulative and therefore be turned off If goals are viewed as unattainable staff may be turned off. 3.2 Communication Problems 3.2.1 Weekly Meetings Organise weekly meetings that all WPC clerks will attend as well as Mrs. Blakely, to encourage flow of information and so clerks can voice their concerns. Arthur Lawton will hold the meeting himself, acting as a mediator. Advantages Open communication Both parties can listen to each other Invites feedback Disadvantages Arthur Lawton may not have time to be in charge Mrs. Blakely may not listen Clerks may not attend or may resist attending 3.2.2 Consultation Organise one-on-one consultations with Mrs. Blakely where clerks can voice their concerns in privacy, and vice-versa. Advantages Makes Mrs. Blakely aware of the situation It is individual and one-on-one Increases feedback and creates open communication Disadvantages Time consuming (one-on-one) Mrs. Blakely may be unwilling to listen or to change. 3.2.3 Retrain Mrs. Blakely Retrain Mrs. Blakely in order to improve her interpersonal communication skills. This will allow her to find out where she has gone wrong and improve her communication skills. Advantages Improvement in communication skills. Increase in employee happiness Disadvantages Costs money Mrs. Blakely may not change 3.2.4 Informal Communication Encourage informal communication during tea breaks ie. the tearoom could be designed in a way to encourage communication. For instance, the layout could be open rather than people hiding behind walls and sitting in corners. Advantages Clerks are able to vent their need to chatter in the right environment rather than during work time. Encourages a friendly environment Disadvantages: Mrs. Blakely may resist this as an implementation. Clerks may still talk a lot during work time anyway. 3.3 Leadership Problems 3.3.1 Retrain Mrs. Blakely Retrain Mrs. Blakely, i.e. formally train Mrs. Blakely in order to improve her leadership skills. Advantages Improvement in leadership Happier employees Disadvantages Costs money Mrs. Blakely may not improve or she may resist training altogether 3.3.2 Re-delegation Re-delegation of Mrs. Blakely to another job and appointment of a new supervisor. Advantages Quicker than re-training Increase in employee satisfaction Increase in efficiency Disadvantages Whoever else is put in charge, may be just as bad Insulting to Mrs. Blakely Creates resistance to change [IMG-8] [8] 4.1 Motivation Provide employees with attainable goals, then recognize the clerks if they reach the goals and reward them accordingly. In terms of Herzberg's Motivation - Hygiene theory, the clerks in the WPC department have their hygiene factors satisfied (Robbins et al., 1997). The clerks have excellent working conditions; i.e. ergonomic furniture, great views of the city, excellent furnishings and a pleasant staff room. Although these hygiene factors have been satisfied, motivation factors such as achievement, recognition, the work itself and responsibility are not satisfied, and therefore according to this theory, the clerks are not motivated. Recognition is theorized by Herzberg to be a major element as a motivator, and by recognizing the employees, they will feel a sense of achievement. Goal incentives have yielded an approximate 16% increase in productivity and a reward program consisting of a monetary incentive, can dramatically improve productivity by an estimated 30% (Robbins et al., 1997). When Mrs. Blakely recognizes employees for their achievements she is sending the message out that she doesn't view them from a "Theory X" perspective, as proposed by theorist Douglas McGregor, which is a rather negative view, for instance, that the clerks dislike their work, are lazy and that they avoid responsibility and must be coerced to perform. Recognition encourages a more positive approach, "Theory Y", which assumes employees are creative when left to their own devices and seek responsibility and can exercise their own sense of direction (Robbins et al., 1997). [IMG-9] [9]According to Maslow's Hierarchy of Needs theory, as one need is satisfied, ie. a "safety need", the next level of needs, for instance, "social needs," needs to be satisfied. The employees in the WPC have most of their needs satisfied up until the esteem needs. By recognizing the employees for their achievement in reaching the set goals, the organisation will in turn be satisfying their "esteem needs" (Robbins et al., 1997). Arthur Lawton assumes that by playing music he could perhaps solve the low motivational problems, and although it was initially assumed that it did in fact help the employees work, it failed after a few months. This is because as Maslow points out, once a need is substantially satisfied, it no longer motivates. The physiological needs have been more than satisfied by the conditions of the work environment and there is no complaint about the salary. The music was only an added physiological factor, and therefore no longer has a motivating impact. 4.2 Communication Organise weekly meetings as well as retrain Mrs. Blakely. The weekly meetings will ensure that the communication flow is constant. The weekly meetings will solve the problem of lack of feedback by providing an environment where there is a mediator, Arthur Lawton, Mrs. Blakely and the clerks. The set up is informal, as there is a lack of this kind of communication. The clerks and Mrs. Blakely would be able to communicate both positive and negative feedback on the performance of the parties involved. Mrs. Blakely will be retrained in terms of communication along with development of her interpersonal skills. Through training, her skills in communication would improve and she will become more aware of the needs of employees. Currently, Mrs. Blakely spends a majority of her time in networking and conducting traditional management roles and significantly less time communicating with the clerks and participating in human resource management. As Fred Luthan theorized, the best way for a manager to be an effective manager is to spend 44% of their time in communicating, 26% in human resource management, 11% of their time in networking and 19% of their time taking part in traditional management activities (Robbins et al. 1997) . Mrs. Blakely is effectively managing opposite to the way she should be in order to be effective. 4.3 Leadership Retrain Mrs. Blakely. [IMG-10] [10]In terms of Hershey and Blanchard's theory (Robbins et al., 1997), Mrs. Blakely is at the stage of simply telling her staff what to do. With significant training, it is hoped that Mrs. Blakely will develop the skills to sell her ideas to the clerks, or even include the clerks in decision-making processes. 5. Implementation [Please note that the assignment table cannot be displayed on this screen.] [IMG-11] [11] References Robbins, S.P., Bergman, R. & Stagg, I. (1997). Management (1st ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. [1] Reference missing The student's sentence contains a paraphrase of information coming from another writer. Therefore, a reference is needed. Although the student has used her own words instead of quoting, the same referencing rule applies to both situations. [2] Discuss theory The information here is important. The student needs to introduce and discuss the origin of these concepts (e.g. Herzberg's Motivation-Hygiene Theory; positive/negative feedback, empowerment, etc.). Don't forget to provide a correct reference when referring to a source reported in a second source (See next comment). [3] Referencing problems The concept of motivators comes from Herzberg, although Robbins et al. is the source. When referring to a source quoted in a second source, reference as follows: ... (Herzberg, cited in Robbins et al., 1997.) [4] Good use of theory The student has followed through from the theory provided earlier from Hershey and Blanchard and applied it to the situation in the WPC. This is precisely what is meant "by applying and interpreting the literature". [5] Symptoms not major problems! The student has not provided any theory here or direct links to the management problem areas. Both these sections, 1.4 (Lack of interpersonal skills) and 1.5 (Lack of initiative), describe symptoms of poor communication and poor motivation. They should be discussed under those headings. Apart from these two sections, the overall section contains some good ideas. However, it is very brief considering that the Problem Identification section is worth 25% of the total assignment marks. [6] Very thorough! Alternative solutions have been well defined here. The advantages and disadvantages are clearly set out, are specific to the situation, and are presented objectively. [7] Rewrite more concisely Some of the solutions presented in this section could be expressed in a shorter, more concise way. For example, 3.1.3 could be written as follows: 3.1.3 Set Attainable Goals Create attainable goals which encourage a reasonable level of typing accuracy. Refer to Topic 2: 'Generate Solutions' in the Skills for Writing in Management section of the module. [8] Reference missing Even though Maslow's name is mentioned, the student still needs to include a date after this writer's name in the reference, i.e. Maslow (1954, cited in Robbins et al., 1997). Note that this information will tell the reader that Maslow's theory predates the source given. [9] Good use of theory The student pinpoints the precise element of the theory which is relevant to this part of the case study. [10] Too brief Just because the student has nearly finished does not mean she should skimp on the information needed, as this can lose marks overall. A much better impression would be made if she dealt with each point at the same length she has treated similar points. [11] Inadequate references Referring to just the main textbook is not sufficient. The student needs to show that she has consulted several different sources. This is a critical part of the research and writing task at university. Marketing assignment This tutorial contains information about writing based on materials from the first-year subjects Marketing Theory and Practice, Introduction to Marketing, and Tourism Marketing. You will also find much of the information to be useful for your other Marketing subjects. Navigate through the tutorial using the Table of Contents on the left. The tutorial's three main sections are outlined below. Lecturer's advice <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/1.xml> Get information from the lecturer about what is required for Marketing assignments. Skills for writing in Marketing <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/2.xml> Learn to write better assignments through interactive tasks. Annotated assignments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.xml> View samples of student work with lecturer and student comments. Lecturer's advice In this section, one of your lecturers - Ian Walker - answers Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) about researching and writing of reports in first-year Marketing. FAQs: Click on those topic areas that are of interest to you, or that you need to know more about. 1. What should I be aiming at in a first-year Marketing report? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq1> 2. How are Marketing assignments evaluated? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq2> 3. What are the main difficulties first-year students have with writing Marketing assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq3> 4. How much reading should I do? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq4> 5. Is the approach to writing different from VCE? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq5> 6. How can I be "original" in Marketing assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq6> 7. What is "critical thinking" in first-year Marketing? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq7> 8. What can I use as "evidence" in Marketing? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq8> 9. How should I be using the theory in my assignment? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq9> 10. What's a good overall approach to researching and writing marketing assignments? <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faq10> 1. What should I be aiming at in a first-year Marketing report? Summary: Using theory to understand practice Researching carefully Presenting clearly Students should aim to start thinking about the marketing theory they have been learning and to begin using that marketing perspective to better understand specific industries/organisations that are operating in the marketplace. These can be profit-oriented organisations, nonprofit, large, small, local, or international. Students should gain a recognition of the role marketing can and does fulfil, and also see that there is a wide range of information available from a range of sources that can be used by organisations for analysis. In writing the report students should understand the need for a concise, clear, well-argued, and well-presented document that identifies the main issues which, in the real world, can be used by management to make decisions. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 2. How are Marketing assignments evaluated? Summary: Markers look at the quality of your understanding research analysis presentation A good assignment should demonstrate an understanding of the terminology and how the various forces/influences impact an industry and an organisation. In a good assignment, the student identifies and analyses the main issues asked for in the question. These issues are well-presented and concise; they are appropriately referenced, and the information is supported by the referenced sources of information used. Finally, the analysis is supported by the data and material is presented as a business report not an essay. The unit outline provides a detailed list of expectations and information that is expected at each grade level and what differentiates each grade. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 3. What are the main difficulties first-year students have with writing Marketing assignments? Summary: Students may not realise what they themselves need to do to find out what's required Not knowing where to start: starting the assignment too late and therefore rushing to finish it on time Not reading the instructions in the unit outline detailing what is required in the assignment Not asking questions of their tutor/lecturer about the assignment Not realising that a business report is quite different from much of what they've previously done, especially in secondary school Not understanding how to reference information used or the importance of that referencing from an academic perspective Presenting a view they may have of something, rather than a logical, well-developed argument based on analysis of the information Not understanding the function of the executive summary section: i.e. it is not an introduction but a summary of the main points and findings/recommendations of the report Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 4. How much reading should I do? Summary: Relevant parts of the text book, plus relevant items in reports, magazines, and media The basic reading required is the text which provides the initial perspective for this assignment. The next sources of information are current reports (both print-based and electronic) available through the library that provide much of the information about different industries and the macroenvironment (IBIS reports, statistical information, economic analysis, and forecasts). Additional information is often found in business magazines and the business press. The amount of reading does not have to be excessive. Relevance is important, as not all macroenvironmental factors are equally important or relevant to all industries/organisations. Students should be guided in their selection of reference material by 1) recommendations on the unit web site, 2) suggestions found in the unit guide, and 3) specific recommendations from the lecturer/tutor and librarians. Though they'll actually read more than this, students who do well commonly have 8+ sources in their reference lists. If students can't find much material on their second product or the marketing mix of the companies, they can seek advice from their tutor and/or lecturer. In most cases information is available or it can be sourced for most industries/organisations. At this introductory stage we are not expecting students to be finding "weaknesses" as such in theories/readings. It's good if they can check out the relevance of the theory to a particular industry/organisation and see how using that theory might have an impact on its operations. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 5. Is the approach to writing different from VCE? Summary: A business report has a specific structure, its content is research-based, and it uses specialised language The business report is less likely to have been used in VCE so students are unlikely to be familiar with its format. A business report is concise but with sufficient detail to allow those reading it (management) to use it to make decisions. It should also have data and information that support the conclusions/recommendations of the report. This is not so much a report based on opinions but on the evidence and information collected by students during their research. Students need to develop analysis skills and become familiar with the sort of analysis seen in the business press and business publications. A good starting point is to read the business section of newspaper such as The Age, The Australian, or their equivalent in other countries ( The South China Morning Post, The Straits Times, etc.). Also read business magazines such as the Business Review Weekly (local Australia) or its equivalent in other countries ( Far Eastern Economic Review, Asian Retailer, etc). Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 6. How can I be "original" in Marketing assignments? Summary: Students can be original in their perspective, their choice and use of sources, their insight into circumstances This is a difficult one as originality may be many things, such as: the perspective that the student provides through their analysis of the information they collect their use of references that may add to their understanding the insight and interpretation of the circumstances facing an industry or organisation they provide Originality must always be supported by the data and information and not just thrown in because it sounds good. Creative examples include such things as: presenting the information in graphs and/or diagrams that clearly show the main point of that data, and using a clear explanation of the graph/diagram identifying an emerging - less obvious - issue that may/will impact the industry/organisation providing insight/understanding about the forces and influences that impact organisations and industries Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 7. What is "critical thinking" in first-year Marketing? Summary: Thinking about who is putting forward the information, identifying what's important, thinking of future implications Not accepting anything at face value. Asking questions. Challenging information, its reliability and relevance. For example when analysing the information researched, being able to identify the more appropriate and important influences that relate to their industry/organisation. Making judgements based on the data that can lead to a particular strategy or direction for an organisation. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 8. What can I use as "evidence" in Marketing? Summary: Statistics, company data, information about economic and demographic trends There is a variety of things students can use for evidence. Reference information from reliable sources such as the ABS (Australian Bureau of Statistics) data about economic or demographic trends. IBIS database (available through the library) trends and information. Whilst newspapers and magazines are less reliable, they can provide information about industries, economic and demographic trends, and influences, etc. that can support generalisations. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 9. How should I be using the theory in my assignment? Summary: The theory provides the framework and the definitions The theory provides the framework from which to look at and understand the assignment question and to provide a perspective for examining the research data. The text provides the basic theory about marketing and the terms used such as an explanation of the marketing environment and specifically the macroenvironment. Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> 10. What's a good overall approach to researching and writing Marketing assignments? Begin your research EARLY; don't leave it until the last minute. Ask questions of your lecturer/tutor. Try to relate some of the marketing theory to yourself (this helps provide some insight, understanding and relevance). Back to top <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#faqs> Skills for writing in Marketing In this section, you have a chance to practise skills to help you with your report writing for Marketing. The materials cover three broad topics and include a range of practice tasks. Some of these tasks introduce advice and comments from Helen, Amanda, Briohny, and Troy, the four students whose assignments you'll find under Annotated Assignments. Select those topics you'd like to work on. Topics: Research <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/2.1.xml> From researching to writing Structure <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/2.2.xml> Structuring the report Using sources <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/2.3.xml> - Using sources in your writing Research In order to move quickly into the research for the major assignment, you need to think very practically about: the topic area (product/target market) you want to investigate the two companies you want to investigate Talk to other students, ask your tutor and make use of tutorials. How to decide on a topic? Get real As soon as you get the assignment, mentally evaluate which topics are most viable. To make sure it was possible to get info on the coffee market, I searched for the topic on Dow Jones interactive database. Plenty of articles (200+) were found. If there were not enough, I would have changed my topic. Once you have found there are enough resources, you know you'll be OK. Don't download them all though. Get a life I thought I'd focus on the Consumer Services area, specifically the fast-food industry - I'm more interested in services and also I work at McDonald's. I would be able to relate the macroenvironmental forces to this, making it easier for me as I could picture examples. Trying to relate life to work and vice versa is always good. It makes you more motivated for both. Get lucky Choosing the topic market was one of the hardest parts. If you made a bad decision, it would have made things very tricky. If you start early enough, you can change your mind if need be. You can also email/call on your tutor to check it with him/her. Making the best use of class discussion The class discussion clarifies the purpose of the assignment Ask as many questions as possible. Don't worry about sounding "dumb". Ask any question you can think of, no matter how silly it may sound. The tutor would make a point of saying that some things were important for the assignment. Immediately I would make a note at the top of the page for late reference. But by Week 9, because I hadn't yet chosen an industry, I was at a little disadvantage: I couldn't ask topicspecific questions and get some input from the tutor. What is research? Is it: 1. 2. 3. 4. Looking up sources of information? Looking up sources of information to see which are most relevant? Looking up sources of information to see which are most relevant and skim-reading them? Looking up sources of information to see which are most relevant, skim-reading them, then identifying the most important points for your assignment? The first three are information gathering and are thus an important component of research. "Research" covers the whole process spelled out in number 4. Note that identifying the most important points can involve: just highlighting some notetaking a rough plan What does research for first-year marketing involve? Marketing may be the first subject where you get your first real experience of what it's like to do university research. Researching is an art which requires practice. Don't be disheartened if your mark is not as high as you'd hoped. It's a learning experience - don't leave yourself too little time to learn. I quickly skimmed content of articles and found those most appropriate to the two areas to be discussed - macroenvironment and coffee market; and marketing mix of two companies. A very tedious task! But necessary. I read through my final chosen articles (about 15) and highlighted segments of particular interest. I found an industry report on the IBIS World database. It was 50+ pages so I used the computer to search for the word "coffee" to direct me to the important areas. Amanda describes her searching as "tedious" and, yes, it is routine. Notice that, at each point in the process, she's exercising her judgement, making decisions, working out strategic short cuts. The more you research and the more you read the better understanding you get You do need to be realistic about what you will need - and use - for a 3,000 word report. It's expected that you'll cite around five sources minimum of whatever kind for your assignment. Finding time Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. In a survey of first-year Marketing students after completing Assignment 2, 65% said they should have started work on it sooner. As you'll find out, one of the first skills for writing a good Marketing report is figuring out how much time you'll need to complete each task and subtask. How long do you think it would take you to research the major assignment? Examine the following time chart showing how three students spent their time in the four weeks before the assignment was due. How effectively do you think each one has used their time? Amanda Week 8 Looked up product on Dow Jones database and skimmed articles found Briohny ...waited... Troy ...waited... Drafted Part 1 Week 9 Borrowed books from Library Visited supermarket and looked on product web site for Part 2. Quickly looked on internet ...waited... Drafted Part 2 Read books and searched internet further Week 10 Reworked report (four drafts in total) Waited a day, then finalised it SUBMITTED Wrote plan, and one third of report ...waited... Week 11 Report due Looked up books in library Looked on internet for organisations Did two thirds of report on PC ...waited... Did final third and proofread SUBMITTED Did plan and Part 1 on PC Did Part B Reread research and instructions Proofread SUBMITTED [1] Feedback [1] While the three students used their time rather differently there seem to be four things they did in common: Activities A. Looking up the product/organisation On database(s) On www On library catalogue On site 1 B. Reading Hard copy 2 On screen C. Writing Plan Two of the three students wrote a plan Both wrote plan and Part 1 simultaneously D. Drafting/writing report Students took 1-3 weeks to complete report Only one student produced a number of separate drafts 3 1. 2. 3. Looking up a product in the supermarket For this assignment, the three students did more highlighting text than notetaking (note that this is not the best method for every assignment) This student - who started drafting earliest and spent most time on the drafting - received the highest mark So, while the activities (A-D) were common, and some of the methods were standard, there were still some variations in approach. The student who started first did the best. In first year for most subjects you need to do more research than you did in Year 12. This takes more time than you might expect. There's no teacher at your side saying "You should have finished looking up books and articles by the end of this week!!" Locating sources So many sources. So little time. What to do? Which sources would be appropriate to use for this assignment? Tick the appropriate boxes. Books Encyclopedia articles Journal articles Magazine articles Newspaper articles Press releases Product web sites Product sites (e.g. supermarkets, department stores) Product labels Advertisements Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. [1] Check your answer How would you go about locating these sources? [2] Check your answer [1] Appropriate sources are: Part 1 books journal articles, magazine articles, newspaper articles (many available electronically) industry reports (many available electronically) product web sites product sites (e.g. supermarkets, department stores) Part 2 Books journal articles, magazine articles, newspaper articles (many available electronically) industry reports (many available electronically) product web sites product sites (e.g. supermarkets, department stores) product labels media advertisements: hoardings (posters), TV, radio, magazines [2] Appropriate locations are: Monash Library's Voyager Catalogue IBIS World database ABI Inform database Dow Jones interactive Internet sites Product outlets/retailers TV, radio Once you start looking, you find information all over the place: on the side of trams, at railway stations, talking to people. I visited the supermarket to choose my two coffee companies. There were many more resources I could have used - like the CDs - but time was not permitting. It's easy to leave things to the last minute now there's no required draft, and noone is checking up on you. Probably the best resource to help you identify what you need to do for your research is the Monash Virtual Librarian site and the Marketing Subject Guide. This covers: Before you start Books Using databases Journals Internet Other useful information Research is something I always tend to underestimate, and find myself running out of time. Either that or all the good stuff has already been taken. Memo to self: must go in at least four weeks early when fewer people are thinking about the assignment; that way all the books should be there. What happens then is that you need more time to integrate all the different info: I used a lot of subheadings in my planning for the different aspects of the marketing mix to organise my information. That way I would not neglect any area that had to be dealt with. Structure Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Some guidelines for structuring the [1]major assignment. Executive Summary Outline the major sections of the report, saying what your main findings were. Table of Contents Introduction Choose industry - DEFINE IT. Briefly outline purpose, scope (what you're going to cover), and any background needed to understand the industry. Part 1 Macro forces - what are they, how does each one affect your topic area? Name them all; don't leave any out. As you examine each one, add in more detail for most important ones. Include positive and negative impacts, actual or possible effects (short-term, long-term). Sum up. Part 2 Marketing mix - define. Choose two companies, discuss differences. Company 1: how positioned in the market, primary target markets; marketing mix (4/7Ps). Company 2: how positioned in the market, primary target markets; marketing mix (4/7Ps). Comparison Sum up the major points of comparison between the two companies. Where are they similar, where different? Conclusion Briefly overview the industry, highlighting most significant elements of macro forces discussion for Part 1, and then assess the position of the two companies, comparing marketing mix and other important differences for Part 2. Reference List List only those references you cite in the report. Be sure you use informative headings to guide your reader throughout the report. Drafting Most students do their first draft straight on to the computer. One student, Briohny, feels more comfortable writing first, then word-processing later: Hand writing helps me think more clearly in the early stages of planning and writing an assignment. I can write more quickly than I can type. I can carry my paper around and jot things down as I think of them. How do you prefer to work? How might this impact on your effectiveness? I keep my references handy so I can keep reminding myself, for example, what "macro forces" are as I write. I do further research during the writing process - that was because I found areas that needed further investigation. >Before printing it off, I quickly checked through the assignment to check for any mistakes. I don't like doing this and usually don't do it in great detail which is one of my faults - I'd rather not see the problem than have to fix it. This is another reason why I should start my assignments early - so I have an extra day to go through and perfect them. [1] Assignment 2 Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. Method of structuring Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. There is a limited number of ways you can structure a report. For Part 2 of the Marketing report, there are at least two ways you can think about structuring it: Method 1 Company A Target Market Market Positioning Marketing Mix (application of marketing mix to the target market) Company B Target Market Market Positioning Marketing Mix (application of marketing mix to the target market) Comparison Conclusion Method 2 Target Market - Company A, Company B Market Positioning - Company A, Company B Marketing Mix - Company A, Company B Product - Company A, Company B Price - Company A, Company B Promotion - Company A, Company B Place - Company A, Company B People - Company A, Company B Process - Company A, Company B Physical Evidence - Company A, Company B Conclusion What might be the advantages and disadvantages of each? [1] Check your answer [1] With Method 1, you give yourself a very clear-cut approach: you can see how much you're writing on each and you can, to a certain extent, imply comparison throughout the Company B section. You do need to be careful to write a fairly thorough and explicit Comparison section before your conclusion, though. With Method 2, you run the risk of getting yourself a little confused trying to coordinate your information for the two companies throughout. If it's well done, this can still be a good approach. You won't necessarily need a Comparison section, because you have been comparing all the way through. Writing the introduction Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. The introduction and the conclusion are key elements in the structure of your report. They are the bookends that stop the bits in the middle collapsing, if you like. There are some important things you need to do in the introduction: You need to define what you are going to talk about. Otherwise your marker can't tell if you've talked about it meaningfully or not. You need to show your marker what you are trying to do with your topic - your direction. You need to show your marker what you are going to cover (and what you're not, if need be). You need to give your marker background information necessary to their understanding. The following sample introduction has both strengths and weaknesses. Read it and see where you think the strengths and weaknesses lie. Introduction 1 1.1 Purpose The purpose of this report is to identify how Westpac Banking Corporation and ANZ Banking Group use the marketing mix to attract their specific target market. 1.2 Background Over the past 20 years, the banking industry in Australia has experienced significant pressures from a number of areas that have changed "and continue to change the landscape of the banking industry" (Ibis Report). The de-regulation of the financial system in the1980s has arguably had the greatest impact on the banking industry; however, the ever-increasing influence of technology also cannot be over-stated. The four major banks collectively control 73% of industry assets (Ibis World). The market segments comprise individual clients (53%) and the commercial sector (35%), with governments and financial intermediaries having a lesser influence (Ibis Report) [1] Feedback Do the same with this sample introduction. Introduction 2 Pre-mixed drinks were introduced in response to the demand of a segment in the alcoholic beverage market, especially by the younger age group who did not like the taste of stronger alcoholic drinks. In general, the pre-mixed alcoholic beverage industry includes wine coolers and spirit-based products. For a while they were also called the "alcopops" which were also tagged "New Age drinks" (Simpson, 2000, p.16). For the purposes of this assignment, the focus will be on the pre-mixed alcoholic beverage industry in Australia, concentrating on one of the older products, and one of the newest, Bacardi Breezers, with regard to differing marketing mixes. [2] Feedback [1] Introduction 1 1.1 Purpose The purpose of this report is to identify how Westpac Banking Corporation and ANZ Banking Group use the marketing mix to attract their specific target market. 1.2 Background Over the past 20 years, the banking industry in Australia has experienced significant pressures from a number of areas that have changed "and continue to change the landscape of the banking industry" (Ibis Report). The de-regulation of the financial system in the1980s has arguably had the greatest impact on the banking industry; however, the ever-increasing influence of technology also cannot be over-stated. The four major banks collectively control 73% of industry assets (Ibis World). The market segments comprise individual clients (53%) and the commercial sector (35%), with governments and financial intermediaries having a lesser influence (Ibis Report) [2] A definition of the banking industry would have been useful. It is helpful to outline the overall purpose of your report. As above, while it is useful to have background - and the background here is good - you do not have to use numbered sections unless you want to. The student has clearly done useful research. It would also help the reader to have the scope of the report spelled out in the introduction. The three references to Ibis World should have been more specific Introduction 2 Pre-mixed drinks were introduced in response to the demand of a segment in the alcoholic beverage market, especially by the younger age group who did not like the taste of stronger alcoholic drinks. In general, the pre-mixed alcoholic beverage industry includes wine coolers and spirit-based products. For a while they were also called the "alcopops" which were also tagged "New Age drinks" (Simpson, 2000, p.16). This introduction jumps too quickly into the background: you need to orient your reader to the nature of the report and its focus at the outset. Defining the industry would be useful. Good use of reference here - gives added understanding of the industry. For the purposes of this assignment, the focus will be on the premixed alcoholic beverage industry in Australia, concentrating on Very clear presentation of the scope. one of the older products, and one of the newest, Bacardi Breezers, with regard to differing marketing mixes. Writing the conclusion Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. When you finish writing, leave yourself time to stand back from your report so you can get some perspective on it. Read the whole thing through again, making notes before you start the conclusion. There are some important things you need to do in the conclusion: You need to link it to the rest of your report. You need to highlight the significant elements from your report (from both parts). You need to draw out the main points you want to make about the topic - and make them at a general level. You need to avoid introducing new material. Read the following sample conclusion. Note how it is organised and see where you think the strengths and weaknesses lie. Conclusion 1 It can be seen then that differences do exist between Coca-Cola and Pepsi Cola. This can be seen in the marketing variables which are the basis for segmentation such as age and geographic variables. In a competitive market, both companies must identify and target different market segments in order to remain at the cutting edge. Differences between the companies are evident with respect to product, pricing, place and promotion. Coca-cola relies heavily on value: quality is more than something we see or taste. (http://www.coca-cola.com). Pepsi, on the other hand, relies on its success resulting from superior products and high standards of performance (http://www.pepsico.com). [1] Feedback Now do the same with this conclusion. Conclusion 2 Organisations in our era are extremely sensitive - as they must be - to demographic, political, technological and economic developments. Environmental changes most affect strategic perspective. With respect to the marketing mix, quality in the biscuit industry is a key factor. For example, Arnott's uses its Sunshine brand to compete at the budget end of the market, but promotes its own brand on the basis of quality at the upper end. Competition with non-biscuit products such a snack food and confectionery is partly on the basis of packaging. Even though the two companies have different specialities, the price, distribution and promotion are very similar. It can be seen that Arnott's have a stronger market share than Nabisco due to stronger promotion, more variety of products and brand loyalty. An effective marketing program brings together all of the elements of the marketing mix to achieve the organisation's marketing objectives by delivering to customers what they want and need. Thus, the most successful companies will be those that can meet these needs most effectively [2] Feedback [1] Conclusion 1 Good - refers back to the comparison. It can be seen then that differences do exist between Coca-Cola and Pepsi Cola. This can be seen in the marketing variables which are the basis for segmentation such as age and geographic variables. In a competitive market, both companies must identify and target different market segments in order to remain at the cutting edge. Differences between the companies are evident with respect to product, pricing, place and promotion. Coca-cola relies heavily on value: quality is more than something we see or taste. (http://www.coca-cola.com). Pepsi, on the other hand, relies on its success resulting from superior products and high standards of performance (http://www.pepsico.com). Needs more explicit focus on most significant macro forces from Part 1 Sums up main points. Highlights significant features from Part 2. This section is sounding too much like a promo from the sites. [2] Conclusion 2 Good attempt to raise the significant elements from Part 1. Organisations in our era are extremely sensitive - as they must be - to demographic, political, technological and economic developments. Environmental changes most affect strategic perspective. With respect to the marketing mix, quality in the biscuit industry is a key factor. For example, Arnott's uses its Sunshine brand to compete at the budget end of the market, but promotes its own brand on the basis of quality at the upper end. Competition with non-biscuit products such a snack food and confectionery is partly on the basis of packaging. Even though the two companies have different specialities, the price, distribution and promotion are very similar. It can be seen that Arnott's have a stronger market share than Nabisco due to stronger promotion, more variety of products and brand loyalty. This is a little too specific for a conclusion: the student needs to focus on drawing out main points at a general level. Some of this could have been positioned earlier in the report rather than in the conclusion. Good here - gets back on the track of the significant similarities and differences. An effective marketing program brings together all of the elements of the Good general level of marketing mix to achieve the organisation's marketing objectives by discussion here, though could delivering to customers what they want and need. Thus, the most successful be referring to the industry. companies will be those that can meet these needs most effectively Using sources "Originality is the art of concealing your sources." Malcolm McLaren, philosopher and manager of the Sex Pistols It is likely that your university lecturer will not agree with Malcolm McLaren. One of the main difficulties identified by first-year Marketing students is how to integrate source material without running the danger of plagiarising. At school, the main sources you consulted were textbooks. At university, it is important to consult a range of sources, and so you will be faced with an array of different text types. As a Marketing student, you are expected to: research your topic come to an opinion or view about the topic area use marketing theory to frame your response Thus, you are not simply putting forward a lot of information about your topic. You are producing your own original piece of research with your own interpretation. How to do this? To start with, it's important to realise that much of the material you read for the marketing report is often not the best model for how you are expected to write as a Marketing student. Why? Let's begin by considering how textbooks and other sources actually function. Textbooks are works written especially for students, and thus they attempt to present a body of knowledge in a coherent form for general consumption. But you are not expected to write as if you were writing a Marketing textbook. Some other sources you can read and model your writing on include the following: works of original scholarly research, presenting knowledge that other researchers can build upon other types of texts which disseminate or pass on information. Types of sources Which of the following are about research ("knowledge generating") and which are about passing on information? Type Answer journal articles magazine articles newspaper articles industry reports product web sites Magazines and academic journals Magazine and academic journal articles have some very different features. If you want to model your writing on the style of academic journals, you should study the features of research writing so you can begin to use them in your own writing. Read the following extracts and try to decide which are from a magazine and which come from an academic journal. How can you tell? What differences are there between them? (You may come across some unfamiliar expressions in these passages. Just make a guess at the general meaning and keep on reading, as you would for any academic research.) The first example is done for you: Example extract The Hispanic Consumer Panel had its origins about five years ago. "We saw a need to understand what Hispanics were purchasing", Greenberg says. "There was nothing really available that fully captured Hispanic purchasing behaviour. Some services just included acculturated Hispanics, others were not capturing urban consumers and, in many cases, the information was not continuous, so you couldn't compare households from one year to another." Your answer: Journal Magazine Magazine The writer does not source the information. The opinion quoted is presented in direct speech and we have no way of checking up if that person said what he is reported to have said. Let's see what the passage might have been like if it appeared in an academic journal: The Hispanic Consumer Panel had its origins about five years ago (Greenberg 1998). It was conceived with the intention of exploring Hispanics' purchasing behaviour, as there was a dearth of research on the topic. There were problems with the research which had previously been conducted: much of it had been limited to acculturated Hispanics; or did not capture urban consumers; or did not lend itself to longitudinal studies (Greenberg, 1998, p. 10). Now complete the remaining task questions. Extract 1 Strack (1992) argues that people may engage in a judgement correction process subsequent to forming their initial judgement about a product. This correction process may occur when people perceive that potentially biasing influences may have affected their initial judgements (Martin and Achee 1992). Your answer: Journal Magazine Extract 2 E-commerce is creating some unlikely bedfellows in South Korea. The country's chaebols, or family-run business groups, are going on-line, but they are hamstrung in the rapidly morphing market by their lack of flexibility. Meanwhile many of the nation's dotcoms are going broke as the money bubble bursts. The result? A blossoming of alliances between the two that could signal a fundamental change to the chaebols' monopolistic ways. Your answer: Journal Magazine Extract 3 In the drug business, marketing is now as important as science. Most people in the pharmaceutical industry firmly believe that successful drugs are the result of breakthrough science. Drug companies have notoriously high R and D budgets, and the output of their new product development tends to be prolific. The Swiss drug giant, Novartis, for example, has 166 projects under development. Indeed, a large proportion of the recent M and A activity in pharmaceuticals has been driven by a desire to expand the R and D pipeline. R and D = research and development Your answer: Journal Magazine Extract 4 Every day, U.S. consumers are exposed to no less than 1000 commercial messages (Kotler 1997). Regardless of their content and the techniques they employ, most messages share a common final goal: persuading target consumers to adopt a particular product, service or idea. Your answer: Journal Magazine Extract 5 Figure 1 summarises the key issues in addressing information assymetry about product quality, which occurs for "experience products" (Nelson 1974), that is, products whose quality can be evaluated only after purchase. Quality-sensitive buyers are unsure about the true quality of the seller's product. Note: Information assymetry occurs where the parties have differing amounts of information regarding the transaction. Your answer: Journal Magazine First-year standards Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Although the assignments had deadlines, they're still a lot broader than for Year 12 and so you need to make the effort to clarify things with the tutor, lecturer, or past students. There are a lot more resources and materials to get lost in - that's why research needs to be started a lot earlier. You will find the better models for the kind of writing you need to produce as a student in the academic journals such as the Journal of Marketing, the Journal of Marketing Research, the Journal of Consumer Research. In first year, you read text books (such as Kotler) and a range of other information sources. Only a few of these are likely to be research journals, so you need to read these carefully. Pay attention to the style of academic journals so that your own academic writing style can develop. When you are in the workforce, your writing styles will need to change again. By that stage, the kind of writing that is appropriate in that context may be much more like that of the industry reports and trade magazines you use frequently now! So all your academic and professional writing is interlinked throughout your life. But it is important to be very aware of which kind of writing is appropriate when. Consider the following excerpts from three satisfactory Year 12 Business Management reports. Because the subject is Business Management and thus is similar in that it is also a business report, you might think at first that the same kind of writing is acceptable in first-year Marketing, but it is not. In what ways do you think these Year 12 reports might not be satisfactory for first-year Marketing? Excerpt 1 My personal objectives were to understand how an organisation responds to pressures for policy change and see how the company's Training and Development policy could succeed in addressing those areas in need of improvement. The information required will involve an examination of the previous Training and Development policy, including the pressures faced by management in regard to change, and a detailed account of the policy response to the pressures. An assessment of the comprehensiveness of the company's policy response, and its effect on structures and activities must be addressed. I will also need to establish appropriate criteria for evaluating the policy response, as well as provide an assessment of the policy with regard to these criteria. Finally, an explanation of the organisation's likely management response to Training and Development in the future will be provided. [1] Feedback Excerpt 2 Arnott's Ltd. is the organisation from which a policy response was gained. Arnott's is the largest biscuit manufacturer in Australia, as well as the 7th largest in the world. Every year, Arnott's turns over 26,000 tonnes of biscuit and makes $900 million in sales revenue. A continued emphasis on International Competitiveness (IC) is essential in keeping Arnott's at the forefront of biscuit manufacturing. Central to Arnott's policy response was the introduction of the Quality Enterprise Philosophy (QEP), which was a bridge to make Arnott's more IC. The theoretical basis of the QEP was for Arnott's to become customer driven in cost, quality, and service 1 Other characteristics of the QEP are: Responsibility for managing the worksite allocated to those doing the work Flexible production systems based on short cycle times and zero defects Team approach with flexible, skilled resources Strong reciprocal obligations defining relationships Decisions and actions based on facts (data). 1. Arnott's information pamphlet. [2] Feedback Excerpt 3 Blockbuster Music's main competitors are Brash's and Homeshow, both of which are also situated on Chapel Street. Blockbuster Music has a competitive edge over their competitors mainly due to the size of their store and the amount of stock and variety. Blockbuster Music also has the well publicised policy of guaranteeing that if they don't have the CD you are looking for, they will take five dollars off the price for you when they get it in. Blockbuster Music is one of the few stores that actually allows the consumer to try a product before they purchase it. This is the case with both CDs and video games. This policy is especially important at the moment due to the recent release of the Nintendo 64. With many people looking to buy the latest in electronic multimedia, retailers of this ilk are focussing heavily on the sale of the new unit and are after any competitive advantage they can get. [3] Feedback [1] Excerpt 1 My personal objectives were to understand how an organisation responds to pressures for policy change and see how the company's Training and Development policy could succeed in addressing those areas in need of improvement. Personal objectives, outlined to fulfil criteria for Year 12 writing tasks, are usually not expected in a university assignment. The information required will involve an examination of the previous Training and Development policy, including the pressures faced by management in regard to change, and a These sentences could be taken from a detailed account of the policy response to the pressures. An university-level report. assessment of the comprehensiveness of the company's policy response, and its effect on structures and activities must be addressed. I will also need to establish appropriate criteria for evaluating the policy response, as well as provide an assessment of the policy with regard to these criteria. Finally, an explanation of the organisation's likely management response to Training and Development in the future will be provided. This sentence reverts to the personal involvement of Paragraph 1. Because the approach in university writing, while responding to task requirements, is largely self-directed, you would say something like: "Criteria will be established and policy assessed..." [2] Excerpt 2 Arnott's Ltd. is the organisation from which a policy response was gained. Arnott's is the largest biscuit manufacturer in Australia, as well as the 7th largest in the world. At university, this statement would require a reference. Every year, Arnott's turns over 26,000 tonnes of biscuit and makes $900 million in sales revenue. This one would, too. This observation sounds like general knowledge, but A continued emphasis on International perhaps there are some companies for whom this Competitiveness (IC) is essential in keeping Arnott's would not be the case. That means it would be at the forefront of biscuit manufacturing. someone's opinion; hence at university a reference would be needed. This statement could be regarded as introducing the next statement which is referenced, but there are two Central to Arnott's policy response was the problems with this: The "bridge" sounds as if it's taken introduction of the Quality Enterprise Philosophy from somewhere so it should be paraphrased; and (QEP), which was a bridge to make Arnott's more IC. "Arnott's information pamphlet" may not be enough The theoretical basis of the QEP was for Arnott's to (maybe Arnott's has a lot of information pamphlets). become customer driven in cost, quality, and service Note that the reference is presented as a footnote and 1. so is not done according to the Harvard (in-text) style required for Marketing assignments. Other characteristics of the QEP are: Responsibility for managing the worksite allocated to those doing the work Flexible production systems based on short This is obviously coming from somewhere; even if it's cycle times and zero defects from the same pamphlet, another citation should be Team approach with flexible, skilled given. resources Strong reciprocal obligations defining relationships Decisions and actions based on facts (data). 1. Arnott's information pamphlet. [3] Excerpt 3 Blockbuster Music's main competitors are Brash's and Homeshow, both of which are also situated on Chapel Street. At university, you would need a reference for Blockbuster Music has a competitive edge over their this - or evidence and also a reference. competitors mainly due to the size of their store and the amount of stock and variety. Blockbuster Music also has the well publicised policy of guaranteeing that if they don't have the CD you are looking for, they will take five dollars off the price for you when they get it in. This does not require a reference as this is something that can be observed (in the real world). Note, though, that for your first-year Marketing report, you will often not be relying on real world observation. Where you are not, a reference is required. Blockbuster Music is one of the few stores that actually allows the consumer to try a product before they purchase it. This is the case with both CDs and video games. This policy is especially important at the moment due to the recent release As above. of the Nintendo 64. With many people looking to buy the latest in electronic multimedia, retailers of this ilk are focussing heavily on the sale of the new unit and are after any competitive advantage they can get. Reference list At the end of your report you will have a list of the references you CITED in the course of your report. When you are proof-reading, you should be able to cross-reference each text on the list with a mention - or citation in your report. Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. What should the reference list look like? There are quite specific conventions according to the referencing style generally used in your discipline which your tutor will expect you to familiarise yourself with. These conventions are quite tricky to remember at first, but if you keep by you a model such as the one below - where the student has been very consistent - it becomes easier. Look at the sample entries below and notice their differences and similarities. Use the dropdown list to indicate the type of source that each reference comes from: book newspaper article organisational web site database item Reference Your answer Assael, H., Reed, P. and Patton, M. (1995) Marketing: Principles and Strategy HarcourtBrace, Sydney. Foster's News Release (2000) World-first a winner at Carlton and United Breweries,www.fosters.com.au/media_or acle.asp, accessed 15/08/2004 Gentle, N. (2000), "Light Beer To Cost More Under Bill To Scrap Subsidy", Canberra Times, 25 May 2000, p.1-2. IBIS World (2000), G5123 Liquor Retailing, http://www.ibisworld.com.au/industry/Defi nition.asp?industry_id=39, accessed 17/08/04. Kotler, P., Armstrong, G., Brown, L., Chandler, S. A. (1998), Marketing, (4th edn), Prentice Hall, Sydney. Lamb, W., Hair, J., McDaniel, C. (1998), Marketing, (4th edn), South-Western College Publishing, Cincinatti. Lloyd, S. (1999), "Liquor Companies Find A Pre-Mixed Blessing", Business Review Weekly, 20 August, p.1-2. Oey, P. (1998), "Asia on the Fast Track", Drug and Cosmetic Industry, 22 May, p.2. Port, J. (1999), "Creative License", Business Review Weekly, 26 October, p.1-2. Simpson, W. (2000), "Sweet Surrender", Sydney Morning Herald, 2 February, p.16. How could the student reference list below be improved? Comparing it with the sample list above, see if you can find at least three mistakes. Bibliography 1 1. Kotler, P., (1998), Marketing, (4th ed.), Prentice Hall, Australia 2. Kotler, P., (1998), Marketing Management - analysis planning implementation and control, (9th ed.), Prentice Hall, Australia 3. ABIX - Australian Business Intelligence: Retail World 4. Australian Financial Review, 28/8/00 5. Sunday Star Times, 13/8/00 6. Red Bull GmbH, www.redbull.com 7. Frucor Ltd, www.frucor.com 8. IBIS Reports, www.ibisworld.com 9. Dow Jones International, www.dowjones.com Your answer: [1] Check your answer See if you can find at least three mistakes with this reference list as well. Bibliography 2 Assail H., Reed P., and Patton M, "Marketing: principles and strategy", Harcourt Brace, Australia, 1995. Jain S. "Marketing Planning and Strategy", (4th ed), South Western Publishing Co, USA 1993. Keegan W., Moriarty S., and Duncan, T, "Marketing", Prentice Hall, USA, 1992. Keegan W., Moriarty S., and Duncan, T, "Marketing", (2nd ed), Prentice Hall, USA, 1995. Kotler, P, "Marketing Management" (8th ed), Prentice Hall, Australia, 1994. Kotler, Armstrong, Brown, Adam, Chandler, "Marketing", Prentice Hall, Australia, 1998 Zikmund W. and D'amico M. "Marketing", (3rd ed), John Wiley and Sons, USA 1989 Web Sites http://www.corporateinformation.com/ausector.html http://www.natfoods.com.au/ Your answer: [2] Check your answer [1] The problems are as follows: Entries are numbered (unnecessarily) Periodical titles should also be italicised (not just books) Place of publication for all books is not given (it's usually possible to be quite specific as to the city where the book was published) Web sites do not have names and date accessed For the two databases, there is not enough information about the precise source [2] The problems are as follows: Titles are bold and in quotation marks, not italicised as they should be Date should be after the names of authors, not at end Place of publication for all books is not given (it's usually possible to be quite specific as to the city where the book was published) Third and fourth references: no need to include two editions of the same book. Second last book: authors' initials are not given There should be no division for web sites: they are included alphabetically in list as for books, articles, etc. Web sites do not have names and date accessed Citing and referencing Another term for referencing is citation - i.e. you are citing the work of someone else. How do I know when to acknowledge something from another source? This depends to a large extent on what is understood to be the given information in a particular field or discipline. For example, in Marketing it is accepted that there are macroeconomic forces which act on the microenvironment. You would not need to cite a reference in support of that. In the following extracts from student assignments, where should a reference to a source be included? Click on the Task Feedback at the end. Extract Your answers REF1 Demographic factors which influence segmentation include, for example, age, family size, income and occupation. REF1? These variables are very important to Ford when determining a target market as they are factors which are very closely linked to the specific needs and wants of customers. REF2? Age is an important factor taken into consideration by Ford in determining target markets. REF3? The Falcon is typically targeted at middle-aged men and women with children. REF4? Yes No REF2 Yes No REF3 Yes No REF4 Yes No Correct Answer REF1: No Understanding that there is a range of demographic factors or variables is a "given" in Marketing; thus, there is no need to reference REF2: No The fact that Ford makes use of these variables in determining their target market is hardly surprising - it is part of the given understanding in the discipline. No need to reference. REF3: Yes Why should age be of particular importance? The student must have got this piece of information from somewhere: thus, it needs to be referenced. REF4: Yes Why should this particular group be Ford's target market? A reference is needed to support the claim. REF1 The common pricing strategy for the Ford Explorer is value pricing, a strategy that attempts to offer customers the perfect combination of good service at an acceptable price for their specific needs. REF1? This strategy has been used considerably by Ford for most of its other product lines, and the trend is catching on around the automobile industry, as there is growing customer demand. REF2? However, other pricing strategies are often implemented in combination with value pricing. REF3? Yes No REF2 Yes No REF3 Yes No REF1: No It could be argued that this is a specific policy adopted by Ford and thus would need to be referenced. However, the point would be understood by anybody who stopped to think for a moment about how that type of car would be priced. Hence a reference is not necessary, only optional. REF2: Yes The notion of there being "growing demand" needs documented evidence. REF3: No If this were the end of the paragraph, this may need supporting evidence. However, in the original student assignment, as there was a sentence following giving an example, the reference was included at that point. REF1 The Smith's company targets Australian families of all ages who have high incomes. REF1? The marketing mix elements are used to help the company produce the response it wants from its target market. REF2? The marketing mix is the specific combination of interrelated and interdependent marketing activities engaged in by an organisation. REF3? The basic elements of the marketing mix are product, price, place and promotion. REF4? These elements are also referred to as marketing's controllable variables. REF5? Yes No REF2 Yes No REF3 REF1 Yes This is special knowledge which must have come from some source. REF2: No The fact that Smith's makes use of the marketing mix elements is not unexpected - it is part of the given understanding in the discipline. No need to reference. Yes No REF4 Yes No REF5 Yes REF3: Yes This is a definition which would have come from a source; thus, it needs a reference. REF4: No Although, this is a separate sentence from the next, it is referring to the same thing and thus REF5 can apply to both. No REF5: Yes A reference is required to cover this and the preceeding sentence - referring to a key marketing definition. REF1 Promotion is also an integral part of Qantas as they are Australia's leading airline brand. REF1? The kangaroo represents a proud history focused on reliability, safety, engineering excellence and customer service. REF2? Qantas has launched a new television advertising campaign using some of the world's most spectacular landmarks as the backdrop and featuring more than 200 members of the Australian choir. REF3? This was done as Qantas supports more than 240 individual sporting organisations throughout Australia and the world. REF4? Through this, they are creating a strong world-wide brand name. REF5? Yes No REF2 Yes No REF3 Yes No REF4 Yes No REF5 Yes No REF1: No This is probably accepted widely enough not to require a reference. REF2: Yes This sounds rather as if it is from Qantas advertising and thus would require a reference. REF3: No This is evident from everyday observation. REF4: Yes This is specific information, requiring a reference. REF5: No This is arguably a reasonable representation of common opinion, so probably doesn't need a reference. Defining and discussing Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. For Part 1, it is important to develop your ability to define and discuss. What does this mean? Examine the following examples to see how these students define, then begin to discuss: Example 1 The economic environment consists of "factors that affect consumer purchasing power and spending patterns" (Kotler et al, 1998, p.113). There are numerous factors in the economic environment that may influence and potentially have a profound impact on the banking industry. The most obvious of these are cyclical fluctuations in the level of economic activity... Student defines by making a statement, quoting from a reference and citing the source. He then moves from the general to the specific to discuss in terms of his chosen industry. Example 2 Demography may be defined as the "statistical study of human population and its distribution" (Stanton, Miller and Layton, 1991, p. 23), measured in terms of age, sex, density, location, race, occupation, etc. If the baking industry is to prosper, they must be able to identify the changes and trends in their demographic environment and cater their services to meet or respond to these changes... Student gives the definition, quoting from a reference and citing the source. She then moves from the general to the specific to discuss in terms of her chosen industry. Example 3 Fifield (1998, p. 33) defines promotion as "the whole array of methods and procedures by which the organisation communicates with its target market". Promotion can be accomplished using a number of different methods... Student gives the name and reference of the author presenting the definition, quoting it and then moving from the general to the specific to discuss in terms of his chosen industry. It is good to present definitions in different ways to make your writing more interesting for your reader. In general, you should try to paraphrase your sources, but for definitions, for obvious reasons, it is difficult not to use direct quotation. Identify the problem with the following examples. Example 1 Demographic Environment Demographically, the world is not what it used to be. Australia today is very different from what it was a generation ago. According to the Australian Bureau of Statistics (ABS), in 1998 nearly 12% of the population was aged over the age of 65... Example 2 Natural Environment The natural environment and the consumers' love for it have seen an emergence of specialist "outdoortourism" companies over the past ten to fifteen years. An even newer development in this field of tourism has been that of "eco-tourism"... Example 3 Technological Environment Technology is making the airlines industry more efficient and competitive, as more accurate information is available to consumers and more competitive distribution to producers. It seems inevitable that advances in technology will continue to have major impacts on the airline industries. [1] Task feedback [1] In each case, the student begins discussing before they have defined the macroenvironmental force. Sometimes you should quote directly, but mostly you need to quote indirectly - paraphrasing your sources. To paraphrase, you need to: Understand the original - there's no point including something you do not understand. Check a dictionary if you need to. Work out the main idea you want to include: make sure it's relevant to your line of argument Include words to indicate the original author's attitude, if that is relevant Check that you have not distorted the original author's meaning Use quotation marks if you are using specialist words/phrases from the original Cite your source accurately Paraphrasing Identify the problems with the following: Sample 1 The over-heated share-markets are unblinking in their admiration for the internet and the opportunities of e-business... Sample 2 The kangaroo symbol [of Qantas] represents a proud history focused on reliability, safety, engineering excellence and customer service. [2] Task feedback [2] There are expressions in both of these which are clearly derived from sources: "unblinking in their admiration", "a proud history". Even when it's not so clear that the wording comes from a source, remember that your marker is very familiar with all the textbooks on the subject and marks hundreds of assignments each year. In the case of these two examples, the expressions are not so important that they should have been quoted directly, so the students would have been better off paraphrasing, e.g.: Share markets may in time regret their current excessive enthusiasm for the possibilities of e-commerce (Bloggs, 2000). The kangaroo image links Qantas to all that is thought to be best about Australia: this includes qualities such as reliability and safety, high-quality engineering and service (Smith, 1999). Annotated assignments Covering the first-year subjects: Marketing Theory and Practice Introduction to Marketing Tourism Marketing The examples used in this tutorial reflect the assessment requirements for the Marketing assignment in a given year, but are still relevant to current assignments. Topic: Australian Automative Industry Report Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this report. Helen's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.1.2.xml> : See Helen's assignment before she received feedback on it. Helen's report and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.3.xml> : Read the lecturer's comments on this report. Interview with helen <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.1.4.xml> : Listen to Helen talk about the writing process. Topic: Instant Coffee Industry Report Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this report. Amanda's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.2.2.xml> : See Amanda's assignment before she received feedback on it. Amanda's report and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.3.xml> : Read the lecturer's comments on this report. Interview with Amanda <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml> : Listen to Amanda talk about the writing process. Topic: Fast Food Industry Report Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.3.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this report. Briohny's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.3.2.xml> : See Briohny's assignment before she received feedback on it. Briohny's report and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.3.3.xml> : Read the lecturer's comments on this report. Topic: Fast Food Industry Report Lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.4.1.xml> : Read what the lecturer expected from this report. Troy's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.4.2.xml> : See Troy's assignment before he received feedback on it. Troy's report and what the lecturer thought <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.4.3.xml> : Read the lecturer's comments on this report. The annotated assignments and the writing approaches described by students should not be seen as ideal models for you to copy. They are intended to be a general guide to writing in your subject and to help you to reflect on your own approach. Helen's assignment Helen is a first-year Marketing student. For her first assignment in the subject, Helen chose to focus on the Australian Automotive Industry. Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Helen's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.2.xml> . o How well do you think the report responds to the topic? o Do you think the report could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.3.xml> about Helen's report. 4. Finally, listen to Helen <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml> talk about how she wrote her assignment and read feedback about how to overcome the difficulties she faced. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Ian Walker - sets out what he expects from student assignments on this topic. Assignment 1 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. What the lecturer expects Guidelines Try to answer the following questions: Who are the major competitors in the industry? Is the sector expanding, contacting, remaining stagnant? Are there changes occurring (such as new taxes) likely to affect the industry? What are they? What effect/impact will these changes have? Your assignment will therefore be a report in three parts: 1. General discussion of the industry 2. Microenvironmental forces and likely effects 3. Macroenvironmental forces and likely effects Additional notes 1. This assignment is to be done on an INDIVIDUAL basis. (They are not GROUP assignments.) The work submitted must be your own. You must acknowledge the sources of your information. 2. The assignment must be typed, and well presented. Because it is intended to prepare you for the final examination, it must be written in business REPORT format/style. You may, however, use subheadings and bullet-points where appropriate within the report. You may also incorporate graphs, tables, diagrams, and figures into the body of the report if you wish. (If lengthy, material of this kind may be attached as appendices.) 3. In Assignment 2 you MUST include a bibliography. This should be on a separate page. FULL details are required - name and initials of all authors, full title, publisher, place, and date of publication. At this level of study, you must get these details right! See the Faculty's Q Manual (http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/) <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/> or any of the other good style guides in the libraries. 4. The word limit for the first assignment is 2,000 words. You will not be penalised for exceeding these limits - within reason (say 10%) - provided that there is no repetitiveness, irrelevance, or "padding". Similarly, you will not be penalised for being under the word limit, provided that the question has been fully and satisfactorily answered. 5. Although you are encouraged to seek a greater understanding of the issues raised in this assignment by discussing them with business practitioners of your personal acquaintance, you are NOT permitted to make unsolicited contact with business organisations to obtain information. Assignment and exam assessment criteria High Distinction 80 - 100% The student demonstrates the competencies in Distinction standard, and in addition uses creative examples, possible extensions, and applications of theory demonstrates originality makes defensible generalisations draws conclusions which lend themselves to further research writes to a publishable standard is aware of limitations Distinction 70 - 79% The student demonstrates the competencies in Credit standard, and in addition provides evidence of analysis and critical thinking demonstrates an ability to evaluate develops a progressive, convincing, and clear argument throughout the work demonstrates selectivity and uses judgement in determining the importance of readings and ideas shows evidence of wide reading and synthesis of ideas utilises additional material to supplement information provided produces writing which is of a high literacy standard (structure, style, and referencing) Credit 60 - 69% The student demonstrates the competencies in Pass standard, and in addition demonstrates the understanding of concepts, theories, and issues is able to identify strengths and weaknesses in theories/readings and use these as a basis for evaluation is able to apply information to practices/situations develops a clear argument with rationale for assumptions integrates writing and demonstrates links between components will rarely, if ever show evidence of original work will tend to bring material to closure (tidy it up and make it fit a neat conclusion) provides a structured, sourced, and referenced work expresses him-/herself concisely and clearly and exhibits relatively error-free writing may rely heavily on the the text and assigned readings may sometimes lapse into description rather than providing analysis and evaluation Pass 50 - 59% The student: essentially demonstrates an understanding of concepts, theories, and issues but will tend to restate rather than evaluate does not transform data in terms of structure, synthesis ,or application relies extensively on text, or text and limited readings may demonstrate coverage which is sparse in places provides little or no evidence of critical analysis provides little or no evidence of research tends to use one limited approach possibly a narrow focus provides an acceptably sourced and referenced work but improvement may be necessary in structure and grammar Fail 0 - 49% The student may demonstrate some or all of the following failure to answer the question misinterpretation of the question failure to demonstrate understanding of the theory and concepts required failure to identify the problems or issues failure to provide evidence of reading the minimum requirements does not write to acceptable academic standards (structure and grammar require extensive improvement) sourcing and referencing may not be present or are very confused is not typed is not handed in on time Helen's report Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. Executive summary: This Minor Assignment - Stream 1 is based on a business formulated report discussing the Australian Automotive Industry, and includes a general description of the industry, such as production details, major players, etc. This report will also attempt to identify and cover the microenvironmental and macroenvironmental forces affecting the industry and the likely consequences as a result of these forces. It is hoped that through this minor assignment and by investigating the automotive industry, a broad knowledge of the industry mentioned will be gained, an understanding of how the micro and macroenvironmental forces can and might affect the industry and thus enhance, improve and build my marketing skills. The aim of this assignment is also to provide an insight into how marketing can impact and influence us, in turn how we as the public community can influence others both now and in the future. Contents Executive Summary 1. Introduction 2. Industry Description 2.1. Sales 2.2. Production 2.3. Automotive Trade (Imports and Exports) TABLE: 1 - Major Importers to Australia TABLE: 2 - Major Exports of Australian Vehicles and Automotive components 2.4. Employment 2.5. Research and Development 3. Micro-macroenvironments 3.1. Microenvironment 3.1.1. Consumers/Customers 3.1.2. Suppliers 3.1.3. Competition GRAPH: 1 - Major Players 3.2 Macroenvironment 3.2.1 Economic Pressures 3.2.2 Technological Changes 3.2.3 Demographic Forces 4. Conclusion Bibliography Motor vehicle industry 1. Introduction: The Motor Vehicle Industry is a large and complex enterprise which not only consists of the manufacture and sales of passenger vehicles, but also the manufacture and sales of commercial vehicles, trucks, buses, planes, motor vehicle components, vehicle body manufacturing, automotive electrical/instrument manufacturing, engines and motor cycles. This vast industry produces, sells, imports and exports motor vehicles from passenger vehicles to vans, sports and luxury cars. It also comprises services ranging from repairs and safety tests to insurance, design, research and development. The major market segmentation includes private buyers, government fleet purchasers, business fleet purchasers and buyers of heavy industrial vehicles. This industry, however, is affected and influenced by many factors outside the control of the industry. These factors include the micro and macroenvironments. 2. Industry description: 2.1. Sales: Currently the Australian automotive industry has grown significantly over the years, with a 12% increase in vehicle sales, totalling 807,669 units in 1998 compared to 85,000 units in 1997. Within this 12% there was an increase of 23% in commercial vehicles, 35% in wagons, and passenger vehicles increased 8% (10% of passenger vehicles was due to an increase in small cars, and 9% due to increase in the upper medium sector). This was significant as the passenger motor vehicle manufacturing segment represents 78% of Australia's key product segment, with the other 22% being represented by the freight bus manufacturing segment. 2.2. Production: Production in the motor vehicle industry occurs nation-wide, with Victoria producing and manufacturing 47.3%, NSW 14.3%, Queensland 18.8%, SA 8.9% WA 9.8% and the Northern Territory producing 0.9%. However, the market size for the Australian motor vehicle manufacturing industry only consists of 80 organizations, of which less than 24% of people employed in the manufacturing sector produce automotive equipment. 2.3. Automotive trade (import and exports): Imports of vehicles and components occur nationally, with major importers being Japan, Republic of Korea, Germany and the United Stated. In the year ending 1999, imports had risen 7.9% as a result of strong demand for imported vehicles (6% increase in the demand for imported vehicles domestically). However, there was only a 0.9% increase in production of motor vehicle and automotive parts locally. The Australian motor vehicle industry also exports motor vehicles and automotive components, some of the major exporters being New Zealand, Republic of Korea, the United States of America, the United Arab Emirates and South Africa. TABLE 1: - Major Importers to Australia Country Percentage Japan 57.0 % Republic of Korea 11.1 % Germany 10.6 % United States of America 6.0 % TABLE 2: - Major Exports of Australian vehicles and automotive components Country United States of America Percentage 19.0 % New Zealand 18.8 % Republic of Korea 17.8 % United Arab Emirates 17.8 % South Africa 2.2 % 2.4. Employment: The Australian Motor Vehicle Industry manufacturing segmentation employs around 55,000 people in total. Within the manufacturing market segment, approximately 20,000 people are employed by the motor vehicle manufacturing sector, 11,000 employed by the motor vehicle body manufacturing division, 10,000 by the automotive electrical and instrument manufacturing portion and the remaining estimated 4,000 employees are employed by the automotive component sector. Thousands more people are employed in car retailing, research and development, insurance, fuel and petrol segments, management and administration of both manufacturing and service motor vehicle organizations. The government also employs thousands of people in their government departments, which monitor and regulate motor vehicle laws, e.g. employees governing registration, drivers' licensing, industrial relations, etc. 2.5. Research and development: The automotive industry also includes a research and development segment, which researches areas such as air pollution, gas emissions and road-worthiness of cars, and tries to develop solution to these problems. For example, Holden has researched and developed a prototype car called the Hybrid, which will reduce gas emissions, air pollution, fuel consumption and resources, by running on smaller amounts of petrol and more on electricity. The research and development segment also researches to design up-market cars, which excel in luxury, prestige, and market these to a niche sector. For example, Mitsubishi Technas and the aXcessAustralia Hybrid Concept car is designed and aimed to provide the world with an innovative vision of cars in the next century. 3. Micro-macroenvironments: The microenvironment is defined as forces affecting and influencing the organization's growth, production, function and direction, which are close to and directly impact the organization. Some of these forces include consumers/customers, suppliers, competition and marketing firm channels. The macroenvironment refers to the forces which extend beyond the organization's direct interaction and are out of their control, but determine the long-term survival of that organization. These macroenvironmental forces include economic, legal, political, social, international, technological, education and demographic pressures. 3.1. Microenvironment: 3.1.1. Consumers/Customers: Consumers/customers are the lifeblood of the industry as they directly affect it and determine if it is to succeed and grow. Without the customers purchasing and supporting the demand for products and services provided by the industry, there wouldn't be a market for the automotive industry's existence. With the goods and services tax to be introduced in July 2000, the expected drop in prices has led to customers postponing purchases of motor vehicles; thus there isn't the expected growth in the industry as hoped several years ago. The increase in fuel prices has also hampered the growth of the petroleum and fuel sector, as customers feel that they must seek cheaper alternatives to transport. Within the automotive industry, the car-retailing sector has implemented a strategy to increase sales, through heavy discounting on cars now instead of waiting till July 2000. This in turn has improved the industry's growth and reduced a large amount of impact on overall sales. Once the GST is introduced, customers will hopefully resume the purchasing of vehicles without the heavy discounting; thus the industry will continue to grow at a steady rate. 3.1.2. Suppliers: Suppliers largely dominate the automotive industry, whether they provide raw goods to other sectors within the industry itself or are suppliers providing raw goods to the general public. The fuel and petroleum segment of the motor vehicle industry has recently increased fuel prices, which have directly affected the automotive industry as customers are reluctant to fully refill their engines, thus reducing the amount of fuel purchased. It has also affected the industry's image, as customers and sectors within the industry are not pleased and are expressing anger to some extent towards the increase. The GST (goods and services tax) to be introduced has affected the production plans of manufacturing organizations. This is due to the reduced demand for vehicles from the general public; therefore there is the need to produce vast quantities of body parts, components, engines or vehicles. Again this restriction to the quantity of vehicles and components manufacture will undoubtedly continue once the GST has taken effect. 3.1.3. Competition: There are major competitors (accounting for 65.3% of manufacturing turnover) in the motor vehicle industry that manufacture, sell, export and import vehicles and components, and these include the Ford motor company of Australia, Toyota Motor Sales Australia Ltd, Mitsubishi Motor Australia Ltd and Holden Ltd. Mack Trucks Australia Pty Ltd is also another major player in the motor vehicle industry, which deals with the truck and buses sector, accounting for 34.7% of industry turnover. Over the past year, competition in the industry has increased due to the abolition of quotas on imports, thus allowing unlimited imports of vehicles into the country. In turn, this has put pressure on both organizations in the industry and the government to increase the standard/level of quality, efficiency and lower vehicle prices. Further pressure on competition has risen due to the fact that imports now account for 42% of sales made. Competitors must strive to improve the quality and technology of vehicles in the new century, as many competitors such as Holden and Toyota have now released a Hybrid model, which is cost-efficient, environmentally-friendly (reduces air pollution) and reserves resources, such as gas, petrol, etc. It is expected that competition will continue to rise as the GST will lower vehicle prices further, and more imports will allow customers more options when purchasing vehicles, thus the design, features and cost must be more appealing to the market than what other competitors are offering. GRAPH 1: 3.2. Macroenvironment: 3.2.1. Economic pressures: There are many economic pressures which plague the motor vehicle industry which include inflation, the level of interest rates, the type of taxation, increase minimum wages, and level of international competitiveness. Currently the motor vehicle industry is seen as a mature industry where the domestic and world economic cycles are strongly influencing the growth and turnovers in the industry. As mentioned previously, the introduction to the goods and services tax (GST) has so far had a devastating effect on the industry as sale and turnover figures indicate that customers are postponing purchases, therefore creating difficulties for manufacturers and car retailing organizations. Another downside to the GST is that used/second-hand cars will incur the extra 10% GST into the total price of the vehicle; thus it will be more expensive to purchase a second-hand car after July, 2000. However these pressures can bring about positive benefits. For example, tariffs on vehicle parts have been lowered, consequently reducing the cost of inputs and applying pressure on local supplier for better, more efficient performance. But some customers will still be reluctant to follow this expected trend, as the full input tax credit won't occur until July 2002. 3.2.2. Technological changes: Technology in the automotive industry is advancing at a rapid rate, in that we now see electronic maps, TV sets, CD players, etc, being built into cars for the sake of entertainment. But there have also been pressures placed on the automotive industry to improve the standards of their vehicles, engines and components to reduce the amount of gas emissions, use of resources and fossil fuels, and to provide a better quality of life through better engineering of cars that are/will be more environmentally friendly. Holden and Toyota are one of the first organizations to take the steps to meeting these goals, they have both designed, research and developed a Hybrid concept car, which has been built to reduce air pollution, fuel consumption and preserve resources. Test dummies and safety are also another form of technological pressure as organizations must continually upgrade and improve the standards of their cars so to meet the safety requirements set by government bodies. Organizations must ensure that the cars will not only meet these requirements, but strive to produce a car which is the 'safest' and one which will provide customers with peace of mind. 3.2.3. Demographic forces: Demographic factors/forces must be taken into account by all sectors and segments in the automotive industry, as this information will aid in the marketing, research, development, design, etc of current and future cars. Currently statistics and trends indicate that the slowing of population growth and the increase in the number of elderly people in the community will reduce the demand for vehicles. This will reduce demand for other, if not all motor vehicle related services, as this group of people are not likely to use or replace their cars. However statistics have also indicated that the majority of the population are seeking more independence and less dependence on the traditional family (father, mother and 2.3 children; where the parents are the income earners, and provide the income structure for the family), therefore we should see an increase in sales of vehicles made and automotive services used. 4. Conclusion: In conclusion, the motor vehicle industry involves more than just producing and purchasing vehicle, it involves many sectors which interconnect, and when influenced by the macro or microenvironments, they cause a ripple effect which affects the whole industry. The outlook for the future within the next 12 to 24 months seems to be brighter than currently. The confusion with the GST will hopefully, if not cease, be reduced and customers reassured, thereby the "postponing of purchasing vehicles phase" will be over and sales and production may resume. The industry overall will face many competitors and the industry will be more competitive than it has ever been before, as we will see a fall in vehicle prices and an increase in the number of imports. Local automotive organizations must at least maintain or better yet improve standards in both quality and customer relations, so to strive in the near future. We will see an introduction to a whole new set of vehicles designed for the next generation, advanced in technology, comfort, cost efficient and environmentally-friendly Hybrids which will run on electricity. Before you know it, they'll be running on water, if not the air pollution which they once generated! It's a bright, but competitive future for the motor vehicle industry Word count: 2129 words BIBLIOGRAPHY: 1. Kolter, P., Armstrong, G., Brown, L. and Adam, S. (1998) Marketing (4th Ed), Prentice Hall of Australia: Sydney 2. Bradmore, D., Joy, S., Kimberly, C. and Walker, I. (1998) Marketing Visions: Readings in Marketing (2nd Ed) , Prentice Hall of Australia: Sydney 3. Bradmore, D. (1990) Australian Marketing Dictionary, Macstyle Publishing Company: Melbourne 4. www.Autonet.com.au 5. www.Austrade.com.au 6. www.ABS.gov.au 7. www.automotiveworld.net 8. www.buseco.monash.edu.au/SUBJECTS/MKX/MKX1120 (links on web site home page) 9. Dow Jones Interactive (DJI) - articles and journals on motor vehicles, GST, impact, sales, production, Hybrid, and technological. 10. IBIS World - C2811 Motor Vehicle Manufacturing Helen's report and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. Executive summary: [IMG-1] [1]This Minor Assignment - Stream 1 is based on a business formulated report discussing the Australian Automotive Industry, and includes a general description of the industry, such as production details, major players, etc. This report will also attempt to identify and cover the microenvironmental and macroenvironmental forces affecting the industry and the likely consequences as a result of these forces. It is hoped that through this minor assignment and by investigating the automotive industry, a broad knowledge of the industry mentioned will be gained, an understanding of how the micro and macroenvironmental forces can and might affect the industry and thus enhance, improve and build my marketing skills. The aim of this assignment is also to provide an insight into how marketing can impact and influence us, in turn how we as the public community can influence others both now and in the future. Contents Executive Summary 1. Introduction 2. Industry Description 2.1. Sales 2.2. Production 2.3. Automotive Trade (Imports and Exports) TABLE: 1 - Major Importers to Australia TABLE: 2 - Major Exports of Australian Vehicles and Automotive components 2.4. Employment 2.5. Research and Development 3. Micro-macroenvironments 3.1. Microenvironment 3.1.1. Consumers/Customers 3.1.2. Suppliers 3.1.3. Competition GRAPH: 1 - Major Players 3.2 Macroenvironment 3.2.1 Economic Pressures 3.2.2 Technological Changes 3.2.3 Demographic Forces 4. Conclusion Bibliography Motor vehicle industry 1. Introduction: [IMG-2] [2]The Motor Vehicle Industry is a large and complex enterprise which not only consists of the manufacture and sales of passenger vehicles, but also the manufacture and sales of commercial vehicles, trucks, buses, planes, motor vehicle components, vehicle body manufacturing, automotive electrical/instrument manufacturing, engines and motor cycles. This vast industry produces, sells, imports and exports motor vehicles from passenger vehicles to vans, sports and luxury cars. It also comprises services ranging from repairs and safety tests to insurance, design, research and development. The major market segmentation includes private buyers, government fleet purchasers, business fleet purchasers and buyers of heavy industrial vehicles. This industry, however, is affected and influenced by many factors outside the control of the industry. These factors include the micro and macroenvironments. 2. Industry description: 2.1. Sales: [IMG-3] Currently the Australian automotive industry has grown significantly over the years, [3]with a 12% increase in vehicle sales, totalling 807,669 units in 1998 compared to 85,000 units in 1997. Within this 12% there was an increase of 23% in commercial vehicles, 35% in wagons, and passenger vehicles increased 8% (10% of passenger vehicles was due to an increase in small cars, and 9% due to increase in the upper medium sector). This was significant as the passenger motor vehicle manufacturing segment represents 78% of Australia's key product segment, with the other 22% being represented by the freight bus manufacturing segment. 2.2. Production: Production in the motor vehicle industry occurs nation-wide, with Victoria producing and manufacturing 47.3%, NSW 14.3%, Queensland 18.8%, SA 8.9% WA 9.8% and the Northern Territory producing 0.9%. However, the market size for the Australian motor vehicle manufacturing industry only consists of 80 organizations, of which less than 24% of people employed in the manufacturing sector produce automotive equipment. 2.3. Automotive trade (import and exports): Imports of vehicles and components occur nationally, with major importers being Japan, Republic of Korea, Germany and the United Stated. In the year ending 1999, imports had risen 7.9% as a result of strong demand for imported vehicles (6% increase in the demand for imported vehicles domestically). However, there was only a 0.9% increase in production of motor vehicle and automotive parts locally. The Australian motor vehicle industry also exports motor vehicles and automotive components, some of the major exporters being New Zealand, Republic of Korea, the United States of America, the United Arab Emirates and South Africa. [IMG-4] [4]TABLE 1: - Major Importers to Australia Country Percentage Japan 57.0 % Republic of Korea 11.1 % Germany 10.6 % United States of America 6.0 % TABLE 2: - Major Exports of Australian vehicles and automotive components Country Percentage United States of America 19.0 % New Zealand 18.8 % Republic of Korea 17.8 % United Arab Emirates 17.8 % South Africa 2.2 % 2.4. Employment: The Australian Motor Vehicle Industry manufacturing segmentation employs around 55,000 people in total. Within the manufacturing market segment, approximately 20,000 people are employed by the motor vehicle manufacturing sector, 11,000 employed by the motor vehicle body manufacturing division, 10,000 by the automotive electrical and instrument manufacturing portion and the remaining estimated 4,000 employees are employed by the automotive component sector. Thousands more people are employed in car retailing, research and development, insurance, fuel and petrol segments, management and administration of both manufacturing and service motor vehicle organizations. The government also employs thousands of people in their government departments, which monitor and regulate motor vehicle laws, e.g. employees governing registration, drivers' licensing, industrial relations, etc. 2.5. Research and development: The automotive industry also includes a research and development segment, which researches areas such as air pollution, gas emissions and road-worthiness of cars, and tries to develop solution to these problems. [IMG-5] [5]For example, Holden has researched and developed a prototype car called the Hybrid, which will reduce gas emissions, air pollution, fuel consumption and resources, by running on smaller amounts of petrol and more on electricity. The research and development segment also researches to design up-market cars, which excel in luxury, prestige, and market these to a niche sector. For example, Mitsubishi Technas and the aXcessAustralia Hybrid Concept car is designed and aimed to provide the world with an innovative vision of cars in the next century. 3. Micro-macroenvironments: [IMG-6] [6]The microenvironment is defined as forces affecting and influencing the organization's growth, production, function and direction, which are close to and directly impact the organization. Some of these forces include consumers/customers, suppliers, competition and marketing firm channels. The macroenvironment refers to the forces which extend beyond the organization's direct interaction and are out of their control, but determine the long-term survival of that organization. These macroenvironmental forces include economic, legal, political, social, international, technological, education and demographic pressures. 3.1. Microenvironment: 3.1.1. Consumers/Customers: Consumers/customers are the lifeblood of the industry as they directly affect it and determine if it is to succeed and grow. Without the customers purchasing and supporting the demand for products and services provided by the industry, there wouldn't be a market for the automotive industry's existence. With the goods and services tax to be introduced in July 2000, [IMG-7] [7]the expected drop in prices has led to customers postponing purchases of motor vehicles; thus there isn't the expected growth in the industry as hoped several years ago. The increase in fuel prices has also hampered the growth of the petroleum and fuel sector, as customers feel that they must seek cheaper alternatives to transport. Within the automotive industry, the car-retailing sector has implemented a strategy to increase sales, through heavy discounting on cars now instead of waiting till July 2000. This in turn has improved the industry's growth and reduced a large amount of impact on overall sales. Once the GST is introduced, customers will hopefully resume the purchasing of vehicles without the heavy discounting; thus the industry will continue to grow at a steady rate. 3.1.2. Suppliers: Suppliers largely dominate the automotive industry, whether they provide raw goods to other sectors within the industry itself or are suppliers providing raw goods to the general public. The fuel and petroleum segment of the motor vehicle industry has recently increased fuel prices, which have directly affected the automotive industry as customers are reluctant to fully refill their engines, thus reducing the amount of fuel purchased. It has also affected the industry's image, as customers and sectors within the industry are not pleased and are expressing anger to some extent towards the increase. The GST (goods and services tax) to be introduced has affected the production plans of manufacturing organizations. This is due to the reduced demand for vehicles from the general public; therefore there is the need to produce vast quantities of body parts, components, engines or vehicles. Again this restriction to the quantity of vehicles and components manufacture will undoubtedly continue once the GST has taken effect. 3.1.3. Competition: There are major competitors (accounting for 65.3% of manufacturing turnover) in the motor vehicle industry that manufacture, sell, export and import vehicles and components, and these include the Ford motor company of Australia, Toyota Motor Sales Australia Ltd, Mitsubishi Motor Australia Ltd and Holden Ltd. Mack Trucks Australia Pty Ltd is also another major player in the motor vehicle industry, which deals with the truck and buses sector, accounting for 34.7% of industry turnover. Over the past year, competition in the industry has increased due to the abolition of quotas on imports, thus allowing unlimited imports of vehicles into the country. In turn, this has put pressure on both organizations in the industry and the government to increase the standard/level of quality, efficiency and lower vehicle prices. Further pressure on competition has risen due to the fact that imports now account for 42% of sales made. Competitors must strive to improve the quality and technology of vehicles in the new century, as many competitors such as Holden and Toyota have now released a Hybrid model, which is cost-efficient, environmentally-friendly (reduces air pollution) and reserves resources, such as gas, petrol, etc. It is expected that competition will continue to rise as the GST will lower vehicle prices further, and more imports will allow customers more options when purchasing vehicles, thus the design, features and cost must be more appealing to the market than what other competitors are offering. GRAPH 1: 3.2. Macroenvironment: 3.2.1. Economic pressures: There are many economic pressures which plague the motor vehicle industry which include inflation, the level of interest rates, the type of taxation, increase minimum wages, and level of international competitiveness. Currently the motor vehicle industry is seen as a mature industry where the domestic and world economic cycles are strongly influencing the growth and turnovers in the industry. [IMG-8] [8]As mentioned previously, the introduction to the goods and services tax (GST) has so far had a devastating effect on the industry as sale and turnover figures indicate that customers are postponing purchases, therefore creating difficulties for manufacturers and car retailing organizations. Another downside to the GST is that used/second-hand cars will incur the extra 10% GST into the total price of the vehicle; thus it will be more expensive to purchase a second-hand car after July, 2000. However these pressures can bring about positive benefits. For example, tariffs on vehicle parts have been lowered, consequently reducing the cost of inputs and applying pressure on local supplier for better, more efficient performance. But some customers will still be reluctant to follow this expected trend, as the full input tax credit won't occur until July 2002. 3.2.2. Technological changes: Technology in the automotive industry is advancing at a rapid rate, in that we now see electronic maps, TV sets, CD players, etc, being built into cars for the sake of entertainment. But there have also been pressures placed on the automotive industry to improve the standards of their vehicles, engines and components to reduce the amount of gas emissions, use of resources and fossil fuels, and to provide a better quality of life through better engineering of cars that are/will be more environmentally friendly. Holden and Toyota are one of the first organizations to take the steps to meeting these goals, they have both designed, research and developed a Hybrid concept car, which has been built to reduce air pollution, fuel consumption and preserve resources. Test dummies and safety are also another form of technological pressure as organizations must continually upgrade and improve the standards of their cars so to meet the safety requirements set by government bodies. Organizations must ensure that the cars will not only meet these requirements, but strive to produce a car which is the 'safest' and one which will provide customers with peace of mind. 3.2.3. Demographic forces: Demographic factors/forces must be taken into account by all sectors and segments in the automotive industry, as this information will aid in the marketing, research, development, design, etc of current and future cars. Currently statistics and trends indicate that the slowing of population growth and the increase in the number of elderly people in the community will reduce the demand for vehicles. [IMG-9] [9]This will reduce demand for other, if not all motor vehicle related services, as this group of people are not likely to use or replace their cars. However statistics have also indicated that the majority of the population are seeking more independence and less dependence on the traditional family (father, mother and 2.3 children; where the parents are the income earners, and provide the income structure for the family), therefore we should see an increase in sales of vehicles made and automotive services used. 4. Conclusion: In conclusion, the motor vehicle industry involves more than just producing and purchasing vehicle, it involves many sectors which interconnect, and when influenced by the macro or microenvironments, they cause a ripple effect which affects the whole industry. The outlook for the future within the next 12 to 24 months seems to be brighter than currently. The confusion with the GST will hopefully, if not cease, be reduced and customers reassured, thereby the "postponing of purchasing vehicles phase" will be over and sales and production may resume. The industry overall will face many competitors and the industry will be more competitive than it has ever been before, as we will see a fall in vehicle prices and an increase in the number of imports. Local automotive organizations must at least maintain or better yet improve standards in both quality and customer relations, so to strive in the near future. We will see an introduction to a whole new set of vehicles designed for the next generation, advanced in technology, comfort, cost efficient and environmentally-friendly Hybrids which will run on electricity. Before you know it, they'll be running on water, if not the air pollution which they once generated! It's a bright, but competitive future for the motor vehicle industry Word count: 2129 words [IMG-10] [10] [Lecturer's overall comment] [IMG-11] [11]BIBLIOGRAPHY: 1. Kotler, P., Armstrong, G., Brown, L. & Adam, S. (1998). Marketing (4th ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. 2. Bradmore, D., Joy, S., Kimberly, C. & Walker, I. (1998). Marketing visions: Readings in marketing (2nd ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. 3. Bradmore, D. (1990). Australian marketing dictionary. Melbourne: Macstyle Publishing Company. [IMG-12] [12] 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. www.Autonet.com.au www.Austrade.com.au www.ABS.gov.au www.automotiveworld.net www.buseco.monash.edu.au/SUBJECTS/MKX/MKX1120 (links on web site home page) [IMG-13] 9. [13] Dow Jones Interactive (DJI) - articles and journals on motor vehicles, GST, impact, sales, production, Hybrid, and technological. [IMG-14] 10. [14] IBIS World - C2811 Motor Vehicle Manufacturing [1] More of an intro than an abstract While an abstract (or executive summary) may trace the structure of a report, its central function is to provide a summary of the main findings. It should not outline the contents, nor should it deal with the task aims or expected benefits for the student. These are accepted features of some Year 12 assignments - e.g. Business Management - but are not necessary for first-year Business subjects [2] Good - recognises complexity While it is not explicitly tackling the terms of the question, this is a promising introduction as it gives a thorough account of the activities in the industry, recognising the complexity of the industry from a range of perspectives. This suggests to the marker that the report will be comprehensive and strong on detail. [3] Be careful when using stats Statistics are very useful, particularly in the early stages of the report to give a broad and objective picture. However, they must not be misquoted (see Example 1), what you are showing must be clear (see Example 2), and the significance of what you are pointing out must be clear (Example 3). [4] Source? Unless you have created them yourself from raw data, all material - even tables and graphs (see later in report) - need to be sourced. [5] Good example As well as the more "tangible" elements of an industry, it is important to remember areas such as "R and D", as an investigation of their activities may yield some truly interesting and significant examples of how an industry is responding to internal and external forces. [6] Source? Reports require definitions of key areas: inevitably these will come from a source. Your marker will be familiar with these, and - if there are variations according to different commentators - will actually be interested to see which definition you choose to use. You need to name your sources. [7] Evidence? An assertion such as this requires a source. But before we even get to that, it first needs to present the evidence on which the statement is based. It sounds like a likely thing to be happening, but how do we know it is? [8] As above... ...only more so: How "devastating" is it? What was previously only lack of growth has now become "difficulties" for manufacturers and retailers. [9] Evidence, source? Can we assume all "elderly" people are in the same financial position and have the same needs and wants? Maybe this is one of the sorts of assumptions which the study of marketing will lead us to question. What is the source of these "statistics"? The paragraph introduces the kinds of evidence that should be included under "demographic forces", but the source needs to be named so the persuasiveness of the evidence (e.g. the magnitude of a trend) can be examined. [10] Lecturer's overall comment This report received a Credit. The assignment demonstrates a reasonable understanding of the industry, segmentation, and a range of forces that influence the industry. A significant shortcoming is the lack of appropriate referencing of sources, tables, and other claims/statements. Much of this material cannot be verified, and as a consequence the report lacks weight and strength. Discussion of all the macro factors - including the political, legal, and natural environments - would also have improved the assignment. [11] In APA Style this is called References. [12] Listing only the website is not sufficient. Follow the APA format for websites: Author/editor surname, Author/editor initial(s). (Year, month day of last update, or copyright year). Title of the page/document. Retrieved Month day, year, from URL. [13] Articles and journals to be listed individually. For electronic journals, the following information is required: Surname, Initial(s). (Year). Title of article. Journal title, number. Retrieved from. [14] IBISWorld. (Year, Month Day). Motor vehicle manufacturing (C28 11). Retrieved from IBISWorld database. (Include the date and the database it was retrieved from) Helen's comments Researching the assignment (1) - Using the subject website <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I would suggest go to the website and whatever addresses you think might exist on the Internet. You type them in and see whether they can actually open information, but also go to things like Dow Jones and IBIS World, which will provide you not only with articles but also other links to important websites; to try and talk to, probably, fellow students: they can give you all the helpful advice on where to go, and what sort of information is contained, they can give you suggestions on sorts of problems they have had, or experienced, and the sort of ways they've solved those problems. There is also the Q Manual, which gives you information on how to report, how to write down the sorts of information, categorise them and organise them, so that you can incorporate all that information into your report. The subject website provides a lot of information. The website has a section where you - basically it tells you what sort of outline, and the things that need to be incorporated inside the assignment. It has a section which is called Bulletin which also provides information on how to solve problems. It's an actual link to where students type in the sorts of problems they've had, and they wait for a reply from other students or the lecturer. The website also provides other links to direct website addresses which contain a lot of information on the subject topic that you are doing. Researching the assignment (2) - Using the library <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I started off with the librarian, and I asked whether there was any particular sort of way I should approach my research. The librarian gave me helpful hints on going to tours, which were really helpful. These tours contained a lot of information and handouts on the specific subject that I was doing. It showed me where to go in the library, what sort of information I should expect and hope to find. It showed me how - what sort of words and phrases I should type into the Internet, or the Voyager [= the library catalogue], so that I could get the most information from that topic that was the most relevant. It also showed me the sorts of CD ROMs and what sort of things like IBIS and Dow Jones, sort of, programmes that were available for me, and he told me that those contained not only abstracts, but actual full-content articles on my topic. Managing the writing process (1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Writing the report - I actually kind of postponed it. I found that there was so many problems and questions that needed to be answered, that I planned - I might have planned to do the report a bit each day, but I ended up leaving it to the last two days before the actual report was due. There was actual problems in that I might have written one sentence that I didn't actually know how to follow up on that sentence, so what I did was - that also caused problems, so I actually stopped. I took a break, and whenever an idea came up I jotted down to a note pad, and come back to the report, maybe a couple of hours later, maybe a half-day later. Managing the writing process (2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> As for writing up the essay, what I did was that I went from writing the Executive Summary, and then what I did was that I wrote the Introduction, and each point that I made I linked with the topic, and linked so that the next paragraph would be connected. The structure of the report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Strictly informational, but also in a sense that we needed to incorporate graphs and statistics, so that the whole essay flowed. I also needed to understand that the report writing involved subject headings, which also needed to be included inside the graph - er, inside the report. And I also needed to know that within the report there are certain formats required; like, I had to number each, sort of, section as I went along, and this sort of thing; I needed an Executive Summary, and things like that, which actually told me that - or, told the person who was reading it that - I needed to explain what, sort of, the report was about, and give them a hint; so that instead of reading the whole report, and finding out the whole report was based on the motor vehicle industry, I had to write a paragraph or so on that at the start of the essay. Deciding on a style <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Writing sorts of styles, they all contain different sort of words at the start of paragraph. But a good thing is to out find whether the assignment that you're writing requires a definite statement at the start of the paragraph, then lead through the ideas that you've got and explain them with examples or not or with graphs and things like that. I didn't really know whether I needed to do it in that format, or whether I should write it so that the actual language used was simple language or really complex corporate language, whether a word that I may have used in the report really needed to be defined or not. Using graphical material <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Graphs, statistics, tables, diagrams are all important in a report format. However, you've got to realise that when you use anything of that sort, that you have to explain it – why you are using it, what sort of important information and what you are trying illustrate to the reader. So the best thing is, probably, include a sentence or two which talks about the actual information that's in the diagram. Then what you should do is that with the formatting of the graph, you have to make sure that it's clear, logical, and that there is a number associated to the diagram which is also stated inside the contents pa- - on the contents page. You also should write probably - sort of, a caption underneath the diagram which has a brief sentence saying what the diagram is showing; like, "This graph indicates something in regards or relation to another" - sort of thing. With the graph you also have to be careful that you are not including too much into the body of the report, because graphs, yes, they are good, they illustrate things clearly, but too much of it, you may run the risk of not explaining properly. So that was also a problem, in that I wasn't told exactly how many graphs or things I should include, whether I should put them in the Appendix or not. As for actually explaining it, what I did was, I basically explained it at the end of the paragraph; then I included the - I went to the next paragraph; and things like that. Plagiarism (1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I realised at a University level that plagiarism doesn't mean copying straight from the text. It could mean rewording the text, and with summarising texts and incorporating statistics and sorts of information like that, I have realised that any work, even my own words, could be a form of plagiarism, because rewording statistics in the text is so close to, actually, plagiarism that I could be, in a sense, plagiarising but not intentionally plagiarising. And the thing is that, because I can't give drafts the tutor, I've realised that I might be plagiarising and I won't know it until the actual assignment is corrected and handed back to me; so that was a problem. Maybe if students could read my work it would have been good, but the thing with that is, that if I gave my work out to a student, I would run the risk of having them plagiarise my work. Plagiarism (2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> The plagiarism thing was completely different from High School, in that we were required to actually hand in drafts to teachers, and that ideas were actually discussed in the tutorial classes, so that all students have the option of getting information from both students and teachers. With University level, we can't hand in drafts, and the tutorials are basically planned out well in advance so that we don't actually have time to brainstorm and discuss ideas on the topic. Our tutorial was - the only tutorial we actually had that talked about the assignment was basically running through the assignment - the sorts of things that - the criteria that we need; but the criteria was brief, and we weren't able to talk about what sort of ideas we had in relation to the topic, and students couldn't give us advice, or anything of that nature. Checking the writing <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> Our tutors could also help in that aspect, but as for drafts, we weren't actually allowed hand in a draft and get that assessed, which was also a problem; so - probably - going to see a fellow-student, who could read the essay and give you feedback - that would have been good as well. Checking the assignment against the criteria <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/business-economics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> With the criteria, what I did was that, as I went along writing down the essay and typing up things on the computer, what I did was I wrote questions on the sorts of material that I want to be written inside the report and what I expected that the tutor and lecturer would be assessing me on. And so that what I did was that after I finished reading and proof-reading my report, I basically assessed myself on the sorts of things that grading from 1-5 whether it was good or not, and then I corrected those. I wrote whether the tutor would be expecting me to write specific things, and what sort of examples would be better used inside the report. Assessing the final product <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.1.4.xml#audioDiv> I haven't got information on how my tutor or the lecturer is going to mark my work, so I don't really know what sort of criteria I've got. I'm not actually completely pleased with my work, in that I didn't really know how to write it at first. I had so many problems in writing it and getting ideas. I mean, the sorts of information available was so broad, that the essay wasn't - didn't contain a lot of material that might have been relevant. With the sort of things that - I mean, previously in CATs in High School, what we did was that we got a criteria sheet which stated what was considered high, what was considered low, and we could actually correct our work according to the criteria. With this assignment we weren't given anything of the sort, we weren't told what the tutor or the lecturer was looking for. All we were told was that the assignment had to talk about a particular industry, describe the general industry, talk about the macro/micro perspectives of it, and basically had to be logical and clear. But I don't know what the tutors and the lecturer sees as clear and logical. It doesn't have a definition in the Q Manual, and it doesn't have a definition of that in the subject guide. Download the full interview with Helen (mp3, 8.85 MB). <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/assets/utilities/download.php?file=assets/audio/helen/helen-all.mp3> Amanda's assignment Amanda is a first-year Marketing student. For her first assignment in the subject, Amanda chose to focus on the instant coffee industry. Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Amanda's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.2.xml> . o How well do you think the report responds to the topic? o Do you think the report could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.3.xml> about Amanda's report. 4. Finally, listen to Amanda <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml> talk about how she wrote her assignment and read feedback about how to overcome the difficulties she faced. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Ian Walker - sets out what he expects from student assignments on this topic. Assignment 1 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. What the lecturer expects 1. Assignment Topic Areas <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#topic> 2. Guidelines <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#guidelines> 3. Additional notes <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#additional-notes> Assignment topic areas: TOURISM Product/Target Market: Backpackers, Retirees, Families ELECTRONIC COMMERCE Product/Target Market: Books, Wine, Music(MP3), Software FAST MOVING CONSUMER GOODS Product/Target Market: - Breakfast cereal for Children (under 12years) CONSUMER SERVICES Product/Target Market: - Movies, Consumer Banking Word limit 3,000 words Assessment for Assignment 2 (25%) divided equally between both parts of the assessment. Guidelines Part 1 asks you to: Briefly identify and explain the macro forces discussed by Kotler. Then identify and discuss in more detail the macro forces that are most applicable to the product/market area that you have selected. You must explain why you think they are applicable, how they impact the product/market area, and give appropriate examples to illustrate your understanding. Part 2 asks you to: Select two organisations that operate in the product/target market that you have chosen. Identify and detail the marketing mix (i.e. 4 and P's) they use to target this product/target market. Discuss the differences and the similarities between the two organisations' marketing mixes. Why do these differences exist or not exist? What other insight can you get into these organisations and how they use marketing for this industry? You are expected to develop the information yourself, being guided by whatever hard information you are able to find. You should read widely in Kotler et al. and other texts about what is required in a theoretical way, and you should observe closely what is actually happening with your chosen product(s) in the marketplace. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES ARE YOU TO CONTACT COMPANIES IN YOUR CHOSEN INDUSTRY FOR INFORMATION. Additional notes 1. This assignment is to be done on an INDIVIDUAL basis. (They are not GROUP assignments.) The work submitted must be your own. You must acknowledge the sources of your information. 2. The assignment must be typed, and well presented. Because it is intended to prepare you for the final examination, it must be written in business REPORT format/style. You may, however, use subheadings and bullet-points where appropriate within the report. You may also incorporate graphs, tables, diagrams, and figures into the body of the report if you wish. (If lengthy, material of this kind may be attached as appendices.) 3. In Assignment 2 you MUST include a bibliography. This should be on a separate page. FULL details are required - name and initials of all authors, full title, publisher, place, and date of publication. At this level of study, you must get these details right! See the Faculty's Q Manual (http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/) <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/> or any of the other good style guides in the libraries. 4. The word limit for the first assignment is 2,000 words. You will not be penalised for exceeding these limits - within reason (say 10%) - provided that there is no repetitiveness, irrelevance, or "padding". Similarly, you will not be penalised for being under the word limit, provided that the question has been fully and satisfactorily answered. 5. Although you are encouraged to seek a greater understanding of the issues raised in this assignment by discussing them with business practitioners of your personal acquaintance, you are NOT permitted to make unsolicited contact with business organisations to obtain information. Assignment and exam assessment criteria High Distinction 80 - 100% The student demonstrates the competencies in Distinction standard, and in addition uses creative examples, possible extensions, and applications of theory demonstrates originality makes defensible generalisations draws conclusions which lend themselves to further research writes to a publishable standard is aware of limitations Distinction 70 - 79% The student demonstrates the competencies in Credit standard, and in addition provides evidence of analysis and critical thinking demonstrates an ability to evaluate develops a progressive, convincing, and clear argument throughout the work demonstrates selectivity and uses judgement in determining the importance of readings and ideas shows evidence of wide reading and synthesis of ideas utilises additional material to supplement information provided produces writing which is of a high literacy standard (structure, style, and referencing) Credit 60 - 69% The student demonstrates the competencies in Pass standard, and in addition demonstrates the understanding of concepts, theories, and issues is able to identify strengths and weaknesses in theories/readings and use these as a basis for evaluation is able to apply information to practices/situations develops a clear argument with rationale for assumptions integrates writing and demonstrates links between components will rarely, if ever show evidence of original work will tend to bring material to closure (tidy it up and make it fit a neat conclusion) provides a structured, sourced, and referenced work expresses him-/herself concisely and clearly and exhibits relatively error-free writing may rely heavily on the the text and assigned readings may sometimes lapse into description rather than providing analysis and evaluation Pass 50 - 59% The student: essentially demonstrates an understanding of concepts, theories, and issues but will tend to restate rather than evaluate does not transform data in terms of structure, synthesis ,or application relies extensively on text, or text and limited readings may demonstrate coverage which is sparse in places provides little or no evidence of critical analysis provides little or no evidence of research tends to use one limited approach possibly a narrow focus provides an acceptably sourced and referenced work but improvement may be necessary in structure and grammar Fail 0 - 49% The student may demonstrate some or all of the following failure to answer the question misinterpretation of the question failure to demonstrate understanding of the theory and concepts required failure to identify the problems or issues failure to provide evidence of reading the minimum requirements does not write to acceptable academic standards (structure and grammar require extensive improvement) sourcing and referencing may not be present or are very confused is not typed is not handed in on time Amanda's report Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. Table of contents Market/Industry Definition Macroenvironment Demographic Environment Economic Environment Natural Environment Technical Environment Political Environment Cultural Environment The Marketing Mix: How two companies use it to target the Australian Instant Coffee Market Nescafe Robert Timms Nescafe vs. Robert Timms Conclusion Reference List Industry/Market definition The Australian Coffee Industry comprises all the firms that offer products for sale that are derived from coffee beans. There are pure coffee products, ie whole and ground coffee beans, and instant coffee products. Each kind of product has its own target market. A market is "the set of all actual and potential buyers of a product" (Kotler et al 1998, p885). The pure coffee market consists of all the actual and potential buyers of whole or ground coffee beans. The instant coffee market consists of all the actual and potential buyers of instant coffee. For the purposes of this assignment, I will focus on the instant coffee market in Australia. Part1 Macroenvironment The marketing environment within which a company operates is dynamic. Its consists of a microenvironment, and a macroenvironment. The microenvironment is "the forces close to the company that affect its ability to serve its customers." The macroenvironment is "the larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment," (Kotler et al 1998, pp885-886) The macroenvironment consists of six types of forces: demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces. A company's marketing strategy must take into account changes and trends in these environments that can present opportunities or pose threats. A successful firm is one that regularly modifies it marketing mix and strategies to adapt to these changes (Czinkota et al 2000, p17). Below I will outline the six macroenvironmental forces, and how they may affect the instant coffee market in Australia. Demographic environment Demographics are the "study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, occupations and other statistics" (Kotler et al 1998, p105). The demographic environment consists of all the aforementioned demographic variables, and their ability to affect the Australian instant coffee market. The importance of the demographic environment lies in the fact that all demand for a product derives ultimately from people (Cannon 1998, p41). Kotler et al (1998, p113) noted that demographic developments have "transformed the Australian marketplace from a mass market into more fragmented micro-markets differentiated by age, sex, geography, lifestyle, ethic background, education and other factors." Recent demographic trends in Australia are a bettereducated and more white-collar population, increasing ethnic diversity, and changing age structures. The implications of such changes are that organisations must now design products and marketing programs for the specific micro-markets they wish to target. While all demographic variables have the potential to affect the instant coffee market in Australia, the area of particular significance is the emergence of ethnic micro-markets. Ethnic communities now make up a significant - and growing - part of the Australian population, who have clear product and brand preferences (Bradmore et al 1997, p88). Thus, there is now demand for a wider variety of coffee styles to suit ethnic tastes, which requires the development of new products and marketing strategies. For example, since ninetyfive percent of all coffee drunk by Italians is espresso, (Barton 2000), many companies have developed instant espresso products. Economic environment The economic environment consists of the "factors that affect consumer buying power and spending patterns" (Kotler et al 1998, p113). Factor include income and employment levels, inflation levels, savings and credit conditions, the value of the Australian dollar and so on. This aspect of the macroenvironment is important to the Australian instant coffee market, as it is to any market, because consumers must have the purchasing power to back up their desire for the products. However, since non-price factors, such as branding, are a significant basis for competition for coffee products (IBIS World 2000, p8), changes in retail coffee prices will not have a huge effect on the market share of any one manufacturer. Despite that, economic factors that do affect the Australian coffee market include the value of the Australian dollar. Virtually all coffee beans are imported, and their prices vary with changes in the relative exchange rates (IBIS World 2000, p15). A low value of the Australian dollar, as is the present case, drives up input prices for manufacturers, which may be passed onto consumers. Furthermore, the Association of Coffee Producing Countries, which accounts for three quarters of world coffee-bean production, has announced plans to restrict the output of beans, which would mean it could control prices (Crawford 2000, p1). The effect of this possible price control is not yet known, but it could drive smaller manufacturers out of the market if the price increases are too high. Also, another issue is the level of disposable income of Australians. With an increase in income, consumers are increasingly likely to purchase higher quality products rather than to simply purchase more. Thus there is a growing market for higher quality and priced instant coffee. As noted in the IBIS World Report for C2179 Food Manufacturing, "higher income facilitated the successful introduction of specialty...coffee products." (IBIS World 2000, p7) The GST is not applicable to coffee products, but GST on pure coffee products served at commercial premises could increase the market potential for instant coffee. Natural environment The natural environment concerns the "natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or that are affected by marketing activities" (Kotler et al 1998, p116). Today, there is a growing awareness of the need to preserve our planet, and that includes the need to protect our natural environment from the potentially harmful affects of industrial activities. Since coffee producers make use of the natural environment, there is a potential for this aspect of the macroenvironment to be quite significant to the Australian coffee industry. Consumers, more than ever, are beginning to boycott products that have been manufactured in such a way as to damage the environment. This is putting pressure on manufactures to ensure all procedures are environmentally friendly, or risk losing market share. Such issues that involve coffee manufacturing are the use of pesticides and chemicals, pollution from manufacturing plants, excessive water use in the production stage, and the effect of farming the land in regard to future erosion and depletion of natural minerals. Also, the supply and price of coffee beans to the Australian Coffee market is at the mercy of the natural elements. The IBIS World (2000, p27) Industry Report stated that "coffee bean prices are forecast to increase sharply...(as)...the result of poor seasonal conditions in Central America and low stocks." Technological environment The technological environment is the "forces that affect new technologies, creating new product and market opportunities" (Kotler et al 1998, p889). Since coffee was discovered in around 1000AD (Nescafé 2000), the methods used to grow, harvest, process and manufacture coffee products has certainly evolved. The use of irrigation systems, fertilisers, machinery in the harvest process, and the introduction of automated, computer controlled equipment (in Australian processing plants) has raised efficiency and, in many cases, has also improved product quality (IBIS World 2000, p25). However, the most recent influential forces concern advances in manufacturing processes, and developments of new coffee machines for home use. New technologies had made it possible for Australian instant coffee manufacturers to produce a wider range of products, of higher quality. For example, Nescafé have recently introduced a new instant Café Latte range, and also new instant Espresso. Also, using freeze-dried technology, instant coffee has a significantly longer shelf life than any product in the pure coffee market, which is a significant advantage. However, over the past few decades, the development of inexpensive coffee perculators and plungers has increased the attractiveness of pure coffee products, often at the expense of the instant coffee market. For example, Melitta House of Coffee recently introduced a coffee maker that makes 10-15 cups of coffee as quickly as boiling a jug. Lastly, the advent Internet shopping is allowing consumers to make purchases on-line, and from foreign suppliers, thus posing a threat to the size and profitability of the Australian coffee market. Political environment The political environment consists of the "laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit various organisations and individuals in the society" (Kotler et al 1998, p887). Like in all markets, organisations that operate in the Australian instant coffee market are subject to laws that regulate virtually all aspects of their business, including such areas as food and health safety, pollution emissions, and advertising and labelling requirements. However, the political environment does not have large impact on the Australian coffee market. Cultural environment The cultural environment consists of the "institutions and forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions and behaviours" (Kotler et al 1998, p882). Changes in Australian culture, and the emergence of varied subcultures can have a large impact on the instant coffee market in Australia. As Hugh Mackay, chairman of Mackay Research Pty Ltd stated: "Anyone who is serious about communicating with contemporary Australians...needs to understand the most contemporary trends in attitudes and behaviour." (Bradmore et al 1997, p62) Recent trends in Australia that are having a particular affect on the instant coffee market are the redefinition of health and associated anxieties about diet, fitness and stress, and the recent emergence of a young Australian coffee culture. Australians are, more than ever, concerned about their health. There is a wealth of research linking caffeine to many ailments, and thus, this is increasing demand for the 'healthy' alternative - decaffeinated products. There is also the threat the consumers could boycott coffee products all together, and switch to another beverage, such as tea, which is well known for its positive health benefits. In addition, the market for all types of coffee is benefiting from an "era of coffee in Australia...A real coffee culture is growing." (Miller 2000, p3) People are not only drinking more coffee, but becoming coffee connoisseurs. Coffee is no longer just a product, but a means of self-expression. As a society we are placing the emphasis on quality, not quantity, and as such consumers are buying more "exotic" instant coffees (Bannister 2000, p17). There has also been an emergence of many different subcultures. A subculture is a "group of people with shared value systems based on common life experiences or situations (Kotler et al 1998, p123). Today, there is wide range of subcultures, particularly those based on nationalities, which is leading to demand for a wider variety of products. Part2 The marketing mix: How it is used by two companies to target the australian instant coffee market There are many organisations that operate within the instant coffee market in Australia. Each company positions themselves with a unique marketing mix that is aimed at specific segments of the market. Kotler et al (1998, p57) defines the marketing mix as "the set of controllable marketing variables that the company blends to produce the response it wants in the target market." The variables of the marketing mix are the 'four Ps': Product: "the 'goods-and-service' combination the company offers to the target market" (Kotler et al 1998, p57). Price: "the amount of money customers have to pay to obtain the product" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). Place (Distribution): "involves company logistics and marketing activities concerned with the making and distributing the final product" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). Promotion: the "activities that communicate the merits of the product and persuade the target customers to buy it" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). This includes advertising, publicity, sales promotions, personal selling, direct marketing and sponsorship. I will focus on the marketing mix of Nescafé and of Robert Timms. Nescafé Nescafe products are produced by Nestle. Necafe holds a vary large share of the instant coffee market in Australia. Marketing mix outline Product There is a range of Nescafé products available (see Table 1 below). Table 1: Nescafé Products and Price STYLE NESCAFÉ BLENDS DESCRIPTION PRICE ($) Espresso Strong, dark roast 250g 150g 50g 9.51 6.72 2.51 Mild Roast Full flavoured coffee with no bitterness 150g 50g 6.72 2.64 Blend 43 Rich and full bodied coffee 1kg 500g 250g 150g 100g 50g 33.97 18.05 9.51 6.41 4.65 2.47 Kenjara Smooth, full flavoured roast. 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Cap Colombie Medium roast, rich and subtle 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Alta Rica Deep and exotic high roast 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Gold Blend Rich and smooth. Made from the best arabica beans 375g 200g 100g 50g 19.90 11.16 6.55 3.34 250g 100g 50g 11.38 5.63 3.11 100g 6.98 Latte Original 240g 4.88 Latte French Vanilla 240g 4.88 Latte Mocha 240g 4.88 Decaf Gold Decaf NESCAFÉ LATTE RANGE SELLING SIZE Naturally Decaffeinated Coffee Price The prices of the Nescafé products have been listed in Table1: Nescafé products and price. Place (Distribution) The Nescafé product range is available in all large supermarket chains (Safeway, Coles etc). Smaller, independent grocers or stockists generally have a smaller range that would include Nescafé Blend 43. Promotion a variety of promotional techniques. This includes: Large scale advertising They advertise their products in a wide variety of print, broadcast and display media. Their most recent nation wide advertising campaigns were the "Open up with Nescafé" series, and the "Nescafé in the morning" series. Sales promotions Nescafé regularly runs contests that coincide with new product launches or advertising campaigns. Recent promotions were "win $1000 every morning for a month" "Win the Nescafé Latte Lounge" - to promote the new latte range Nescafé also use point of sale promotions, have cash-back offers, and have give-aways. Eg. a free Nescafé mug was given away with every purchase of 500g of Blend 43. The mug was the same type as that used in the 'Nescafé in the morning' advertisement series. Sponsorship: Nescafé sponsors the "Nescafé Big Break" competition which will give away $180,000 to young people (aged 16-21) with original and achievable ideas. "Nescafé Short Film Awards" - which offers a total of A$50,000 in cash awards to short film makers. There is a student category in this competition. Nescafé also has an Australian website (www.cafe43.com.au) where information on all products, competitions and events can be accessed. Marketing mix analysis Nescafé's marketing mix is aimed at a large and varied segment of the instant coffee market. They could be considered the 'Myer' of the instant coffee industry. The most obvious segments of the market they target are: Young adult café culture segment: They target this segment with their new latte range, along with the advertising, sales promotion and the competition to win the lounge seen in the advertisements. Upscale, quality driven, higher income consumers: Their Nescafé Gold range, and exotic tastes such as Alta Rice are aimed towards such consumers, where the price and qaulity are higher than that of the general blends. Middle-class consumer (no age target): Nescafé targets such a large segment with their Blend 43, Mild Roast and Espresso products. The consumer gets an economical benefit, as well as a quality product. Furthermore, Nescafé attempts to tap into the ethnic segment using their Espresso and exotic blends. In their advertisements for espresso, they use local Italian actor, Nick Giannopoulos. In general, since Nescafé has the largest range of instant coffee products in Australia, and has such a powerful brand name, they have a consumer franchise - they gain brand recognition and demand consumer loyalty. In particular, their most popular product, Nescafé Blend 43, is seen as the people's coffee. In their advertisements, they use actors of varied age, gender, occupations and ethnicity. Robert Timms: Robert Timms is Australia's oldest coffee company. It is the leader in the coffee bean market (Bannister 2000, p17), and has only entered the instant coffee market over the last couple of years. Marketing mix outline Product Robert Timms offers coffee bags (which work in the same manner as a tea bag) in four styles: Café Style Espresso Italian Style Espresso Mocha Kenya Style Royal Special The coffee bags are a mix of ground and instant coffee. They also have: Presmoto: Gourmet Freeze Dried Coffee. Molto: Gourmet Granulated Coffee Price Robert Timms coffee bags are sold in: packs of 8 for $2.35, or packs of 18 for $4.83 I was not able to find the price of Presmoto and Molto soluble coffee as I could not find an outlet that stocks it. Place Robert Timms coffee bags are available in all large supermarket chains, but sporadically in independent stores. I am not aware of where the gourmet soluble coffee can be purchased. It was not available in any large supermarket I have visited. Promotion Robert Timms has only begun extensive promotion since early 2000, after remaining relatively low in profile. They do not promote the coffee bags or gourmet instant coffee specifically, but rather they promote the brand name. Promotional tools used by Robert Timms are: Large scale advertising Robert Timms most recent nation wide advertising campaign was the "Think it over with Robert Timms" series, which is seen on broadcast, print and display media. Sponsorship Robert Timms is the official coffee supplier to the 2000 Olympic Games. Robert Timms also has a web site (www.reoberttimms.com). It mainly has information on the history of the company and it products. Marketing mix analysis Robert Timms positions itself in the instant coffee market as a provider of the very highest quality coffee products. The company prides itself on its heritage. As it states on its web-site: We are a dedicated group of Australians producing coffee, coffee related products and services that are comparable to the very best in the world. http://www.roberttimms.com/about/index.html <www.roberttimms.com/about/index.html> The company has targeted its instant coffee products to the high income, quality driven segment of the instant coffee market. The quality of their products is reflected in the prices, which are expensive, and the packaging, which uses the stylish combination of black and gold. Furthermore, through their role as official coffee supplier to the Olympics, they are also associating themselves with the pursuit of excellence and the Australian spirit. Their promotional campaign "Think it Over...with Robert Timms™" creates a relaxed, yet sophisticated feel about the company and their products. The premise behind the campaign is best summed up on their website: Take some time out of your busy day to enjoy our coffee and you too can Think it Over...with Robert Timms™' Reflect on the day, make the right decision at work or just decide to relax. It's up to you. http://www.roberttimms.com/think_it_over/index.html <www.roberttimms.com/think_it_over/index.html> Thus, while their marketing mix is targeted at high-income consumers who want high quality, they made sure they did not exclude a large share of the market by appearing overly elitist. Nescafé vs. Robert Timms The marketing mix of Nescafé and the marketing mix of Robert Timms are quite different. These differences reflect the different positioning of the two companies, and the segments of the market they were aiming to capture. Whereas Nescafe has targeted a larger percentage of the market, with quality but affordable products, Robert Timms has targeted a narrower segment with gourmet, expensive products. Generally, Robert Timms and Nescafé are no real direct threat to each other. While they do both compete in the high quality, gourmet end of the instant coffee market, Robert Timms is clearly the highest quality product, and consumers must pay for this. What Nescafé is offering is a more affordable alternative. Conclusion The instant coffee market in Australia is subject to the demographic, economic, political, cultural, natural and technological forces of the wider macroenvironment that it operates within. Each of these forces has the potential to change the marketing environment, and create opportunities and pose threats to the market and those who operate within it. What companies must do is monitor these environments to adapt its marketing mix accordingly. In the Australian instant coffee market, different companies have quite different marketing mixes, as can be seen when comparing Nescafé and Robert Timms. These differences do not mean that one is more effective than the other, but rather they reflect the different marketing strategies adopted by each company to capture the market segments they feel the company can best serve. Reference list Bannister Christine (2000), 'A coffee storm is brewing', ABIX Australasian Business Intelligence: Supermarket Plus, July 24, p. 17 Barton, Warren (2000), "The long and short of it; Breaking new grounds", The Dominion, July 6, p15. Cannon, T. (1998), Marketing: principles and practice (5th Ed), Cassell Publishers Ltd, London. Crawford, Anne (2000), "Enjoy It While You Can Afford It", The Age (Today section), p1, June 12. Czinkota M, Dickson P, Dunne P, Griffen A, Hoffman K, Hutt M, Lindgren J, Lusch R, Ronakainen I, Rosenbloom B, Sheth J, Shimp T, Siguaw, Simpson P, Speh T, Urbany J (2000), Marketing Best Practices , The Dryden Press, Orlando. IBIS World (2000), C2179 Food Manufacturing n.e.c Volume 8, http://203.173.101/iosrpt.asp?code=C2179 and sec=all, accessed 10/9/00 Kotler, Armstrong, Brown and Adam (1998), Marketing (4th Ed), Prentice Hall of Australia, Sydney. Miller Nick (2000), 'Espresso Yourself', The West Australian, September 16, p3 Nescafé, Coffee People, www.nescafe.com, accessed 14/09/00. Robert Timms, The House of Robert Timms, www.roberttimms.com, accessed 25/09/00. Amanda's report and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. [IMG-1] [1] [Executive summary?] Table of contents Market/Industry Definition Macroenvironment Demographic Environment Economic Environment Natural Environment Technical Environment Political Environment Cultural Environment The Marketing Mix: How two companies use it to target the Australian Instant Coffee Market Nescafe Robert Timms Nescafe vs. Robert Timms Conclusion Reference List Industry/Market definition The Australian Coffee Industry comprises all the firms that offer products for sale that are derived from coffee beans. There are pure coffee products, ie whole and ground coffee beans, and instant coffee products. Each kind of product has its own target market. A market is "the set of all actual and potential buyers of a product" (Kotler et al 1998, p885). The pure coffee market consists of all the actual and potential buyers of whole or ground coffee beans. The instant coffee market consists of all the actual and potential buyers of instant coffee. For the purposes of this assignment, I will focus on the instant coffee market in Australia. Part1 Macroenvironment The marketing environment within which a company operates is dynamic. Its consists of a microenvironment, and a macroenvironment. The microenvironment is "the forces close to the company that affect its ability to serve its customers." The macroenvironment is "the larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment," (Kotler et al 1998, pp885-886) The macroenvironment consists of six types of forces: demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces. A company's marketing strategy must take into account changes and trends in these environments that can present opportunities or pose threats. A successful firm is one that regularly modifies it marketing mix and strategies to adapt to these changes (Czinkota et al 2000, p17). Below I will outline the six macroenvironmental forces, and how they may affect the instant coffee market in Australia. Demographic environment Demographics are the "study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, occupations and other statistics" (Kotler et al 1998, p105). The demographic environment consists of all the aforementioned demographic variables, and their ability to affect the Australian instant coffee market. The importance of the demographic environment lies in the fact that all demand for a product derives ultimately from people (Cannon 1998, p41). Kotler et al (1998, p113) noted that demographic developments have "transformed the Australian marketplace from a mass market into more fragmented micro-markets differentiated by age, sex, geography, lifestyle, ethic background, education and other factors." Recent demographic trends in Australia are a bettereducated and more white-collar population, increasing ethnic diversity, and changing age structures. The implications of such changes are that organisations must now design products and marketing programs for the specific micro-markets they wish to target. While all demographic variables have the potential to affect the instant coffee market in Australia, [IMG-2] [2]the area of particular significance is the emergence of ethnic micro-markets. Ethnic communities now make up a significant - and growing - part of the Australian population, who have clear product and brand preferences (Bradmore et al 1997, p88). Thus, there is now demand for a wider variety of coffee styles to suit ethnic tastes, which requires the development of new products and marketing strategies. For example, since ninety-five percent of all coffee drunk by Italians is espresso, (Barton 2000), many companies have developed instant espresso products. Economic environment The economic environment consists of the "factors that affect consumer buying power and spending patterns" (Kotler et al 1998, p113). Factor include income and employment levels, inflation levels, savings and credit conditions, the value of the Australian dollar and so on. This aspect of the macroenvironment is important to the Australian instant coffee market, as it is to any market, because consumers must have the purchasing power to back up their desire for the products. However, since non-price factors, such as branding, are a significant basis for competition for coffee products (IBIS World 2000, p8), changes in retail coffee prices will not have a huge effect on the market share of any one manufacturer. Despite that, economic factors that do affect the Australian coffee market include the value of the Australian dollar. Virtually all coffee beans are imported, and their prices vary with changes in the relative exchange rates (IBIS World 2000, p15). A low value of the Australian dollar, as is the present case, drives up input prices for manufacturers, which may be passed onto consumers. Furthermore, the Association of Coffee Producing Countries, which accounts for three quarters of world coffee-bean production, has announced plans to restrict the output of beans, which would mean it could control prices (Crawford 2000, p1). The effect of this possible price control is not yet known, but it could drive smaller manufacturers out of the market if the price increases are too high. Also, another issue is the level of disposable income of Australians. With an increase in income, consumers are increasingly likely to purchase higher quality products rather than to simply purchase more. Thus there is a growing market for higher quality and priced instant coffee. As noted in the IBIS World Report for C2179 Food Manufacturing, "higher income facilitated the successful introduction of specialty...coffee products." (IBIS World 2000, p7) [IMG-3] [3]The GST is not applicable to coffee products, but GST on pure coffee products served at commercial premises could increase the market potential for instant coffee. Natural environment The natural environment concerns the "natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or that are affected by marketing activities" (Kotler et al 1998, p116). Today, there is a growing awareness of the need to preserve our planet, and that includes the need to protect our natural environment from the potentially harmful affects of industrial activities. Since coffee producers make use of the natural environment, there is a potential for this aspect of the macroenvironment to be quite significant to the Australian coffee industry. Consumers, more than ever, are beginning to boycott products that have been manufactured in such a way as to damage the environment. This is putting pressure on manufactures to ensure all procedures are environmentally friendly, or risk losing market share. Such issues that involve coffee manufacturing are the use of pesticides and chemicals, pollution from manufacturing plants, excessive water use in the production stage, and the effect of farming the land in regard to future erosion and depletion of natural minerals. Also, the supply and price of coffee beans to the Australian Coffee market is at the mercy of the natural elements. The IBIS World (2000, p27) Industry Report stated that "coffee bean prices are forecast to increase sharply...(as)...the result of poor seasonal conditions in Central America and low stocks." Technological environment The technological environment is the "forces that affect new technologies, creating new product and market opportunities" (Kotler et al 1998, p889). Since coffee was discovered in around 1000AD (Nescafé 2000), the methods used to grow, harvest, process and manufacture coffee products has certainly evolved. The use of irrigation systems, fertilisers, machinery in the harvest process, and the introduction of automated, computer controlled equipment (in Australian processing plants) has raised efficiency and, in many cases, has also improved product quality (IBIS World 2000, p25). However, the most recent influential forces concern advances in manufacturing processes, and developments of new coffee machines for home use. New technologies had made it possible for Australian instant coffee manufacturers to produce a wider range of products, of higher quality. For example, Nescafé have recently introduced a new instant Café Latte range, and also new instant Espresso. Also, using freeze-dried technology, instant coffee has a significantly longer shelf life than any product in the pure coffee market, which is a significant advantage. However, over the past few decades, the development of inexpensive coffee perculators and plungers has increased the attractiveness of pure coffee products, often at the expense of the instant coffee market. For example, Melitta House of Coffee recently introduced a coffee maker that makes 10-15 cups of coffee as quickly as boiling a jug. Lastly, the advent Internet shopping is allowing consumers to make purchases on-line, and from foreign suppliers, thus posing a threat to the size and profitability of the Australian coffee market. Political environment The political environment consists of the "laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit various organisations and individuals in the society" (Kotler et al 1998, p887). Like in all markets, organisations that operate in the Australian instant coffee market are subject to laws that regulate virtually all aspects of their business, including such areas as food and health safety, pollution emissions, and advertising and labelling requirements. [IMG-4] [4]However, the political environment does not have large impact on the Australian coffee market. Cultural environment The cultural environment consists of the "institutions and forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions and behaviours" (Kotler et al 1998, p882). Changes in Australian culture, and the emergence of varied subcultures can have a large impact on the instant coffee market in Australia. As Hugh Mackay, chairman of Mackay Research Pty Ltd stated: "Anyone who is serious about communicating with contemporary Australians...needs to understand the most contemporary trends in attitudes and behaviour." (Bradmore et al 1997, p62) Recent trends in Australia that are having a particular affect on the instant coffee market are the redefinition of health and associated anxieties about diet, fitness and stress, and the recent emergence of a young Australian coffee culture. Australians are, more than ever, concerned about their health. There is a wealth of research linking caffeine to many ailments, and thus, this is increasing demand for the 'healthy' alternative - decaffeinated products. There is also the threat the consumers could boycott coffee products all together, and switch to another beverage, such as tea, which is well known for its positive health benefits. In addition, the market for all types of coffee is benefiting from an "era of coffee in Australia...A real coffee culture is growing." (Miller 2000, p3) People are not only drinking more coffee, but becoming coffee connoisseurs. Coffee is no longer just a product, but a means of self-expression. As a society we are placing the emphasis on quality, not quantity, and as such consumers are buying more "exotic" instant coffees (Bannister 2000, p17). There has also been an emergence of many different subcultures. A subculture is a "group of people with shared value systems based on common life experiences or situations (Kotler et al 1998, p123). Today, there is wide range of subcultures, particularly those based on nationalities, which is leading to demand for a wider variety of products. [IMG-5] [5]Summary? Part2 The marketing mix: How it is used by two companies to target the australian instant coffee market There are many organisations that operate within the instant coffee market in Australia. Each company positions themselves with a unique marketing mix that is aimed at specific segments of the market. Kotler et al (1998, p57) defines the marketing mix as "the set of controllable marketing variables that the company blends to produce the response it wants in the target market." The variables of the marketing mix are the 'four Ps': Product: "the 'goods-and-service' combination the company offers to the target market" (Kotler et al 1998, p57). Price: "the amount of money customers have to pay to obtain the product" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). Place (Distribution): "involves company logistics and marketing activities concerned with the making and distributing the final product" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). Promotion: the "activities that communicate the merits of the product and persuade the target customers to buy it" (Kotler et al 1998, p58). This includes advertising, publicity, sales promotions, personal selling, direct marketing and sponsorship. I will focus on the marketing mix of Nescafé and of Robert Timms. Nescafé Nescafe products are produced by Nestle. Necafe holds a vary large share of the instant coffee market in Australia. Marketing mix outline Product [IMG-6] [6]There is a range of Nescafé products available (see Table 1 below). Table 1: Nescafé Products and Price STYLE NESCAFÉ BLENDS DESCRIPTION Strong, dark roast 250g 150g 50g 9.51 6.72 2.51 Mild Roast Full flavoured coffee with no bitterness 150g 50g 6.72 2.64 Blend 43 Rich and full bodied coffee 1kg 500g 250g 150g 100g 50g 33.97 18.05 9.51 6.41 4.65 2.47 Kenjara Smooth, full flavoured roast. 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Cap Colombie Medium roast, rich and subtle 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Alta Rica Deep and exotic high roast 100g 50g 7.15 3.94 Gold Blend Rich and smooth. Made from the best arabica beans 375g 200g 100g 50g 19.90 11.16 6.55 3.34 250g 100g 50g 11.38 5.63 3.11 100g 6.98 Latte Original 240g 4.88 Latte French Vanilla 240g 4.88 Latte Mocha 240g 4.88 Gold Decaf Price [IMG-7] PRICE ($) Espresso Decaf NESCAFÉ LATTE RANGE SELLING SIZE Naturally Decaffeinated Coffee [7]The prices of the Nescafé products have been listed in Table1: Nescafé products and price. Place (Distribution) The Nescafé product range is available in all large supermarket chains (Safeway, Coles etc). Smaller, independent grocers or stockists generally have a smaller range that would include Nescafé Blend 43. Promotion a variety of promotional techniques. This includes: Large scale advertising They advertise their products in a wide variety of print, broadcast and display media. Their most recent nation wide advertising campaigns were the "Open up with Nescafé" series, and the "Nescafé in the morning" series. Sales promotions Nescafé regularly runs contests that coincide with new product launches or advertising campaigns. Recent promotions were "win $1000 every morning for a month" "Win the Nescafé Latte Lounge" - to promote the new latte range Nescafé also use point of sale promotions, have cash-back offers, and have give-aways. Eg. a free Nescafé mug was given away with every purchase of 500g of Blend 43. The mug was the same type as that used in the 'Nescafé in the morning' advertisement series. Sponsorship: Nescafé sponsors the "Nescafé Big Break" competition which will give away $180,000 to young people (aged 16-21) with original and achievable ideas. "Nescafé Short Film Awards" - which offers a total of A$50,000 in cash awards to short film makers. There is a student category in this competition. Nescafé also has an Australian website (www.cafe43.com.au) where information on all products, competitions and events can be accessed. Marketing mix analysis Nescafé's marketing mix is aimed at a large and varied segment of the instant coffee market. They could be considered the 'Myer' of the instant coffee industry. The most obvious segments of the market they target are: Young adult café culture segment: They target this segment with their new latte range, along with the advertising, sales promotion and the competition to win the lounge seen in the advertisements. Upscale, quality driven, higher income consumers: Their Nescafé Gold range, and exotic tastes such as Alta Rice are aimed towards such consumers, where the price and qaulity are higher than that of the general blends. Middle-class consumer (no age target): Nescafé targets such a large segment with their Blend 43, Mild Roast and Espresso products. The consumer gets an economical benefit, as well as a quality product. Furthermore, Nescafé attempts to tap into the ethnic segment using their Espresso and exotic blends. In their advertisements for espresso, they use local Italian actor, Nick Giannopoulos. [IMG-8] [8]In general, since Nescafé has the largest range of instant coffee products in Australia, and has such a powerful brand name, they have a consumer franchise - they gain brand recognition and demand consumer loyalty. In particular, their most popular product, Nescafé Blend 43, is seen as the people's coffee. In their advertisements, they use actors of varied age, gender, occupations and ethnicity. Robert Timms: Robert Timms is Australia's oldest coffee company. It is the leader in the coffee bean market (Bannister 2000, p17), and has only entered the instant coffee market over the last couple of years. Marketing mix outline Product Robert Timms offers coffee bags (which work in the same manner as a tea bag) in four styles: Café Style Espresso Italian Style Espresso Mocha Kenya Style Royal Special [IMG-9] [9]The coffee bags are a mix of ground and instant coffee. They also have: Presmoto: Gourmet Freeze Dried Coffee. Molto: Gourmet Granulated Coffee Price Robert Timms coffee bags are sold in: packs of 8 for $2.35, or packs of 18 for $4.83 I was not able to find the price of Presmoto and Molto soluble coffee as I could not find an outlet that stocks it. Place Robert Timms coffee bags are available in all large supermarket chains, but sporadically in independent stores. I am not aware of where the gourmet soluble coffee can be purchased. It was not available in any large supermarket I have visited. Promotion Robert Timms has only begun extensive promotion since early 2000, after remaining relatively low in profile. They do not promote the coffee bags or gourmet instant coffee specifically, but rather they promote the brand name. Promotional tools used by Robert Timms are: Large scale advertising Robert Timms most recent nation wide advertising campaign was the "Think it over with Robert Timms" series, which is seen on broadcast, print and display media. Sponsorship Robert Timms is the official coffee supplier to the 2000 Olympic Games. Robert Timms also has a web site (www.reoberttimms.com). It mainly has information on the history of the company and it products. Marketing mix analysis Robert Timms positions itself in the instant coffee market as a provider of the very highest quality coffee products. The company prides itself on its heritage. As it states on its web-site: We are a dedicated group of Australians producing coffee, coffee related products and services that are comparable to the very best in the world. http://www.roberttimms.com/about/index.html <www.roberttimms.com/about/index.html> The company has targeted its instant coffee products to the high income, quality driven segment of the instant coffee market. The quality of their products is reflected in the prices, which are expensive, and the packaging, which uses the stylish combination of black and gold. Furthermore, through their role as official coffee supplier to the Olympics, they are also associating themselves with the pursuit of excellence and the Australian spirit. Their promotional campaign "Think it Over...with Robert Timms™" creates a relaxed, yet sophisticated feel about the company and their products. The premise behind the campaign is best summed up on their website: Take some time out of your busy day to enjoy our coffee and you too can Think it Over...with Robert Timms™' Reflect on the day, make the right decision at work or just decide to relax. It's up to you. http://www.roberttimms.com/think_it_over/index.html <www.roberttimms.com/think_it_over/index.html> Thus, while their marketing mix is targeted at high-income consumers who want high quality, they made sure they did not exclude a large share of the market by appearing overly elitist. Nescafé vs. Robert Timms The marketing mix of Nescafé and the marketing mix of Robert Timms are quite different. These differences reflect the different positioning of the two companies, and the segments of the market they were aiming to capture. Whereas Nescafe has targeted a larger percentage of the market, with quality but affordable products, Robert Timms has targeted a narrower segment with gourmet, expensive products. [IMG-10] [10]Generally, Robert Timms and Nescafé are no real direct threat to each other. While they do both compete in the high quality, gourmet end of the instant coffee market, Robert Timms is clearly the highest quality product, and consumers must pay for this. What Nescafé is offering is a more affordable alternative. Conclusion The instant coffee market in Australia is subject to the demographic, economic, political, cultural, natural and technological forces of the wider macroenvironment that it operates within. Each of these forces has the potential to change the marketing environment, and create opportunities and pose threats to the market and those who operate within it. What companies must do is monitor these environments to adapt its marketing mix accordingly. In the Australian instant coffee market, different companies have quite different marketing mixes, as can be seen when comparing Nescafé and Robert Timms. These differences do not mean that one is more effective than the other, but rather they reflect the different marketing strategies adopted by each company to capture the market segments they feel the company can best serve. [IMG-11] [11] [Lecturer's overall comment] Reference list Bannister, C. (2000, July 24). A coffee storm is brewing. ABIX Australasian Business Intelligence: Supermarket Plus, p.17. Barton, W. (2000, July 6). The long and short of it: Breaking new grounds. The Dominion, p.15. Cannon, T. (1998). Marketing: Principles and practice (5th ed.). London: Cassell Publishers Ltd. Crawford, A. (2000, June 12). Enjoy It While You Can Afford It. The Age (Today section), p.1. [IMG-12] [12]Czinkota. M., Dickson, P., Dunne, P., Griffen, A., Hoffman, K., Hutt, M., Lindgren, J., Lusch, R., Ronakainen, I., Rosenbloom, B., Sheth, J., Shimp, T., Siguaw, Simpson, P., Speh, T., & Urbany J. (2000). Marketing Best Practices. Orlando: The Dryden Press. [IMG-13] [13]IBIS World (2000), C2179 Food Manufacturing n.e.c Volume 8, http://203.173.101/iosrpt.asp?code=C2179 and sec=all, accessed 10/9/00 Kotler, P., Armstrong, G., Brown, L. & Adam, S. (1998). Marketing (4th ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. Miller, N. (2000, September 16). Espresso Yourself. West Australian, p.3. Nescafe. (n.d.). Coffee People. Retrieved September 14, 2000, from www.nescafe.com <www.nescafe.com> Robert Timms. (n.d.). The House of Robert Timms. Retrieved September 25, 2000, from www.roberttimms.com <www.roberttimms.com> [1] Executive summary An executive summary needs to be included to summarise concisely the major findings/recommendations of the report. It can include the following elements: purpose/method of study; results; conclusions. [2] Needs to expand here Here, the student makes a good point about a significant development, but does not expand on what it is specifically. Statistics are needed in support of this statement, together with some figures on growth and trends. It's good to use examples (Italians and expresso), but more demonstration of the overall trends, such as percentage increase in major groups, would provide more of a comprehensive picture. [3] Explain The word limit should not prevent students from describing a point fully - to show they understand what they are talking about. With this point, the student seems to be saying that, because the GST is applicable to coffee which is served to customers, this could drive some customers to choose instant because of the price difference; but it's not completely clear. Some justification for this statement is also needed - is it solely her own opinion? [4] Current and future trends With the macroenvironmental forces, it's important to think of them as a network, not as separate unrelated agents. Because the political environment includes pressure groups, concerns about such things as the environment and genetic engineering come into play, particularly as possible future trends. Brainstorming points for the macro forces before writing is useful to make sure you include everything: for example, deregulation of industry and/or political policy direction changes. [5] Summary here would help The student is now moving on to the second part and needs to leave the reader with a forceful impression of what has been covered in Part 1. A summary here of the macro forces' influence/impact would help clarify the general and specific points made. [6] More required here While the table demonstrates well the research the student has done, it is not sufficient simply to present factual detail. The brand needs to be referred to: how significant is it (brand equity, etc.)? The table can be introduced by making the point that each product is targeting a different taste, price, expectations, etc., thus maximising the opportunity to demonstrate understanding. [7] More detail needed Instead of just referring to the table, the student could have talked about how price is used as a strategic tool. The brand image is influenced by the pricing strategy; discounts also play a role. It's important to make the most of each of the variables, showing how you thought about each one. [8] Good coverage overall The student draws her points together well. Some additional explanation and detail are required, but the student demonstrates understanding of the marketing concepts and how they are applied in the marketplace. [9] Make differences clearer Even though a comparison is expected at the end, the student could be using the opportunity here to make clear distinctions between the two products. The Robert Timms product taps into the coffee bean drinker who wants convenience. Good to point out the composition of the bags, but more could be made of this as meaning potentially a new market segment. [10] Needs a bit more discusssion The student makes some general points here which are valid, but it would be strengthened in the second paragraph if some of the specific differences were touched on; and in the third paragraph by some more discussion of how and why they are no direct threat to each other. The comparison section shows your marker how well you can synthesise two separate bodies of information. [11] Lecturer's overall comment This report received a High Distinction (in the lower range). Including the executive summary would have resulted in an even better mark. The important thing about the assignment is that, while it is not perfect, the student demonstrates understanding of the relevant marketing concepts and how they can be used/applied to products in the marketplace to provide insight and understanding for marketers. Sometimes she could have been a little more explicit, elaborating and explaining her points further. [12] Czinkota, M., Dickson, P., Dunne, P., Griffen, A., Hoffman, K., Hutt, M., et al. (2000). Marketing Best Practices. Orlando: The Dryden Press. (If there are more than 6 authors, after the sixth author type "et al." and omit the subsequent names) [13] IBISWorld. (2000, August 29). Tea, coffee and other food manufacturing in Australia (C21 79). Retrieved from IBISWorld database. (Apply correct punctuation style; italicise the title information, and include the database this was retrieved from) Amanda's comments Writing in year 12 and first year <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> In regards to University assignments in relation to Year 12 assignments, I think there is a lot of difference between the two. For assignments that I've done this year, I've found that the depth required is a lot greater. It requires more research; you will need to be more succinct in drawing the main points. Whereas Year 12 assignments, although need to be succinct and of a reasonable depth; it wasn't the same standard as required in University. In relation to subjects, I found similarity between the marketing assignment and the ...which was a bio-social analyst, and the reasons that I found it similar was simply because of the kind of research that was required and how you had to get a variety of different sources to draw it all together to put the assignment together. In relation to University assignments and the criteria for assessment, most subjects that I've had so far have spelt out the areas that are going to be assessed in assignments, how much they're worth, but it hasn't necessary gone into detail of the criteria for each assignment that you got in Year 12 when you had your case and you knew what you had to do for an A or a B. I think that you know the general standard that's required to get a high mark, but for each assignment, you don't necessarily know what has to be included, what has to be discussed to actually get the high marks. So, it's a lot broader and I think it's a lot harder to work out what you... Writing the conclusion <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> In the second part of the assignment for the two Marketing lectures, after detailing the Marketing...for both companies, I felt the need to have a contrasting section between Robert Timms and Nescafe. And the reason for that was simply to spell out the differences in the Marketing...between the two companies, and how they use the marketing...differently. Comparing the two companies <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> The conclusion of this assignment was pretty much a very succinct condensation of the whole assignment. Basically, after writing the rest of the assignment, it was pretty easy to put together because I knew the main points and I knew what needed to be included. The Conclusion of the assignment wasn't so much pulling out the most important points, it was simply restating the variables of the macroenvironment, and how they can have a general affect on the industry. And then just making a quick mention of how different companies within the coffee market use their marketing mix to target different areas. Structuring (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> The reason that I ended up doing it under sub-headings, for the different parts of the Marketing index, was that that way I knew that I had addressed every part of the Marketing index and didn't miss anything. Also it sort of helped myself just to make sure that I could compare the two easier. Relevance of one's own opinion <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> For the assignment, it wasn't really about putting your own opinion in. Although I think you did have to make a few judgement calls on the areas that were important to the industry. Also you had to do a bit of your own interpreting on how different parts of the macroenvironment were affecting the industry, because it wasn't necessarily spelt out in some areas. So for example for the political environment I couldn't go anywhere and find out what was happening in ...coffee industry, that I knew there would be areas such as regulations on health and food safety that would have an impact, so that's the kind of thing that you need to make a judgement call... Problems with referencing (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> Personally my uncertainty with referencing comes from two parts: Firstly, "Have I got the right information for the reference, such as the year it was made, the authors and so forth? The second area comes with: "Have I used it in the right spot?" "Am I quoting the right part of the text?" "Is it from that book or did they quote it from somewhere else?" and if so, "How do I quote within another text?" I think that when you're referencing, there is a grey area as to what is your view and what is the view in the book that you're reading and if I use that view do I need to quote them? But I think what I needed to do was if I was using an idea that had come from the book, I did quote and reference that because without having read that, I don't think that may necessarily have been my opinion. So the ideas from the start came from the text and so I think it needed to be referenced. For referencing, I use inverted commas when I've taken the words straight out of the book, whereas I might just in other instances just paraphrase and then just reference the whole area that I've put the paraphrase in. In deciding whether to paraphrase or directly quote, it depends on how I've put the paragraph that's going together. And often I start with direct quoting, but then find it doesn't flow and so I'll paraphrase that area and just... Problems with referencing (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> When I was referencing, what I did was, I put the quote in or the paraphrase in. And as I was doing it, I'd reference that straight away. I'd put in the book that it was from and the page and so forth; because what I found was that if I leave it to the end and have to go back and find where was that quote from, which article, what page, it's very time consuming, its frustrating and it's just so ...it's just so much easier just to do it straight away. Writing (part 1 and part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> In writing the assignment, firstly what I did was the research part. And then once I'd found the research, I moved onto the first part of the assignment, which was describing the macroenvironment of the industry and what was happening. Basically what I did was I started with textbook definitions of each macroenvironment variable, and then from that point I drew information from the articles on what was happening on each environment. Then basically finished that first. Once I'd done the first part of the assignment, I moved onto the second part, which was describing the Marketing index of the two companies. What I did was just under headings of each part of the Marketing Index: product, price, promotion, and place. I started describing the information that I'd found on each of those variables and basically finished that, and then as a whole I read over it all, fixed up grammatical areas, did a bit of structural re-working and then just pretty much finished after a few more drafts. Approaching the tutor and other students <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> While I was doing the assignment, I felt quite comfortable about approaching my tutor about it and getting a bit of help. I went and saw her during her consulting times, just to bounce a few ideas off her about the macroenvironment and just factors that were affecting the industry - just to get myself on the right track and get a bit of feedback on how I was doing and how my thought process was sort of working on the assignment to see if I was on the right track. And also I found that just talking to other people in my class and other people that knew about how they were approaching their assignment. What area they were doing and what kind of factors in the macroenvironment were they finding that were affecting, because possibly they might've discovered something that was relevant to their industry which I may not have thought of, but still... Using information <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> Once I narrowed down the articles, what I did was go through and just with a highlighter, highlight the important points and just keep a mental note of all the different information that I found out. Then what I did was when I was writing the assignment, I just remembered those things and included the information in and referred to the articles at that stage. I didn't make any hand-written notes up until that point. Researching the report (part 1) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> The research that I got on the assignment was from going to the company's websites; from going to say Dow Jones Interactive, and so what I ended up with was articles from industry publications, world reports on the industry as whole, publications from say The Bulletin or Business Review Weekly, just a whole range of articles, because that actual database combines more into one. So you just do your search and then it just ...more in. The quality of the information that I got from the database definitely varied, the industry reports were very useful because they did give specific information about factors that were affecting the industry. The information that I got say from articles from say Business Review Weekly was more general and wasn't as specific, but it was still useful to give an overall trend or maybe little snippets on future events that were occurring. Researching the report (part 2) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> For the assignment, we were warned that you wouldn't be able to go to one book or one area to find all the information you needed. So I already knew that I was going to have to do a fair bit of research for this assignment, but I didn't really realize how many different places I would have to look. It wasn't that hard using the databases of the library because there was advice given in the lecture that told us how to use it; and we were also given a handout, but if you don't know what you're doing - when I tried to use it first semester I didn't know what I was doing and I went round in circles. The difference in my research process the second time using the databases was the fact that I had the librarian come and help us and give us a hand out and basically said "If you want to search for something, go to this site, type it in here, press this press that." And then you'd go off and narrow your search options a lot and find information Researching the report (part 3) <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> To decide what was relevant, I already had in my mind, the kind of information that I was looking for, and so for each article I basically did a quick 'skim-read', looked for where coffee was written, read around those areas - to see if they were to do with anything of macroenvironmental variables or anything to do with the price of products, any kind of promotion that was going on in the industry. After starting the assignment, I found there were areas that needed a bit more investigation and that weren't really coming up to scratch. So at that point I had to go back and do a bit more specific research on different areas just to fill in the gaps. Interpreting the question <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.2.4.xml#audioDiv> Interpreting both parts of the assignment, I think the first part was a lot more straight-forward in defining the areas that affected new markets, such as all the macroenvironmental factors, but for the second part it was definitely a lot harder to find information on and to interpret because you couldn't just go to one place and say look up Nescafe and there they had their price and their products and all the information on it. So you had to look at it and say, well, if I'm going to do this company can I find this information and do I know what it means. Download the full interview with Amanda (mp3, 7.45 MB). <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/assets/utilities/download.php?file=assets/audio/amanda/amandaall.mp3> Briohny's assignment Briohny is a first-year Marketing student. For her first assignment in the subject, Briohny chose to focus on the fast food industry. Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.3.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Briohny's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.3.2.xml> . o How well do you think the report responds to the topic? o Do you think the report could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.3.3.xml> about Briohny's report. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Ian Walker - sets out what he expects from student assignments on this topic. Assignment 2 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. What the lecturer expects 1. Assignment Topic Areas <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#topic> 2. Guidelines <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#guidelines> 3. Additional notes <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#additional-notes> Assignment topic areas: TOURISM Product/Target Market: Backpackers, Retirees, Families ELECTRONIC COMMERCE Product/Target Market: Books, Wine, Music(MP3), Software FAST MOVING CONSUMER GOODS Product/Target Market: - Breakfast cereal for Children (under 12years) CONSUMER SERVICES Product/Target Market: - Movies, Consumer Banking Word limit 3,000 words Assessment for Assignment 2 (25%) divided equally between both parts of the assessment. Guidelines Part 1 asks you to: Briefly identify and explain the macro forces discussed by Kotler. Then identify and discuss in more detail the macro forces that are most applicable to the product/market area that you have selected. You must explain why you think they are applicable, how they impact the product/market area, and give appropriate examples to illustrate your understanding. Part 2 asks you to: Select two organisations that operate in the product/target market that you have chosen. Identify and detail the marketing mix (i.e. 4 and P's) they use to target this product/target market. Discuss the differences and the similarities between the two organisations' marketing mixes. Why do these differences exist or not exist? What other insight can you get into these organisations and how they use marketing for this industry? You are expected to develop the information yourself, being guided by whatever hard information you are able to find. You should read widely in Kotler et al. and other texts about what is required in a theoretical way, and you should observe closely what is actually happening with your chosen product(s) in the marketplace. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES ARE YOU TO CONTACT COMPANIES IN YOUR CHOSEN INDUSTRY FOR INFORMATION. Additional notes 1. This assignment is to be done on an INDIVIDUAL basis. (They are not GROUP assignments.) The work submitted must be your own. You must acknowledge the sources of your information. 2. The assignment must be typed, and well presented. Because it is intended to prepare you for the final examination, it must be written in business REPORT format/style. You may, however, use subheadings and bullet-points where appropriate within the report. You may also incorporate graphs, tables, diagrams, and figures into the body of the report if you wish. (If lengthy, material of this kind may be attached as appendices.) 3. In Assignment 2 you MUST include a bibliography. This should be on a separate page. FULL details are required - name and initials of all authors, full title, publisher, place, and date of publication. At this level of study, you must get these details right! See the Faculty's Q Manual (http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/) <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/> or any of the other good style guides in the libraries. 4. The word limit for the first assignment is 2,000 words. You will not be penalised for exceeding these limits - within reason (say 10%) - provided that there is no repetitiveness, irrelevance, or "padding". Similarly, you will not be penalised for being under the word limit, provided that the question has been fully and satisfactorily answered. 5. Although you are encouraged to seek a greater understanding of the issues raised in this assignment by discussing them with business practitioners of your personal acquaintance, you are NOT permitted to make unsolicited contact with business organisations to obtain information. Assignment and exam assessment criteria High Distinction 80 - 100% The student demonstrates the competencies in Distinction standard, and in addition uses creative examples, possible extensions, and applications of theory demonstrates originality makes defensible generalisations draws conclusions which lend themselves to further research writes to a publishable standard is aware of limitations Distinction 70 - 79% The student demonstrates the competencies in Credit standard, and in addition provides evidence of analysis and critical thinking demonstrates an ability to evaluate develops a progressive, convincing, and clear argument throughout the work demonstrates selectivity and uses judgement in determining the importance of readings and ideas shows evidence of wide reading and synthesis of ideas utilises additional material to supplement information provided produces writing which is of a high literacy standard (structure, style, and referencing) Credit 60 - 69% The student demonstrates the competencies in Pass standard, and in addition demonstrates the understanding of concepts, theories, and issues is able to identify strengths and weaknesses in theories/readings and use these as a basis for evaluation is able to apply information to practices/situations develops a clear argument with rationale for assumptions integrates writing and demonstrates links between components will rarely, if ever show evidence of original work will tend to bring material to closure (tidy it up and make it fit a neat conclusion) provides a structured, sourced, and referenced work expresses him-/herself concisely and clearly and exhibits relatively error-free writing may rely heavily on the the text and assigned readings may sometimes lapse into description rather than providing analysis and evaluation Pass 50 - 59% The student: essentially demonstrates an understanding of concepts, theories, and issues but will tend to restate rather than evaluate does not transform data in terms of structure, synthesis ,or application relies extensively on text, or text and limited readings may demonstrate coverage which is sparse in places provides little or no evidence of critical analysis provides little or no evidence of research tends to use one limited approach possibly a narrow focus provides an acceptably sourced and referenced work but improvement may be necessary in structure and grammar Fail 0 - 49% The student may demonstrate some or all of the following failure to answer the question misinterpretation of the question failure to demonstrate understanding of the theory and concepts required failure to identify the problems or issues failure to provide evidence of reading the minimum requirements does not write to acceptable academic standards (structure and grammar require extensive improvement) sourcing and referencing may not be present or are very confused is not typed is not handed in on time Briohny's report Report Topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. EXECUTIVE SUMMARY "Macroenvironmental forces The larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment - demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces." - Kotler et al Macroenvironmental forces need to be studied by organisations as they can both provide opportunities and pose threats. The fast-food industry is a consumer service; two organisations that operate in the fast-food industry are McDonald's and Hungry Jack's. McDonald's was chosen because it is the primary operator in this market and holds the greatest market share. Hungry Jack's was chosen because the product they offer is the most similar to McDonald's. I thought it would be interesting to compare marketing strategies of two organisations that offer a fairly similar product. McDonald's is the market leader both in Australia and throughout the world. Hungry Jack's is positioned more as a market follower. Companies use target marketing to tailor for specific markets. There are three components involved in target marketing: market segmentation, market targeting and market positioning. McDonald's primary target markets are seniors, adults and teenagers however the most heavily targeted segment is children. Hungry Jack's also essentially segment their market using demographic variables. The final step in target marketing is developing a marketing mix. These tools are also known as the four P's and in the case of services, the seven P's. They are product, price, promotion, place, people, process and physical evidence. With the marketing mix of McDonald's compared to Hungry Jack's, the major difference is that McDonald's promote their product using the marketing mix more evenly. Hungry Jack's use many elements of the marketing mix similar to McDonald's, however they are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting the physical product. TABLE OF CONTENTS CONTENTS Title Page Executive Summary 1. Introduction 2. The Macroenvironment 2.1 Demographic forces 2.2 Economic Forces 2.3 Natural Forces 2.4 Technological Forces 2.5 Political Forces 2.6 Cultural Forces 3. Organisations Within the Fast-food Industry 3.1 Market Position 3.2 Target Markets 3.3 The Marketing Mix 3.1 3 Product 3.3.2 Price 3.3.3 Promotion 3.3.4 Place 3.3.5 People 3.3.6 Process 3.3.7 Physical Evidence 4. Conclusions References 1. INTRODUCTION "Marketed services (consumer services) - A market transaction by an enterprise of an entrepreneur where the object of the market transaction is other than the transfer of ownership (or title, if any) of a tangible commodity." - M. Gabbott, G. Hogg This assignment will focus specifically on the fast-food industry from within the consumer services area. "Fast-food - Serving foods that can be prepared quickly, such as hamburgers, frankfurters and fried chicken." - C. L. Barnhart, R. K. Barnhart The fast-food industry comprises both tangible and intangible components; for this reason the product/target market sits directly in the center of the Product-Service Continuum. If we use McDonald's as an example, the tangible component is the hamburger, fries or item which is purchased. While there is also an intangible element, this is things like the expected level of service from the staff, the ability to have a hamburger cooked "without pickles" if desired, the expected environment of the restaurant, etc. 2. THE MACROENVIRONMENT "The larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment - demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces." - Kotler et al. 2.1 Demographic Forces "The study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, occupation and other statistics." - Kotler et al. The demographic environment is of great importance to marketers as it involves the study of people, and it is people that make up markets. There are a number of demographic trends that are important to marketers. Some of these include: The changing age structure of the population - In Australia, one of the major changes in the age structure of the population is the decreasing birth rate and increase in the number of elderly people. This means that marketers in the fast-food industry (and other industries) are having to market their services and products at different target markets as many of the current markets are becoming smaller and smaller. For example, McDonald's have recently started aiming advertising campaigns at the elderly and offer free tea and coffee to the 60 plus age group. The changing family - Another trend in the demographic environment is the characteristics of families. No longer is mum, dad and 2.4 children the norm. The number of married couples with children is declining while the number of one person and single parent households is continuing to increase. Geographic shifts in population - As the population grows it also expands and shifts geographically. For fast-food services this means that they may need to shift location or open new stores to keep up with demand. Increasing ethnic diversity - Overseas immigration has led to an increase in not only population but also the ethnic diversity of Australia. The impact this has on a market such as the fast-food industry includes understanding different cultures and tastes; Hungry Jack's have introduced promotions like the "Satay burger" to cater for Asian tastes. 2.2 Economic Forces "Factors that affect consumer buying power and spending patterns" - Kotler et al. There are two key economic concerns for marketers; these are changes in income and changes in consumer spending patterns. Changes in income may indicate trends and explain slumps in sales for the fast-food industry. A drop in sales may be able to be explained by a depression in the market place, etc. Consumer spending patterns refer to how household income is divided between food, housing, transportation, etc. By monitoring changes in interest rates, unemployment, business and consumer confidence and retailing expenditure using economic forecasting fast-food outlets are less likely to be surprised by economic depressions or bursts of growth. Economic forces can be used to predict future sales rates and suggest the required number of service staff to have working at anytime. 2.3 Natural Forces "Natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or that are affected by marketing activities." - Kotler et al. There are four major concerns within the natural environment. Not all affect consumer services; however they can have an effect on the fast-food market as part of the product is tangible. These are: Shortages of raw materials - Many resources that once may have seemed to have an infinite supply are now seen as precious and greater efforts are being made to find alternatives or cut down usage. Some examples of these are: McDonald's use recycled paper to wrap their hamburgers, therefore reducing the amount of forestland that is cut down. Energy costs - As nonrenewable resources like oil and coal dwindle, prices of fast-food products are likely to increase as things like transportation costs rise. Some fast-food outlets may have to look for alternatives to how they cook their product; however, there should not be much effect on the service elements of the market. Increased pollution - Pollution has a major effect on how consumers view an organisation. These days an 'environmentally aware' company is likely to be more popular than one that is not. Increased pollution has already had effects on the fast-food market. In 1991 McDonald's changed its packaging from polystyrene boxes to paper in response to consumer demands for a more 'environmentally friendly' packaging. This makes up an important part of the 'service' element of the fast-food market; consumers receive the peace of mind that the product they are eating has had minimal effect on the environment. Government intervention - There are now controls in place to make sure organisations are doing minimal damage to the environment. Organisations in the fast-food industry can either oppose these regulations or help develop them. McDonald's sponsors' days like "Clean-up Australia Day" which also makes up an important part of the "service" element of the fast-food market, again showing that McDonald's is environmentally aware. 2.4 Technological Forces "Forces that affect new technologies, creating new product and market opportunities." - Kotler et al. Technology is often thought of as the greatest force affecting us now. It has allowed us to do things that were once only dreamed about and has created a number of new markets and marketing opportunities. There are a number of technological trends that should be monitored by marketers; these include: The fast pace of change - It is important for organisations to keep up with the fast pace of change, otherwise they will find they fall behind competition. A recent example of fast-food companies keeping up with technology is McDonald's installing EFTPOS machines in their stores, this additional service provided by McDonald's increases the value of the experience to the consumer. High research and development budgets - The fast-food industry would not spend as much on R and D as other organizations. Perhaps when McDonald's and Hungry Jack's, etc. were just starting out more funds would have been spent on improving techniques. However these days the techniques for producing the products and also the service has been perfected. Focus on minor improvements - Most of the improvements that are made tend to be only minor. Rather than gambling with big changes companies will only make small adjustments. Increased regulation - The majority of the recent improvements in technology (especially in the fast-food market) have been due to increases in regulations. Specific to the fast-food industry, an increase in health regulations has caused safety standards to become stricter. This has been good for consumers as it means they can enjoy the product knowing that the quality and service with which it is delivered is to the best possible standard. 2.5 Political Forces "Laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit various organizations and individuals in a given society." - Kotler et al. The decisions made by marketers can be strongly affected by the political environment. Recent examples of trends in the political environment include: increased regulation of business, the introduction of the GST would have had an effect on the fast-food market as prices of fast-food increased while other food products would remain the same. Due to this, fast-food outlets would place more emphasis on their service rather than the product, stressing that 'you can't get service like this at home', etc. to differentiate themselves. There is also a greater concern for ethics which companies have to be aware of. 2.6 Cultural Forces "Institutions and other forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions, preferences and behaviors." - Kotler et al. There are three major cultural forces that influence marketers: these are persistence of cultural values, subcultures and shifts in secondary cultural values. Of these, secondary cultural values has the greatest effect on the fast-food market. When the market is interested in convenience, they are more likely to buy fast food; if the market's secondary values suddenly shift and become interested in fitness and health, they will be less likely to buy fast food. All these factors are important to the fast-food market within Australia, however some are more applicable than others are. The demographic factors would have to be one of the most important factors, as stated previously - studying the demographic forces involves the study of the people that make up the market, and if you don't know your market you're in trouble. Technological factors are also fairly important to the fast-food market. In today's 'age of technology' it is important for an organisation to monitor advances in technology so it doesn't fall behind competitors. Technology is also a great tool to monitor all of the macroenvironmental forces. Of all the macroenvironmental forces these are probably the most important two, however it is also extremely important for fast-food organisations to be seen as environmentally responsible, ethically aware and politically correct. Part 2 3. ORGANISATIONS WITHIN THE FAST-FOOD INDUSTRY The two organisations I have chosen to discuss which operate in the fast-food industry are McDonald's and Hungry Jack's. I chose McDonald's because it is the primary operator in this market and holds the greatest market share. I chose Hungry Jack's because the product they offer is the most similar to McDonald's and I thought it would be interesting to compare marketing strategies of two organisations which offer a fairly similar product. 3.1 Market Position McDonald's market position both within Australia and throughout the world is the market leader. " Market leader The firm with the largest market share in an industry; it usually leads other firms in price changes, new product introductions, distribution coverage and promotion spending." - Kotler et al. Hungry Jack's, however, is positioned more as a market follower. " Market follower A runner-up firm in an industry that wants to hold its share without rocking the boat." - Kotler et al. Some may argue that Hungry Jack's is more of a market challenger than a follower, and that it is fighting to increase its market share. However, I feel that they don't really present any offers to challenge McDonald's, for example when McDonald's was offering 2 dollar burgers Hungry Jack's did nothing to counter this. 3.2 Target Markets "A set of buyers sharing common needs or characteristics that the company decides to serve." - Kotler et al. Companies use target marketing to tailor for specific markets. There are three components involved in target marketing that can be further broken down into six individual steps. These are: Market segmentation 1. Identify bases for segmenting the market 2. Develop profiles of resulting segments Market targeting - 3. Develop measures of segment attractiveness 4. Select the target segment(s) Market positioning 5. Develop positioning for each target segment 6. Develop marketing mix for each target segment - Kotler et al. McDonald's has based its segmentation on demographic variables (this is why demographic forces are so important to monitor). Most of the segments McDonald's targets are broken-down into age and lifestyle stage; this is probably because they are easily identifiable and consumer needs and wants vary closely with demographic variables. McDonald's primary target markets are seniors, adults and teenagers, but the most heavily targeted segment is children. Like McDonald's, Hungry Jack's essentially segment their market using demographic variables. They also segment their market into seniors, adults, teenagers and children. However, unlike McDonald's, they primarily target the teenagers and adults segments. 3.3 The Marketing Mix The final step in target marketing is developing a marketing mix. "Marketing Mix The set of controllable marketing variables that the company blends to produce the response it wants in the target market." - Kotler et al. These tools are also known as the four P's and in the case of services, the seven P's. They are product, price, promotion, place, people, process and physical evidence. 3.3.1 Product Product is defined as anything that satisfies a need or want. It is not necessarily a physical object; products can include goods, services, people, places and ideas (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 1). Products enable a company to differentiate itself from competitors and gain competitive advantage. Products can be positioned based on attributes, benefits offered, usage occasions, users, against or away from competitors, or based on the products class (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 6). Product is the most important element of the marketing mix. After all, if we didn't have the product the company would have no basis to exist. The products that McDonald's and Hungry Jack's sell are almost identical, therefore it is important for each organisation to distinguish the differences between the products to separate themselves from each other. Hungry Jack's uses the phrase "The burgers are better at Hungry Jack's" to suggest they have a superior tasting product. While McDonald's put more emphasis on the service of their staff and the overall experience not just the physical product. 3.3.2 Price Price is defined as the sum of values consumers' exchange for the benefits of having or using a product (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 9). Traditionally the major factor that affected buyer choice was price. Recently non-price factors such as service, guarantees, give-aways, loyalty programs and image have had a major influence. Price is a crucial part of the marketing mix as it is the only element that produces revenue; all other elements create costs. The three general approaches to pricing are the costbased approach (the price is based on reaching a target profit), the value-based approach (where the price is based on the buyer's perception of value) and the competitor-based approach (basing prices on competitors' prices). McDonald's constantly have "specials" such as the two-dollar burger which competitors find difficult to follow. As they are the market leader they obtain the largest revenue, so can afford to have these specials. McDonald's generally use a value-based approach to pricing, looking to give consumers the best value for money. Hungry Jack's use a more competitor-based approach to pricing. Being a market follower they tend to follow trends McDonald's set when they can afford to. 3.3.3 Promotion This is defined as "the whole array of methods and procedures by which the organization communicates with its target market" (Fifield, P.). Promotion can be accomplished using a number of different methods (advertising, publicity and public relations, direct marketing, sales promotion, sponsorship and personal selling). Promotion is used to achieve five objectives: build awareness, differentiate products and organisations from competitors, communicate the benefits of a product, build and maintain the overall image and reputation of an organisation, and persuade customers to buy a product. McDonald's has one of the best promotion methods of any organisation. They use a number of different methods to maintain high awareness and promote their image, including: advertising (television, radio, billboards, etc.), sponsorship (AFL, local basketball, Ronald House), sales promotion (e.g. the two-dollar burger), direct marketing (through birthday clubs, etc.) and publicity (McHappy Day). Hungry Jack's promotion efforts are not quite as ferocious. They tend to just maintain awareness through television advertising and billboards. They occasionally use sales promotion to persuade customers to try new products. Hungry Jack's also use direct marketing through 'Kids' Clubs'. 3.3.4 Place It is said that location is the key to attracting customers (Kotler et al). Looking at the location of a company there are a number of factors taken into account. These include: Who is the target market? Are they easily accessible from the location? Is the surrounding population likely to grow or decline? What is the surrounding competition? Place also refers to a company's image in the consumer's mind. The image is built through promotion and price, etc. The interior and exterior design of the store are also factors that help to build this image. McDonald's and Hungry Jack's have very similar "place" components. The locations and appearances of the stores would be hard to differentiate without signs telling consumers who they are. McDonald's, howeve,r holds a different place in the consumer's mind. This is due to the image built through promotion (price is fairly similar). McDonald's is seen more as a fun place for children through tools such as Ronald Mc Donald, while Hungry Jack's is seen more as merely a place to eat. 3.3.5 People There are two important aspects to this element: service personnel (those who provide the product and do the selling), and customers (those who purchase the product). "People" is an important component of the fast-food industry as it is a service industry. Both McDonald's and Hungry Jack's use their staff to emphasise a "friendly" environment and to promote the :"service" element of the product. Staff adopt the ideal that "the customer is always right". People are ultimately part of the product; therefore they must perform to customer expectations. This is an approach that is constant throughout any service industry. 3.3.6 Process Service marketers must examine processes involved in service delivery to identify ways in which a better service may be provided to the customer (Callaghan, McColl, and Palmer). Two aspects of the process element of the marketing mix are the degree of customer contact and quality control standards. McDonald's is the most innovative in terms of production processes. Examples of this are the recent installation of EFTPOS machines. Due to this Mc Donalds has been able to differentiate itself from competitors like Hungry Jack's. Both organisations have processes such as Drive-thru that is seen as a convenience and makes the product easier to consume. 3.3.7 Physical Evidence Physical evidence involves looking at each aspect the customer uses to assess a product to evaluate its position (Kotler et al). Physical evidence in this case is more personal. As the fast-food industry involves a tangible product as well as a service it is easier to judge. For McDonald's and Hungry Jack's a consumer is likely to judge aspects such as the quality of burger or product they bought. Aspects such as the appearance of staff and the store are also involved. In comparing the marketing mix of McDonald's and Hungry Jack's, the major difference is that McDonald's tend to promote its product through elements like service, price, people and process. They use the marketing mix more evenly. While Hungry Jack's do have many elements of the marketing mix similar to McDonald's, they are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting just the product. The main reason for this is to try to differentiate themselves from the market leader by showing they spend more time making sure the consumer receives a better product. 4. CONCLUSIONS Although all the forces in the macroenvironment have an effect on the fast-food market within Australia, some are more relevant than others. We can see the demographic factors are perhaps the most important factor, particularly for McDonald's and Hungry Jack's because their way of segmenting the market is based on demographic variables. Technological forces are also seen as fairly important to the fast-food market. In an 'age of technology' it is important for organisations to monitor advances in technology so they don't fall behind competitors, and are able to offer consumers the most current services. Technology is also a tool used to monitor all of the macroenvironmental forces. These are the most important two of all the macroenvironmental forces. It is also important for fast-food organisations to be seen as environmentally responsible, McDonald's are excellent in using this as a marketing tool, by sponsoring events like "Clean up Australia Day" the consumer sees them as a caring organisation. Hungry Jack's are not portrayed quite so strongly. When comparing McDonald's and Hungry Jack's marketing mix, the major difference is although Hungry Jack's and McDonald's have similar elements of the marketing mix McDonald's use the marketing mix more evenly. They promote their product through elements like service, price, people and process. Hungry Jack's are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting just the product. The reason for this is to differentiate themselves from the McDonald's by showing more time is taken, making sure consumers receive a higher quality product. REFERENCES Adam, S., Armstrong, G., Brown, L., Kotler, P., (1998), Marketing, (4th edn.), Prentice Hall, Australia. Barnhart, C. L., Barnhart, R. K., The World Book Dictionary: A-K, (1988), World Book Inc., Sydney. Bateson, J. E. G., Hoffman, K. D., Managing Services Marketing, (4th edn.), The Dryden Press, London. Callaghan, B., Mc Coll, R., Palmer, A., (1998), Services Marketing: A Managerial Perspective, The Mc Graw-Hill Book Company, Australia. Fifield, P., (1998), Marketing Strategy, (2nd edn.), Butterworth-Heinemann, Melbourne. Gabbott, M., Hogg, G., (1997), Contemporary Services Marketing Management, The Dryden Press, London. Walker, I., (2000), Marketing Theory and Practice, lectures, Monash University, Caulfield. McDonald's Corporate website, http://www.mcdonalds.com.au/ Briohny's report and what her lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. Executive summary "Macroenvironmental forces The larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment - demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces." - Kotler et al Macroenvironmental forces need to be studied by organisations as they can both provide opportunities and pose threats. The fast-food industry is a consumer service; two organisations that operate in the fast-food industry are McDonald's and Hungry Jack's. McDonald's was chosen because it is the primary operator in this market and holds the greatest market share. Hungry Jack's was chosen because the product they offer is the most similar to McDonald's. I thought it would be interesting to compare marketing strategies of two organisations that offer a fairly similar product. McDonald's is the market leader both in Australia and throughout the world. Hungry Jack's is positioned more as a market follower. [IMG-1] [1]Companies use target marketing to tailor for specific markets. There are three components involved in target marketing: market segmentation, market targeting and market positioning. McDonald's primary target markets are seniors, adults and teenagers however the most heavily targeted segment is children. Hungry Jack's also essentially segment their market using demographic variables. The final step in target marketing is developing a marketing mix. These tools are also known as the four P's and in the case of services, the seven P's. They are product, price, promotion, place, people, process and physical evidence. With the marketing mix of McDonald's compared to Hungry Jack's, the major difference is that McDonald's promote their product using the marketing mix more evenly. Hungry Jack's use many elements of the marketing mix similar to McDonald's, however they are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting the physical product. Table of contents CONTENTS Title Page Executive Summary 1. Introduction 2. The Macroenvironment 2.1 Demographic forces 2.2 Economic Forces 2.3 Natural Forces 2.4 Technological Forces 2.5 Political Forces 2.6 Cultural Forces 3. Organisations within the fast-food industry 3.1 Market Position 3.2 Target Markets 3.3 The Marketing Mix 3.1 3 Product 3.3.2 Price 3.3.3 Promotion 3.3.4 Place 3.3.5 People 3.3.6 Process 3.3.7 Physical Evidence 4. Conclusions References 1. Introduction "Marketed services (consumer services) - A market transaction by an enterprise of an entrepreneur where the object of the market transaction is other than the transfer of ownership (or title, if any) of a tangible commodity." - M. Gabbott, G. Hogg This assignment will focus specifically on the fast-food industry from within the consumer services area. "Fast-food - Serving foods that can be prepared quickly, such as hamburgers, frankfurters and fried chicken." - C. L. Barnhart, R. K. Barnhart The fast-food industry comprises both tangible and intangible components; for this reason the product/target market sits directly in the center of the Product-Service Continuum. If we use McDonald's as an example, the tangible component is the hamburger, fries or item which is purchased. While there is also an intangible element, this is things like the expected level of service from the staff, the ability to have a hamburger cooked "without pickles" if desired, the expected environment of the restaurant, etc. 2. The macroenvironment "The larger societal forces that affect the whole microenvironment - demographic, economic, natural, technological, political and cultural forces." - Kotler et al. 2.1 Demographic forces "The study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, occupation and other statistics." - Kotler et al. The demographic environment is of great importance to marketers as it involves the study of people, and it is people that make up markets. There are a number of demographic trends that are important to marketers. Some of these include: [IMG-2] [2]The changing age structure of the population - In Australia, one of the major changes in the age structure of the population is the decreasing birth rate and increase in the number of elderly people. This means that marketers in the fast-food industry (and other industries) are having to market their services and products at different target markets as many of the current markets are becoming smaller and smaller. For example, McDonald's have recently started aiming advertising campaigns at the elderly and offer free tea and coffee to the 60 plus age group. The changing family - Another trend in the demographic environment is the characteristics of families. No longer is mum, dad and 2.4 children the norm. The number of married couples with children is declining while the number of one person and single parent households is continuing to increase. [IMG-3] [3]Geographic shifts in population - As the population grows it also expands and shifts geographically. For fast-food services this means that they may need to shift location or open new stores to keep up with demand. Increasing ethnic diversity - Overseas immigration has led to an increase in not only population but also the ethnic diversity of Australia. The impact this has on a market such as the fast-food industry includes understanding different cultures and tastes; Hungry Jack's have introduced promotions like the "Satay burger" to cater for Asian tastes. 2.2 Economic forces "Factors that affect consumer buying power and spending patterns" - Kotler et al. There are two key economic concerns for marketers; these are changes in income and changes in consumer spending patterns. Changes in income may indicate trends and explain slumps in sales for the fast-food industry. A drop in sales may be able to be explained by a depression in the market place, etc. Consumer spending patterns refer to how household income is divided between food, housing, transportation, etc. By monitoring changes in interest rates, unemployment, business and consumer confidence and retailing expenditure using economic forecasting fast-food outlets are less likely to be surprised by economic depressions or bursts of growth. Economic forces can be used to predict future sales rates and suggest the required number of service staff to have working at anytime. 2.3 Natural forces "Natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or that are affected by marketing activities." - Kotler et al. There are four major concerns within the natural environment. Not all affect consumer services; however they can have an effect on the fast-food market as part of the product is tangible. These are: Shortages of raw materials - Many resources that once may have seemed to have an infinite supply are now seen as precious and greater efforts are being made to find alternatives or cut down usage. Some examples of these are: McDonald's use recycled paper to wrap their hamburgers, therefore reducing the amount of forestland that is cut down. Energy costs - As nonrenewable resources like oil and coal dwindle, prices of fast-food products are likely to increase as things like transportation costs rise. Some fast-food outlets may have to look for alternatives to how they cook their product; however, there should not be much effect on the service elements of the market. Increased pollution - Pollution has a major effect on how consumers view an organisation. These days an 'environmentally aware' company is likely to be more popular than one that is not. Increased pollution has already had effects on the fast-food market. In 1991 McDonald's changed its packaging from polystyrene boxes to paper in response to consumer demands for a more 'environmentally friendly' packaging. This makes up an important part of the 'service' element of the fast-food market; consumers receive the peace of mind that the product they are eating has had minimal effect on the environment. Government intervention - There are now controls in place to make sure organisations are doing minimal damage to the environment. Organisations in the fast-food industry can either oppose these regulations or help develop them. McDonald's sponsors' days like "Clean-up Australia Day" which also makes up an important part of the "service" element of the fast-food market, again showing that McDonald's is environmentally aware. 2.4 Technological forces "Forces that affect new technologies, creating new product and market opportunities." - Kotler et al. Technology is often thought of as the greatest force affecting us now. It has allowed us to do things that were once only dreamed about and has created a number of new markets and marketing opportunities. There are a number of technological trends that should be monitored by marketers; these include: The fast pace of change - It is important for organisations to keep up with the fast pace of change, otherwise they will find they fall behind competition. A recent example of fast-food companies keeping up with technology is McDonald's installing EFTPOS machines in their stores, this additional service provided by McDonald's increases the value of the experience to the consumer. High research and development budgets - The fast-food industry would not spend as much on R and D as other organizations. Perhaps when McDonald's and Hungry Jack's, etc. were just starting out more funds would have been spent on improving techniques. However these days the techniques for producing the products and also the service has been perfected. Focus on minor improvements - Most of the improvements that are made tend to be only minor. Rather than gambling with big changes companies will only make small adjustments. Increased regulation - The majority of the recent improvements in technology (especially in the fast-food market) have been due to increases in regulations. Specific to the fast-food industry, an increase in health regulations has caused safety standards to become stricter. This has been good for consumers as it means they can enjoy the product knowing that the quality and service with which it is delivered is to the best possible standard. 2.5 Political forces "Laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit various organizations and individuals in a given society." - Kotler et al. The decisions made by marketers can be strongly affected by the political environment. Recent examples of trends in the political environment include: increased regulation of business, the introduction of the GST would have had an effect on the fast-food market as prices of fast-food increased while other food products would remain the same. Due to this, fast-food outlets would place more emphasis on their service rather than the product, stressing that 'you can't get service like this at home', etc. to differentiate themselves. There is also a greater concern for ethics which companies have to be aware of. 2.6 Cultural forces "Institutions and other forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions, preferences and behaviors." - Kotler et al. There are three major cultural forces that influence marketers: these are persistence of cultural values, subcultures and shifts in secondary cultural values. Of these, secondary cultural values has the greatest effect on the fast-food market. When the market is interested in convenience, they are more likely to buy fast food; if the market's secondary values suddenly shift and become interested in fitness and health, they will be less likely to buy fast food. All these factors are important to the fast-food market within Australia, however some are more applicable than others are. The demographic factors would have to be one of the most important factors, as stated previously - studying the demographic forces involves the study of the people that make up the market, and if you don't know your market you're in trouble. Technological factors are also fairly important to the fast-food market. In today's 'age of technology' it is important for an organisation to monitor advances in technology so it doesn't fall behind competitors. Technology is also a great tool to monitor all of the macroenvironmental forces. Of all the macroenvironmental forces these are probably the most important two, however it is also extremely important for fast-food organisations to be seen as environmentally responsible, ethically aware and politically correct. Part 2 3. Organisations Within The Fast-food Industry The two organisations I have chosen to discuss which operate in the fast-food industry are McDonald's and Hungry Jack's. I chose McDonald's because it is the primary operator in this market and holds the greatest market share. I chose Hungry Jack's because the product they offer is the most similar to McDonald's and I thought it would be interesting to compare marketing strategies of two organisations which offer a fairly similar product. 3.1 Market position McDonald's market position both within Australia and throughout the world is the market leader. " Market leader The firm with the largest market share in an industry; it usually leads other firms in price changes, new product introductions, distribution coverage and promotion spending." - Kotler et al. Hungry Jack's, however, is positioned more as a market follower. " Market follower A runner-up firm in an industry that wants to hold its share without rocking the boat." - Kotler et al. [IMG-4] [4]Some may argue that Hungry Jack's is more of a market challenger than a follower, and that it is fighting to increase its market share. However, I feel that they don't really present any offers to challenge McDonald's, for example when McDonald's was offering 2 dollar burgers Hungry Jack's did nothing to counter this. 3.2 Target markets "A set of buyers sharing common needs or characteristics that the company decides to serve." - Kotler et al. Companies use target marketing to tailor for specific markets. There are three components involved in target marketing that can be further broken down into six individual steps. These are: Market segmentation 1. Identify bases for segmenting the market 2. Develop profiles of resulting segments Market targeting - 3. Develop measures of segment attractiveness 4. Select the target segment(s) Market positioning 5. Develop positioning for each target segment 6. Develop marketing mix for each target segment - Kotler et al. McDonald's has based its segmentation on demographic variables (this is why demographic forces are so important to monitor). Most of the segments McDonald's targets are broken-down into age and lifestyle stage; this is probably because they are easily identifiable and consumer needs and wants vary closely with demographic variables. McDonald's primary target markets are seniors, adults and teenagers, but the most heavily targeted segment is children. [IMG-5] [5]Like McDonald's, Hungry Jack's essentially segment their market using demographic variables. They also segment their market into seniors, adults, teenagers and children. However, unlike McDonald's, they primarily target the teenagers and adults segments. 3.3 The marketing mix The final step in target marketing is developing a marketing mix. "Marketing Mix The set of controllable marketing variables that the company blends to produce the response it wants in the target market." - Kotler et al. These tools are also known as the four P's and in the case of services, the seven P's. They are product, price, promotion, place, people, process and physical evidence. 3.3.1 Product Product is defined as anything that satisfies a need or want. It is not necessarily a physical object; products can include goods, services, people, places and ideas (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 1). Products enable a company to differentiate itself from competitors and gain competitive advantage. Products can be positioned based on attributes, benefits offered, usage occasions, users, against or away from competitors, or based on the products class (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 6). Product is the most important element of the marketing mix. After all, if we didn't have the product the company would have no basis to exist. [IMG-6] [6]The products that McDonald's and Hungry Jack's sell are almost identical, therefore it is important for each organisation to distinguish the differences between the products to separate themselves from each other. Hungry Jack's uses the phrase "The burgers are better at Hungry Jack's" to suggest they have a superior tasting product. While McDonald's put more emphasis on the service of their staff and the overall experience not just the physical product. 3.3.2 Price Price is defined as the sum of values consumers' exchange for the benefits of having or using a product (Walker. I., 2000, Marketing Theory and Practice, lecture 9). Traditionally the major factor that affected buyer choice was price. Recently non-price factors such as service, guarantees, give-aways, loyalty programs and image have had a major influence. Price is a crucial part of the marketing mix as it is the only element that produces revenue; all other elements create costs. The three general approaches to pricing are the costbased approach (the price is based on reaching a target profit), the value-based approach (where the price is based on the buyer's perception of value) and the competitor-based approach (basing prices on competitors' prices). McDonald's constantly have "specials" such as the two-dollar burger which competitors find difficult to follow. As they are the market leader they obtain the largest revenue, so can afford to have these specials. McDonald's generally use a value-based approach to pricing, looking to give consumers the best value for money. Hungry Jack's use a more competitor-based approach to pricing. Being a market follower they tend to follow trends McDonald's set when they can afford to. 3.3.3 Promotion This is defined as "the whole array of methods and procedures by which the organization communicates with its target market" (Fifield, P.). Promotion can be accomplished using a number of different methods (advertising, publicity and public relations, direct marketing, sales promotion, sponsorship and personal selling). Promotion is used to achieve five objectives: build awareness, differentiate products and organisations from competitors, communicate the benefits of a product, build and maintain the overall image and reputation of an organisation, and persuade customers to buy a product. [IMG-7] [7]McDonald's has one of the best promotion methods of any organisation. They use a number of different methods to maintain high awareness and promote their image, including: advertising (television, radio, billboards, etc.), sponsorship (AFL, local basketball, Ronald House), sales promotion (e.g. the two-dollar burger), direct marketing (through birthday clubs, etc.) and publicity (McHappy Day). Hungry Jack's promotion efforts are not quite as ferocious. They tend to just maintain awareness through television advertising and billboards. They occasionally use sales promotion to persuade customers to try new products. Hungry Jack's also use direct marketing through 'Kids' Clubs'. 3.3.4 Place It is said that location is the key to attracting customers (Kotler et al). Looking at the location of a company there are a number of factors taken into account. These include: Who is the target market? Are they easily accessible from the location? Is the surrounding population likely to grow or decline? What is the surrounding competition? Place also refers to a company's image in the consumer's mind. The image is built through promotion and price, etc. The interior and exterior design of the store are also factors that help to build this image. McDonald's and Hungry Jack's have very similar "place" components. The locations and appearances of the stores would be hard to differentiate without signs telling consumers who they are. McDonald's, howeve,r holds a different place in the consumer's mind. This is due to the image built through promotion (price is fairly similar). McDonald's is seen more as a fun place for children through tools such as Ronald Mc Donald, while Hungry Jack's is seen more as merely a place to eat. 3.3.5 People There are two important aspects to this element: service personnel (those who provide the product and do the selling), and customers (those who purchase the product). "People" is an important component of the fast-food industry as it is a service industry. Both McDonald's and Hungry Jack's use their staff to emphasise a "friendly" environment and to promote the :"service" element of the product. Staff adopt the ideal that "the customer is always right". People are ultimately part of the product; therefore they must perform to customer expectations. This is an approach that is constant throughout any service industry. 3.3.6 Process Service marketers must examine processes involved in service delivery to identify ways in which a better service may be provided to the customer (Callaghan, McColl, and Palmer). Two aspects of the process element of the marketing mix are the degree of customer contact and quality control standards. McDonald's is the most innovative in terms of production processes. Examples of this are the recent installation of EFTPOS machines. Due to this Mc Donalds has been able to differentiate itself from competitors like Hungry Jack's. Both organisations have processes such as Drive-thru that is seen as a convenience and makes the product easier to consume. 3.3.7 Physical evidence Physical evidence involves looking at each aspect the customer uses to assess a product to evaluate its position (Kotler et al). Physical evidence in this case is more personal. As the fast-food industry involves a tangible product as well as a service it is easier to judge. For McDonald's and Hungry Jack's a consumer is likely to judge aspects such as the quality of burger or product they bought. Aspects such as the appearance of staff and the store are also involved. In comparing the marketing mix of McDonald's and Hungry Jack's, the major difference is that McDonald's tend to promote its product through elements like service, price, people and process. They use the marketing mix more evenly. While Hungry Jack's do have many elements of the marketing mix similar to McDonald's, they are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting just the product. The main reason for this is to try to differentiate themselves from the market leader by showing they spend more time making sure the consumer receives a better product. 4. Conclusions Although all the forces in the macroenvironment have an effect on the fast-food market within Australia, some are more relevant than others. We can see the demographic factors are perhaps the most important factor, particularly for McDonald's and Hungry Jack's because their way of segmenting the market is based on demographic variables. Technological forces are also seen as fairly important to the fast-food market. In an 'age of technology' it is important for organisations to monitor advances in technology so they don't fall behind competitors, and are able to offer consumers the most current services. Technology is also a tool used to monitor all of the macroenvironmental forces. These are the most important two of all the macroenvironmental forces. It is also important for fast-food organisations to be seen as environmentally responsible, McDonald's are excellent in using this as a marketing tool, by sponsoring events like "Clean up Australia Day" the consumer sees them as a caring organisation. Hungry Jack's are not portrayed quite so strongly. [IMG-8] [8]When comparing McDonald's and Hungry Jack's marketing mix, the major difference is although Hungry Jack's and McDonald's have similar elements of the marketing mix McDonald's use the marketing mix more evenly. They promote their product through elements like service, price, people and process. Hungry Jack's are not as heavily promoted and are more interested in promoting just the product. The reason for this is to differentiate themselves from the McDonald's by showing more time is taken, making sure consumers receive a higher quality product. [IMG-9] [9] [Lecturer's overall comment] References [IMG-10] [10]Adam, S., Armstrong, G., Brown, L., Kotler, P., (1998), Marketing, (4th edn.), Prentice Hall, Australia. Barnhart, C.L. & Barnhart, R.K. (1998). The world book dictionary: A-K. Sydney: World Book Inc. Bateson, J. E. G. & Hoffman, K. D. (1999). Managing services marketing (4th ed.). London: The Dryden Press. Callaghan, B., Mc Coll, R. & Palmer, A. (1998). Services marketing: A managerial perspective. Sydney: The McGraw-Hill Book Company. Fifield, P. (1998). Marketing strategy (2nd ed.). Melbourne: Butterworth-Heinemann. Gabbott, M. & Hogg, G. (1997). Contemporary services marketing management. London: The Dryden Press. Walker, I. (2000). Marketing theory and practice [PowerPoint slides]. Retrieved from MGF1 100/2100, Monash University Studies Online: https://my.monash.edu.au/muso/blackboard/login/ <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/https://my.monash.edu.au/muso/blackboard/login/> [IMG-11] [11]McDonald's Corporate website, http://www.mcdonalds.com.au/ [1] Needs to be more precise This is probably the student's first attempt at an executive summary and as such is OK - but too like an introduction. For a report of this length, a summary of around half a page would be expected. It's important to remember that an executive summary may be the only part of the report that senior management reads; thus, it needs to be direct and concise, stating clearly the report's findings. Statements about the process of writing (e.g. why the student chose the companies) are not relevant here. [2] Good This is actually an example of changing target markets with the aim to grow the whole market; but it's a nicely chosen example, nonetheless - current and relevant. [3] Elaborate point This point needs elaboration. Part of the skill being assessed is the student's ability to notice - and eventually predict - trends. So, are new stores opening in the city, the suburbs; fewer in rural areas? Etc. [4] Evidence? In an academic or professional report, your reader is not interested in feelings. The student needs to provide more substantial evidence here. It's a large claim (which may well be correct) and requires something on a larger scale - and from appropriate sources - to support it. [5] Ref? If the reader is to appreciate that this is more than guesswork, the student needs to provide a reference for the way the company segments its market. Note that a reference would not be required for the first point: that they both use demographic variables. [6] But there are differences What the student says may be true, but she should not waste the opportunity to consider what may be a significant difference in product. The differences between the burgers would reflect target market differences, e.g. positioning a burger as superior because it's flame grilled. [7] Good - but target market? This is a carefully observed comment about the differences, but would have been strengthened by some follow-up on the final point: how does the direct marketing relate to the target market? [8] More evenly? This expression is not very helpful. It does not help explain the differences. It's important in a conclusion to treat the major points of the report at a general level, but also not to sacrifice accuracy and significant distinctions: the perceptive observations made in the course of the report should not be lost. [9] Lecturer's overall comment This report received a Distinction. The student has shown some good insight into marketing and how it is influenced by the macroenvironment. This section would have been further improved by more specific examples from the fast food industry. The two organisations are well chosen: Yes, there are many similarities as both of them two use similar strategies (in terms of the 7 Ps); but more could be extracted from focusing on the differences between the two. Use specific examples - and relate to marketing theory. [10] Kotler, P., Armstrong, G., Brown, L. & Adam, S. (1998). Marketing (4th ed.). Sydney: Prentice Hall. (Primary author to be listed first) [11] McDonald's. (n.d.). Retrieved Month Day,Year, from http://www.mcdonalds.com.au <www.mcdonalds.com.au> (Include date on the webpage/document where provided, otherwise type "n.d." to indicate no date was available; also include date retrieved) Troy's assignment Troy is a first-year Marketing student. For his first assignment in the subject, Troy chose to focus on the fast food industry. Report topic: Select a specific product/target market from within the broad areas identified below and: 1. Discuss how the macroenvironmental variables have had an impact on this market making sure you show that you understand all the macroenvironmental variables that are likely to have an impact. 2. Identify two different marketing mixes used by two different companies to target the market you have identified. Use examples to support your discussion where appropriate. 1. Look at the lecturer's expectations <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.4.1.xml> of the assignment. 2. Next read Troy's report <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.4.2.xml> . o How well do you think the report responds to the topic? o Do you think the report could be improved in any way? 3. Now read the lecturer's comments <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/writing/businesseconomics/marketing/3.4.3.xml> about Troy's report. Lecturer's expectations In this section, one of your lecturers - Ian Walker - sets out what he expects from student assignments on this topic. Assignment 2 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. What the lecturer expects 1. Assignment Topic Areas <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#topic> 2. Guidelines <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#guidelines> 3. Additional notes <www.monash.edu/lls/llonline/#additional-notes> Assignment topic areas: TOURISM Product/Target Market: Backpackers, Retirees, Families ELECTRONIC COMMERCE Product/Target Market: Books, Wine, Music(MP3), Software FAST MOVING CONSUMER GOODS Product/Target Market: - Breakfast cereal for Children (under 12years) CONSUMER SERVICES Product/Target Market: - Movies, Consumer Banking Word limit 3,000 words Assessment for Assignment 2 (25%) divided equally between both parts of the assessment. Guidelines Part 1 asks you to: Briefly identify and explain the macro forces discussed by Kotler. Then identify and discuss in more detail the macro forces that are most applicable to the product/market area that you have selected. You must explain why you think they are applicable, how they impact the product/market area, and give appropriate examples to illustrate your understanding. Part 2 asks you to: Select two organisations that operate in the product/target market that you have chosen. Identify and detail the marketing mix (i.e. 4 and P's) they use to target this product/target market. Discuss the differences and the similarities between the two organisations' marketing mixes. Why do these differences exist or not exist? What other insight can you get into these organisations and how they use marketing for this industry? You are expected to develop the information yourself, being guided by whatever hard information you are able to find. You should read widely in Kotler et al. and other texts about what is required in a theoretical way, and you should observe closely what is actually happening with your chosen product(s) in the marketplace. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES ARE YOU TO CONTACT COMPANIES IN YOUR CHOSEN INDUSTRY FOR INFORMATION. Additional notes 1. This assignment is to be done on an INDIVIDUAL basis. (They are not GROUP assignments.) The work submitted must be your own. You must acknowledge the sources of your information. 2. The assignment must be typed, and well presented. Because it is intended to prepare you for the final examination, it must be written in business REPORT format/style. You may, however, use subheadings and bullet-points where appropriate within the report. You may also incorporate graphs, tables, diagrams, and figures into the body of the report if you wish. (If lengthy, material of this kind may be attached as appendices.) 3. In Assignment 2 you MUST include a bibliography. This should be on a separate page. FULL details are required - name and initials of all authors, full title, publisher, place, and date of publication. At this level of study, you must get these details right! See the Faculty's Q Manual (http://www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/) <www.buseco.monash.edu.au/publications/qmanual/> or any of the other good style guides in the libraries. 4. The word limit for the first assignment is 2,000 words. You will not be penalised for exceeding these limits - within reason (say 10%) - provided that there is no repetitiveness, irrelevance, or "padding". Similarly, you will not be penalised for being under the word limit, provided that the question has been fully and satisfactorily answered. 5. Although you are encouraged to seek a greater understanding of the issues raised in this assignment by discussing them with business practitioners of your personal acquaintance, you are NOT permitted to make unsolicited contact with business organisations to obtain information. Assignment and exam assessment criteria High Distinction 80 - 100% The student demonstrates the competencies in Distinction standard, and in addition uses creative examples, possible extensions, and applications of theory demonstrates originality makes defensible generalisations draws conclusions which lend themselves to further research writes to a publishable standard is aware of limitations Distinction 70 - 79% The student demonstrates the competencies in Credit standard, and in addition provides evidence of analysis and critical thinking demonstrates an ability to evaluate develops a progressive, convincing, and clear argument throughout the work demonstrates selectivity and uses judgement in determining the importance of readings and ideas shows evidence of wide reading and synthesis of ideas utilises additional material to supplement information provided produces writing which is of a high literacy standard (structure, style, and referencing) Credit 60 - 69% The student demonstrates the competencies in Pass standard, and in addition demonstrates the understanding of concepts, theories, and issues is able to identify strengths and weaknesses in theories/readings and use these as a basis for evaluation is able to apply information to practices/situations develops a clear argument with rationale for assumptions integrates writing and demonstrates links between components will rarely, if ever show evidence of original work will tend to bring material to closure (tidy it up and make it fit a neat conclusion) provides a structured, sourced, and referenced work expresses him-/herself concisely and clearly and exhibits relatively error-free writing may rely heavily on the the text and assigned readings may sometimes lapse into description rather than providing analysis and evaluation Pass 50 - 59% The student: essentially demonstrates an understanding of concepts, theories, and issues but will tend to restate rather than evaluate does not transform data in terms of structure, synthesis ,or application relies extensively on text, or text and limited readings may demonstrate coverage which is sparse in places provides little or no evidence of critical analysis provides little or no evidence of research tends to use one limited approach possibly a narrow focus provides an acceptably sourced and referenced work but improvement may be necessary in structure and grammar Fail 0 - 49% The student may demonstrate some or all of the following failure to answer the question misinterpretation of the question failure to demonstrate understanding of the theory and concepts required failure to identify the problems or issues failure to provide evidence of reading the minimum requirements does not write to acceptable academic standards (structure and grammar require extensive improvement) sourcing and referencing may not be present or are very confused is not typed is not handed in on time Troy's report Assignment 2 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. Index 1 Cover page 2 Index page 3-8 Part 1 ' The macroenvironment 8-14 Part 2 ' The marketing mix 15 Bibliography Inroduction Within this report the macro-forces of an industry will be analysed, continuing on to compare the marketing mix of two organisations within that industry. All organisations - with their suppliers, customers, competitors, and publics - have a macroenvironment. This environment consists of macro forces that act on and affect the organisation and are generally outside their control, as opposed to the micro forces which also affect the organisation, but are generally under their control. The marketing mix is the term used to describe how an organisation goes about developing a product and selling it to the market. The industry chosen is soft drinks which industry falls into the category of fast-moving-consumable-goods (FMCG's), as it is a product that is consumed, and is fast-moving. These won't sit in a supermarket or convenient store for long, as they are constantly being purchased. Other examples of a 'FMCG' are canned foods, ice cream, soup, cereal, potato chips and a whole lot more. Part 1 There are six main macro forces making up the "macroenvironment." These are: The demographic environment - which is the study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, and occupation 1. Studies in this area, for example, can show the changing age structure, which is necessary, as marketeers need to understand who makes up the market, thus allowing them to make the most effective decisions for the marketing mix. The economic environment ' which has an effect on consumer purchasing power and spending. For example, if the average income drops, then there is likely to be less buying power 2. The natural environment ' involves natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or which are affected by marketing activities 3. An example of this is the non-renewable resource, where companies will face increasing prices, as the shortage becomes more of a problem. Also natural disasters can cause a sudden change in needs. The technological environment ' this can create new markets and opportunities, as well as replace older ones. It can be of great benefit to society, but also of great disaster e.g guns 4. The political environment ' consists of laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit organisations 5. An example of this is the new legislation passed that now products need to label all information, including how they are made. And the cultural environment ' which is made up of institutions and other forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions, preferences, and behaviours 6. An example is of people who are patriotic and may only buy products manufactured by their own country as they believe it's for the better. An organisation must carefully watch and respond to changes in these forces as they all can shape opportunities and also create threats. The ways in which the macroenvironment may effect the soft drink industry will now be discussed with reference to the above definition. It isn't necessary to assume that all these macro forces will have an obvious effect on the industry, however it's more than likely most of them will. Demography can and will affect the soft drink industry in several ways. Youths and young adults are definitely the age group that makes up the majority of consumers in this industry. There has been a decline in the young adults group during the 1990's as a result of the reduced fertility of the 1970's 7. The youth group (1019) dropped through the early 90's but will begin to increase again around the turn of the century. This is important information for marketers, as they can understand why or why not sales are changing. The early middle age group and older are also likely to purchase soft drinks. With the newer "diet" and "caffeine free" products, more of these older groups are able to enjoy soft drinks. However these older groups don't make up a great deal of the purchasing power for soft drinks. The population is becoming more educated. Soft drinks aren't considered healthy, and as more and more people learn of the problems associated with eating and drinking bad foods that rot teeth, it may be likely to have an effect on the soft drink industry. Within the soft drink industry is a range of products with varying prices. Although the cheap brands may be only be a dollar cheaper, this can become much more attractive than the image brought with the more expensive brands, in times of economic struggle. It is suggested that the average income through the 1990's is slowly increasing 8. To make sense of this we would assume then that the middle socioeconomic class would be able to afford the better brands, more so than in the past. However, will this affect soft drinks? Where parents buy for their children it may, but also for the young adults who may be earning more, it may not. The natural environment has had an impact on what we do with the cans and bottles once they're finished with, and that's recycling. This overcomes any worry that consumers may have for the environment, especially seeing as concerns for the environment have been growing more and more. Manufacturers, therefore, need to lend their support to recycling and show their care for the environment. Over the past decade we have seen many variations of one flavour invented, and then many more flavours too. Such ones include "diet" and "caffeine free" to attract the more healthy conscious, many fruity-flavoured soft drinks, and many more. This is related to the technology environment, and what we see here is the industry using the developments in technology to provide more variations to gain a greater market. There have been many developments in the bottling, to suit image, such as Coca-Cola's slick shape, the different sizes, which again give more variations, and the ability to recycle. With computer technology we can now shop over the Internet. Some may choose to purchase soft drinks, however this kind of technology is unlikely to boost sales significantly. Products need to be practical and affordable, and technology processes allow for more efficient production of packaging, and for them to be more practical, which relates back to the size and ability to recycle. The political environment will have had little impact on the soft drink industry except in the area of legislation. Such examples include the labelling of ingredients. The growing concern for the environment also comes under the topic of cultures. For it is becoming a value for the people of Australia, and also the world, to be more aware of the environment. However, cultures have many more influences, like people's views about themselves, which can affect the industry. One of the bigger organisations in the industry, Coca-Cola, promotes that there is an image associated with drinking their product. People use products as a means of self-expression 9 so they buy what will make them feel good. Buying a cheap brand cola may not allow someone to feel :"cool" or comfortable with the people around them. Some, however, don't care about others' opinions on such an issue and will be comfortable drinking cheap brand cola in public. However, it is noted that this "me society"' is on the way out. Thus, indulging in all the good things is becoming a less common thing and is changing to a "we society". However, this change may have no effect on the soft drink industry but only increase the need to buy the better brands. One recent ad shows scenes where huge groups of people are drinking their soft drink on the beach, which displays that it's a social drink. Soft drink organisations are amongst some of the most common organisations that sponsor large events, mainly sporting ones. These include Coca-Cola, Sprite, Pepsi, and many more. This encourages people's view of the organisation to be positive, as people are expecting more from large organisations to help society. So we can see that the macroenvironment for the soft drink industry has a lot of areas to cover - most of them always relating back to the people, as it's the people who make up the markets. Also, although they are macro forces, companies still take an environmental management perspective. That is, taking an aggressive action to influence forces the way they want. In the soft drink industry these forces are mostly all positive and therefore can benefit the consumers. Part 2 The two organisations chosen to analyse their marketing mixes are Coca-Cola, and Pepsi, within the soft drink industry. Coca-Cola is the leading manufacturer, marketer, and distributor of non-alcoholic beverages with Pepsi Co following second. Firstly, we will look at how Coca-Cola has used their marketing mix. The marketing mix is divided up into 4 parts; product, price, promotions and place. Firstly, the product. The product (Coca-Cola soft drink) includes not just the liquid inside but also the packaging. On the product-service continuum we see that a soft drink provides little service, apart from the convenience. Soft drinks satisfy the need of thirst. However, people are always different, some want more and others want less. Therefore Coca-Cola have made allowances for that by providing many sizes. We also have particular tastes, and again they have provided several options. So, although thirst is what is needed to be satisfied and that is the core benefit, we are receiving other benefits in the taste and size. This is all related to the product line, which is a term used to describe a group of products that are closely related because they function in a similar manner, are sold to the same customer groups, and marketed the same 10. Coca-Cola has developed several different flavours and sizes as mentioned above, but also several brands such as Sprite, Lift, Fanta and Diet Coke which increase the product line length, thus making full use of the market to maximise sales. Coca-Cola, however, also aims to create an image about the product. In this case they want it to be a social drink, one that you would have when having a good time. So when we go and buy Coca-Cola, we are not only relieving thirst but taking on an image and an idea. "We are going to a party ' we have to get Coca-Cola". Through promotion people now have the idea that it's only cool to drink Coca-Cola, and to be seen with anything else is cheap. One of their advertising campaigns highlighted the point of enjoying Coca-Cola, thus displaying how the product is not just about satisfying thirst, but also you need to enjoy drinking it. The product is convenient 11, that is - bought frequently, immediately, and with a minimum of comparison and buying effort 12. The appearance 13 of the product is eye catching with the bright red colour. It has a uniquely designed bottle shape that fits in your hand better, and creates a nicer ' more futuristic look. The quality of the soft drink is needed to be regularly high. Sealed caps ensure that none of the "fizz" is lost. The bottles are light, with flexible packaging, so they won't crack or leak, and are not too heavy to casually walk around with. The cans are also light and safe. All these factors are a part of the product, from the drink to the image. And through promotions Coca-Cola aims to create an attractiveness for this. Some of their advertisements show beach scenes, which allow the viewer to relate Coca-Cola and fun together. They have immense advertisement schemes, always creating new ideas and flooding the TV with Coca-Cola, mostly enhancing their image of being socially accepted and fun. Coca-Cola uses the "pull strategy" in their promotion. That is, they promote to the consumers to create the want for their product which in turn creates a demand on the retailers and then back to them. For example, in supermarkets and convenience stores Coca-Cola has their own fridge which contains only their products. There is little personal selling, but that is made up for in public relations and corporate image. Coca-Cola sponsors a lot of events including sports and recreational activities. All these are used to create awareness of the product. They also use competitions, such as check under the lid for an instant prize, to encourage consumers to buy their product over the competition's products. Coca-Cola promotions then create knowledge and liking about the product through campaigns that show that it has the best taste, is the most popular and is the one of the future, whilst appealing to a large range of audiences. Coca-Cola floods all possible retailing stores in satisfying the third part, place. In supermarkets and convenient stores Coca-Cola products are always easy to identify, and usually make up the greater proportion of options to buy. This increases their market exposure 14 through effective use of the retailers. For a FMCG it is important that they can be found and purchased easily. With the many automatic can machines located in many sports stadiums and shopping malls, you don't even need to go to a store to buy a drink. This greatly enhances the speed of purchase 15. Pricing strategy is the last area of the marketing mix. Coca-Cola products would appear, on the shelf, to have the most expensive range of soft drinks common to supermarkets, at almost double the cost of no name brands. This can be for several reasons apart from just to cover the extra costs of promotions, for which no name brands do without. It creates consumer perceptions and values. When people buy Coca-Cola they are not just buying the beverage but also the image that goes with it, therefore to have the price higher reiterates the fact that the product is of a better quality than the rest and that the consumer is not cheap. This is known as value-based pricing and is used by many other industries in attracting consumers. Now we can compare the above marketing mix to that of Pepsi Co. They both would use market segmentation and positioning, however even before the marketing mix is analysed we can see differences here. Market segmentation is the term used to describe the first step organisations take in deciding who they are going to sell the product too. The segmentation used by Pepsi and Coca-Cola is likely to be under the psychographic section, using values and attitudes. This means that within the many different values and attitudes that people have, Coca-Cola and Pepsi aim to choose a few and target their product towards them. They both aim towards creating an image associated with their products, however they target different types. For example, Coca-Cola is shown to be a more outgoing and group orientated image, whereas Pepsi focus more on the individual and less outgoing. This is an example of market positioning. As trying to compete in the exact same area will only result in fewer sales for each, they try to obtain their own part of the market segment 16 . Diagram 1: An example of market positioning. Looking at the marketing mix, we will now compare how Pepsi go about it as opposed to Coca-Cola. As they are both very similar, in that they are the two largest manufacturers of soft drink, they compete for market share constantly, but in different ways. This is shown in the first section of the marketing mix ' product as discussed above. Just as Coca-Cola have aimed to create an image about their product that will encourage you to buy, so too have Pepsi. However Pepsi have a different image associated with their product. As mentioned when talking about market positioning, Pepsi look less to the outgoing groups, and focus on the individuals and also introversive people. A lot of their campaigns in the past are associated with sports, many of which were individual sports. They had promotions that showed men living on the edge and performing dangerous stunts. This is certainly creating different personalities of their products compared to Coca-Cola. For the product itself, flavours are very similar to Coca-Colas. Pepsi have also extended their product line to include other flavours and brands for example, Mountain Dew and also many different sizes, just as their competitors, to gain a greater portion of the market. The appearances of Pepsi products are quite different from that of Coca-Cola. Where Coca-Cola goes for a bright, fun look, Pepsi has a more futuristic look with the theme "the next generation." As the product is more associated with sports and doing unusual things, such as stunts and extreme games, they have not worried about creating a slick bottle shape like Coca-Cola, instead they've just made them slightly larger, to offer more to the customer. Pepsi have strongly associated themselves, through sponsorship, to extreme games, which includes skateboarding, rollerblading, and many other dangerous individual sports. But at the same time with advertisements, showing that it has a great taste, a can be used for a social drink. This is a very similar approach to Coca-Cola, that is, by using events to create awareness and then through advertising, create knowledge and liking to the product. However, they do it for a different target audience, as mentioned above, that's why they sponsor different events and use different advertising campaigns. Pepsi, just like Coca-Cola, flood the convenient stores with their products, and use their own fridges in gaining consumers' attention, thus ensuring their market exposure, is as large as possible Their pricing schemes follow along a similar line to Coca-Cola, in that they are at the more expensive end of the market. However Pepsi have taken one extra step in creating a discount. That is, they offer sixty ml extra for the same price. For many people who don't really know or care about the subtle differences in the tastes, they will go for the one that provides more for less. So again Pepsi have used the marketing mix to ensure their product is known, and attractive just as CocaCola has. The differences though, are stemming from their variance in how they position themselves in the market. Both organisations are very strong in the international market, and each have a strong hold on their target markets through effective use of the marketing mix. However, with poor decisions or failing in one of these four key areas of the marketing mix, either organisation could have caused their own downfall. Bibliography A. Buckley, The Essence of Marketing , Prentice Hall International, U.K, 1993 A. Hutchings, Marketing, a Resource Book, Pitman publishing, Great Britain, 1995 G. Lancaster and P Reynolds, Marketing , Macmillan Press Ltd, London, 1998 P. Kotler, G. Armstrong, L. Brown and S. Adam, Marketing, Prentice Hall, Australia, 1998 www.cocacola.com www.pepsi.com Footnotes: 1. Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p105 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p113 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p116 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p118 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p121 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p123 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p109 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p115 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p124 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p372 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p350 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 A. Buckley (1993) The essence of marketing p32 Lancaster and Reynolds (1998) Marketing P40 Troy's report and what his lecturer thought Click on the highlighted text to see the comments. Assignment 2 - Report topic: "The marketing environment... consists of the actors and forces outside marketing that affect marketing management's ability to develop and maintain successful transactions with its target customers." Kotler et al (1998) pg 100 In this assignment you are required to choose one industry from the two in your stream and identify and discuss the actors and forces currently active in that industry AND the likely effect/impact that these actors/forces will have on that industry in the next 12 months. [IMG-1] [1] [Executive summary?] Index 1 Cover page 2 Index page 3-8 Part 1 - The macroenvironment 8-14 Part 2 - The marketing mix 15 Bibliography Introduction Within this report the macro-forces of an industry will be analysed, continuing on to compare the marketing mix of two organisations within that industry. All organisations - with their suppliers, customers, competitors, and publics - have a macroenvironment. This environment consists of macro forces that act on and affect the organisation and are generally outside their control, as opposed to the micro forces which also affect the organisation, but are generally under their control. The marketing mix is the term used to describe how an organisation goes about developing a product and selling it to the market. The industry chosen is soft drinks which industry falls into the category of fast-moving-consumable-goods (FMCG's), as it is a product that is consumed, and is fast-moving. These won't sit in a supermarket or convenient store for long, as they are constantly being purchased. Other examples of a 'FMCG' are canned foods, ice cream, soup, cereal, potato chips and a whole lot more. Part 1 There are six main macro forces making up the "macroenvironment." These are: [IMG-2] [2]The demographic environment - which is the study of human populations in terms of size, density, location, age, sex, race, and occupation 1. Studies in this area, for example, can show the changing age structure, which is necessary, as marketeers need to understand who makes up the market, thus allowing them to make the most effective decisions for the marketing mix. [IMG-3] [3]The economic environment - which has an effect on consumer purchasing power and spending. For example, if the average income drops, then there is likely to be less buying power 2. The natural environment - involves natural resources that are needed as inputs by marketers or which are affected by marketing activities 3. An example of this is the non-renewable resource, where companies will face increasing prices, as the shortage becomes more of a problem. Also natural disasters can cause a sudden change in needs. The technological environment - this can create new markets and opportunities, as well as replace older ones. It can be of great benefit to society, but also of great disaster e.g guns 4. The political environment - consists of laws, government agencies and pressure groups that influence and limit organisations 5. An example of this is the new legislation passed that now products need to label all information, including how they are made. And the cultural environment - which is made up of institutions and other forces that affect society's basic values, perceptions, preferences, and behaviours 6. An example is of people who are patriotic and may only buy products manufactured by their own country as they believe it's for the better. An organisation must carefully watch and respond to changes in these forces as they all can shape opportunities and also create threats. The ways in which the macroenvironment may effect the soft drink industry will now be discussed with reference to the above definition. It isn't necessary to assume that all these macro forces will have an obvious effect on the industry, however it's more than likely most of them will. [IMG-4] [4]Demography can and will affect the soft drink industry in several ways. Youths and young adults are definitely the age group that makes up the majority of consumers in this industry. There has been a decline in the young adults group during the 1990's as a result of the reduced fertility of the 1970's 7. The youth group (10-19) dropped through the early 90's but will begin to increase again around the turn of the century. This is important information for marketers, as they can understand why or why not sales are changing. The early middle age group and older are also likely to purchase soft drinks. With the newer "diet" and "caffeine free" products, more of these older groups are able to enjoy soft drinks. However these older groups don't make up a great deal of the purchasing power for soft drinks. The population is becoming more educated. Soft drinks aren't considered healthy, and as more and more people learn of the problems associated with eating and drinking bad foods that rot teeth, it may be likely to have an effect on the soft drink industry. Within the soft drink industry is a range of products with varying prices. Although the cheap brands may be only be a dollar cheaper, this can become much more attractive than the image brought with the more expensive brands, in times of economic struggle. It is suggested that the average income through the 1990's is slowly increasing 8. To make sense of this we would assume then that the middle socioeconomic class would be able to afford the better brands, more so than in the past. However, will this affect soft drinks? Where parents buy for their children it may, but also for the young adults who may be earning more, it may not. The natural environment has had an impact on what we do with the cans and bottles once they're finished with, and that's recycling. This overcomes any worry that consumers may have for the environment, especially seeing as concerns for the environment have been growing more and more. Manufacturers, therefore, need to lend their support to recycling and show their care for the environment. Over the past decade we have seen many variations of one flavour invented, and then many more flavours too. Such ones include "diet" and "caffeine free" to attract the more healthy conscious, many fruity-flavoured soft drinks, and many more. This is related to the technology environment, and what we see here is the industry using the developments in technology to provide more variations to gain a greater market. There have been many developments in the bottling, to suit image, such as Coca-Cola's slick shape, the different sizes, which again give more variations, and the ability to recycle. With computer technology we can now shop over the Internet. Some may choose to purchase soft drinks, however this kind of technology is unlikely to boost sales significantly. Products need to be practical and affordable, and technology processes allow for more efficient production of packaging, and for them to be more practical, which relates back to the size and ability to recycle. The political environment will have had little impact on the soft drink industry except in the area of legislation. Such examples include the labelling of ingredients. The growing concern for the environment also comes under the topic of cultures. For it is becoming a value for the people of Australia, and also the world, to be more aware of the environment. However, cultures have many more influences, like people's views about themselves, which can affect the industry. One of the bigger organisations in the industry, Coca-Cola, promotes that there is an image associated with drinking their product. People use products as a means of self-expression 9 so they buy what will make them feel good. Buying a cheap brand cola may not allow someone to feel :"cool" or comfortable with the people around them. Some, however, don't care about others' opinions on such an issue and will be comfortable drinking cheap brand cola in public. However, it is noted that this "me society"' is on the way out. Thus, indulging in all the good things is becoming a less common thing and is changing to a "we society". However, this change may have no effect on the soft drink industry but only increase the need to buy the better brands. One recent ad shows scenes where huge groups of people are drinking their soft drink on the beach, which displays that it's a social drink. Soft drink organisations are amongst some of the most common organisations that sponsor large events, mainly sporting ones. These include Coca-Cola, Sprite, Pepsi, and many more. This encourages people's view of the organisation to be positive, as people are expecting more from large organisations to help society. So we can see that the macroenvironment for the soft drink industry has a lot of areas to cover - most of them always relating back to the people, as it's the people who make up the markets. Also, although they are macro forces, companies still take an environmental management perspective. That is, taking an aggressive action to influence forces the way they want. In the soft drink industry these forces are mostly all positive and therefore can benefit the consumers. Part 2 The two organisations chosen to analyse their marketing mixes are Coca-Cola, and Pepsi, within the soft drink industry. Coca-Cola is the leading manufacturer, marketer, and distributor of non-alcoholic beverages with Pepsi Co following second. [IMG-5] Firstly, we will look at how Coca-Cola has used their marketing mix. [5]The marketing mix is divided up into 4 parts; product, price, promotions and place. [IMG-6] [6]Firstly, the product. The product (Coca-Cola soft drink) includes not just the liquid inside but also the packaging. On the product-service continuum we see that a soft drink provides little service, apart from the convenience. Soft drinks satisfy the need of thirst. However, people are always different, some want more and others want less. Therefore Coca-Cola have made allowances for that by providing many sizes. We also have particular tastes, and again they have provided several options. So, although thirst is what is needed to be satisfied and that is the core benefit, we are receiving other benefits in the taste and size. This is all related to the product line, which is a term used to describe a group of products that are closely related because they function in a similar manner, are sold to the same customer groups, and marketed the same 10. Coca-Cola has developed several different flavours and sizes as mentioned above, but also several brands such as Sprite, Lift, Fanta and Diet Coke which increase the product line length, thus making full use of the market to maximise sales. Coca-Cola, however, also aims to create an image about the product. In this case they want it to be a social drink, one that you would have when having a good time. So when we go and buy Coca-Cola, we are not only relieving thirst but taking on an image and an idea. "We are going to a party - we have to get CocaCola". Through promotion people now have the idea that it's only cool to drink Coca-Cola, and to be seen with anything else is cheap. One of their advertising campaigns highlighted the point of enjoying Coca-Cola, thus displaying how the product is not just about satisfying thirst, but also you need to enjoy drinking it. The product is convenient 11, that is - bought frequently, immediately, and with a minimum of comparison and buying effort 12. The appearance 13 of the product is eye catching with the bright red colour. It has a uniquely designed bottle shape that fits in your hand better, and creates a nicer - more futuristic look. The quality of the soft drink is needed to be regularly high. Sealed caps ensure that none of the "fizz" is lost. The bottles are light, with flexible packaging, so they won't crack or leak, and are not too heavy to casually walk around with. The cans are also light and safe. All these factors are a part of the product, from the drink to the image. And through promotions Coca-Cola aims to create an attractiveness for this. Some of their advertisements show beach scenes, which allow the viewer to relate Coca-Cola and fun together. They have immense advertisement schemes, always creating new ideas and flooding the TV with Coca-Cola, mostly enhancing their image of being socially accepted and fun. Coca-Cola uses the "pull strategy" in their promotion. That is, they promote to the consumers to create the want for their product which in turn creates a demand on the retailers and then back to them. For example, in supermarkets and convenience stores Coca-Cola has their own fridge which contains only their products. There is little personal selling, but that is made up for in public relations and corporate image. Coca-Cola sponsors a lot of events including sports and recreational activities. All these are used to create awareness of the product. They also use competitions, such as check under the lid for an instant prize, to encourage consumers to buy their product over the competition's products. Coca-Cola promotions then create knowledge and liking about the product through campaigns that show that it has the best taste, is the most popular and is the one of the future, whilst appealing to a large range of audiences. Coca-Cola floods all possible retailing stores in satisfying the third part, place. In supermarkets and convenient stores Coca-Cola products are always easy to identify, and usually make up the greater proportion of options to buy. This increases their market exposure 14 through effective use of the retailers. For a FMCG it is important that they can be found and purchased easily. With the many automatic can machines located in many sports stadiums and shopping malls, you don't even need to go to a store to buy a drink. This greatly enhances the speed of purchase 15. Pricing strategy is the last area of the marketing mix. Coca-Cola products would appear, on the shelf, to have the most expensive range of soft drinks common to supermarkets, at almost double the cost of no name brands. This can be for several reasons apart from just to cover the extra costs of promotions, for which no name brands do without. It creates consumer perceptions and values. When people buy Coca-Cola they are not just buying the beverage but also the image that goes with it, therefore to have the price higher reiterates the fact that the product is of a better quality than the rest and that the consumer is not cheap. This is known as value-based pricing and is used by many other industries in attracting consumers. Now we can compare the above marketing mix to that of Pepsi Co. They both would use market segmentation and positioning, however even before the marketing mix is analysed we can see differences here. Market segmentation is the term used to describe the first step organisations take in deciding who they are going to sell the product too. The segmentation used by Pepsi and Coca-Cola is likely to be under the psychographic section, using values and attitudes. This means that within the many different values and attitudes that people have, Coca-Cola and Pepsi aim to choose a few and target their product towards them. They both aim towards creating an image associated with their products, however they target different types. [IMG-7] [7]For example, Coca-Cola is shown to be a more outgoing and group orientated image, whereas Pepsi focus more on the individual and less outgoing. This is an example of market positioning. As trying to compete in the exact same area will only result in fewer sales for each, they try to obtain their own part of the market segment 16. Diagram 1: An example of market positioning. Looking at the marketing mix, we will now compare how Pepsi go about it as opposed to Coca-Cola. As they are both very similar, in that they are the two largest manufacturers of soft drink, they compete for market share constantly, but in different ways. This is shown in the first section of the marketing mix - product as discussed above. [IMG-8] [8]Just as Coca-Cola have aimed to create an image about their product that will encourage you to buy, so too have Pepsi. However Pepsi have a different image associated with their product. As mentioned when talking about market positioning, Pepsi look less to the outgoing groups, and focus on the individuals and also introversive people. A lot of their campaigns in the past are associated with sports, many of which were individual sports. They had promotions that showed men living on the edge and performing dangerous stunts. This is certainly creating different personalities of their products compared to Coca-Cola. For the product itself, flavours are very similar to Coca-Colas. Pepsi have also extended their product line to include other flavours and brands for example, Mountain Dew and also many different sizes, just as their competitors, to gain a greater portion of the market. The appearances of Pepsi products are quite different from that of Coca-Cola. Where Coca-Cola goes for a bright, fun look, Pepsi has a more futuristic look with the theme "the next generation." As the product is more associated with sports and doing unusual things, such as stunts and extreme games, they have not worried about creating a slick bottle shape like Coca-Cola, instead they've just made them slightly larger, to offer more to the customer. Pepsi have strongly associated themselves, through sponsorship, to extreme games, which includes skateboarding, rollerblading, and many other dangerous individual sports. But at the same time with advertisements, showing that it has a great taste, a can be used for a social drink. This is a very similar approach to Coca-Cola, that is, by using events to create awareness and then through advertising, create knowledge and liking to the product. However, they do it for a different target audience, as mentioned above, that's why they sponsor different events and use different advertising campaigns. Pepsi, just like Coca-Cola, flood the convenient stores with their products, and use their own fridges in gaining consumers' attention, thus ensuring their market exposure, is as large as possible Their pricing schemes follow along a similar line to Coca-Cola, in that they are at the more expensive end of the market. However Pepsi have taken one extra step in creating a discount. That is, they offer sixty ml extra for the same price. For many people who don't really know or care about the subtle differences in the tastes, they will go for the one that provides more for less. So again Pepsi have used the marketing mix to ensure their product is known, and attractive just as CocaCola has. The differences though, are stemming from their variance in how they position themselves in the market. Both organisations are very strong in the international market, and each have a strong hold on their target markets through effective use of the marketing mix. However, with poor decisions or failing in one of these four key areas of the marketing mix, either organisation could have caused their own downfall. [IMG-9] [9] [Lecturer's overall comment] Bibliography A. Buckley, The Essence of Marketing , Prentice Hall International, U.K, 1993 A. Hutchings, Marketing, a Resource Book, Pitman publishing, Great Britain, 1995 G. Lancaster and P Reynolds, Marketing , Macmillan Press Ltd, London, 1998 P. Kotler, G. Armstrong, L. Brown and S. Adam, Marketing, Prentice Hall, Australia, 1998 [IMG-10] [10]www.cocacola.com www.pepsi.com Footnotes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p105 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p113 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p116 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p118 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p121 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p123 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p109 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p115 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p124 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p372 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 Kotler et al (1998) Marketing p350 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 A. Hutchings (1995) Marketing, A Resource Book p5 A. Buckley (1993) The essence of marketing p32 Lancaster and Reynolds (1998) Marketing P40 [1] Executive summary An executive summary is required for a report - to sum up objectives and identify the main findings. [2] Harvard system preferred It should be noted that the Harvard or in-text system is the preferred referencing system for Marketing (though other referencing systems are acceptable). [3] Not adequate You need to show you understand the macro forces. Most of the definitions of the forces in this section are very brief and the student then does not really discuss them. He does give examples - which is fine - but if the definition is not clear and comprehensive, examples do not help. One can infer that he has come to grips with the demographic environment, for instance, but it is difficult to see how much he comprehends about the technological environment and others. Direct mention needs to be made of the impact of the macro forces on the FMCG area. [4] Paragraph headings? This appears to be where the first heading, "Demographic Forces", should go. There is no lead-in from the previous paragraph, and it is only because the word "demography" appears that it can be guessed. Compare this with the paragraph below which begins "Within the soft drink industry...". Presumably, this refers to the economic environment, but it is even harder to tell. [5] "divided up"? Talking about the "marketing mix" being divided up into parts creates a false impression The marketing mix is a theory, not an observable feature in the world. It's more appropriate to talk along the following lines: "The elements of the marketing mix are identified/described as...". [6] Difficult to follow Problems arising here are a result of there being no headings to focus and direct the reader. The elements to be discussed have been identified in the previous paragraph as "product, price, promotion and place". This paragraph is about product, but without headings it is hard to see where the next topic starts. By listing the topics at the outset, the writer sets up an expectation that the discussion will follow the same order: price seems to be treated last of all, however. [7] Good Perceptive example: shows the student is observing the promotional material carefully in relation to the target markets. [8] New section Headings again required. The student has switched to his second product without signalling it very conspicuously to the reader. Again, there is no particular lead-in from the previous para. The reader has to assume that the same elements of the marketing mix will be involved as they are not specified. Both "Pepsi" and then "product" need to be signalled. The topics, "promotion" and "place", are difficult to find; "pricing" seems to be treated last again. [9] Lecturer's overall comment This report received a (low) Pass. Overall, the report appears to lack structure - and topics need to be covered in more detail. In Part 1, the student's treatment of the macroenvironment zeroes in on particular instances and examples too quickly: The macro forces need to be covered more systematically - and it is not always easy to see where one ends and another begins. This is made more difficult because he has not used headings; these are essential in a report because a report asks you to address specific topics. If your reader cannot clearly see where you are addressing these topics - even if you are including some discussion of them - it is confusing to read and detracts from the efforts made. The paragraphing too should clearly support the structuring provided by the headings. [10] www sites Web sites should be treated alphabetically the same as the rest of the reference list, using author if there is one, or the organisation name if not. Students should check the accepted ways of referencing web material. See Skills for Writing - Using Sources - Reference List. Copyright © 2017/07/29 WRITINGANDBUSINESS-ECONOMICS Language and Learning, Monash University - ABN 12 377 614 012